optaPlannerLogo

1. OptaPlanner Introduction

1.1. What is OptaPlanner?

Every organization faces planning problems: providing products or services with a limited set of constrained resources (employees, assets, time and money). OptaPlanner optimizes such planning to do more business with less resources. This is known as Constraint Satisfaction Programming (which is part of the Operations Research discipline).

OptaPlanner is a lightweight, embeddable constraint satisfaction engine which optimizes planning problems. It solves use cases such as:

  • Employee shift rostering: timetabling nurses, repairmen, …​

  • Agenda scheduling: scheduling meetings, appointments, maintenance jobs, advertisements, …​

  • Educational timetabling: scheduling lessons, courses, exams, conference presentations, …​

  • Vehicle routing: planning vehicle routes (trucks, trains, boats, airplanes, …​) for moving freight and/or passengers through multiple destinations using known mapping tools …​

  • Bin packing: filling containers, trucks, ships, and storage warehouses with items, but also packing information across computer resources, as in cloud computing …​

  • Job shop scheduling: planning car assembly lines, machine queue planning, workforce task planning, …​

  • Cutting stock: minimizing waste while cutting paper, steel, carpet, …​

  • Sport scheduling: planning games and training schedules for football leagues, baseball leagues, …​

  • Financial optimization: investment portfolio optimization, risk spreading, …​

useCaseOverview

1.2. What is a Planning Problem?

whatIsAPlanningProblem

A planning problem has an optimal goal, based on limited resources and under specific constraints. Optimal goals can be any number of things, such as:

  • Maximized profits - the optimal goal results in the highest possible profit.

  • Minimized ecological footprint - the optimal goal has the least amount of environmental impact.

  • Maximized satisfaction for employees or customers - the optimal goal prioritizes the needs of employees or customers.

The ability to achieve these goals relies on the number of resources available, such as:

  • The number of people.

  • Amount of time.

  • Budget.

  • Physical assets, for example, machinery, vehicles, computers, buildings, etc.

Specific constraints related to these resources must also be taken into account, such as the number of hours a person works, their ability to use certain machines, or compatibility between pieces of equipment.

OptaPlanner helps JavaTM programmers solve constraint satisfaction problems efficiently. Under the hood, it combines optimization heuristics and metaheuristics with very efficient score calculation.

1.2.1. A Planning Problem is NP-complete or NP-hard

All the use cases above are probably NP-complete/NP-hard, which means in layman’s terms:

  • It’s easy to verify a given solution to a problem in reasonable time.

  • There is no silver bullet to find the optimal solution of a problem in reasonable time (*).

(*) At least, none of the smartest computer scientists in the world have found such a silver bullet yet. But if they find one for 1 NP-complete problem, it will work for every NP-complete problem.

In fact, there’s a $ 1,000,000 reward for anyone that proves if such a silver bullet actually exists or not.

The implication of this is pretty dire: solving your problem is probably harder than you anticipated, because the two common techniques won’t suffice:

  • A Brute Force algorithm (even a smarter variant) will take too long.

  • A quick algorithm, for example in bin packing, putting in the largest items first, will return a solution that is far from optimal.

By using advanced optimization algorithms, OptaPlanner does find a good solution in reasonable time for such planning problems.

1.2.2. A Planning Problem Has (Hard and Soft) Constraints

Usually, a planning problem has at least two levels of constraints:

  • A (negative) hard constraint must not be broken. For example: 1 teacher can not teach 2 different lessons at the same time.

  • A (negative) soft constraint should not be broken if it can be avoided. For example: Teacher A does not like to teach on Friday afternoon.

Some problems have positive constraints too:

  • A positive soft constraint (or reward) should be fulfilled if possible. For example: Teacher B likes to teach on Monday morning.

Some basic problems (such as N queens) only have hard constraints. Some problems have three or more levels of constraints, for example hard, medium and soft constraints.

These constraints define the score calculation (AKA fitness function) of a planning problem. Each solution of a planning problem can be graded with a score. With OptaPlanner, score constraints are written in an Object Oriented language, such as JavaTM code or Drools rules. Such code is easy, flexible and scalable.

1.2.3. A Planning Problem Has a Huge Search Space

A planning problem has a number of solutions. There are several categories of solutions:

  • A possible solution is any solution, whether or not it breaks any number of constraints. Planning problems tend to have an incredibly large number of possible solutions. Many of those solutions are worthless.

  • A feasible solution is a solution that does not break any (negative) hard constraints. The number of feasible solutions tends to be relative to the number of possible solutions. Sometimes there are no feasible solutions. Every feasible solution is a possible solution.

  • An optimal solution is a solution with the highest score. Planning problems tend to have 1 or a few optimal solutions. There is always at least 1 optimal solution, even in the case that there are no feasible solutions and the optimal solution isn’t feasible.

  • The best solution found is the solution with the highest score found by an implementation in a given amount of time. The best solution found is likely to be feasible and, given enough time, it’s an optimal solution.

Counterintuitively, the number of possible solutions is huge (if calculated correctly), even with a small dataset. As you can see in the examples, most instances have a lot more possible solutions than the minimal number of atoms in the known universe (10^80). Because there is no silver bullet to find the optimal solution, any implementation is forced to evaluate at least a subset of all those possible solutions.

OptaPlanner supports several optimization algorithms to efficiently wade through that incredibly large number of possible solutions. Depending on the use case, some optimization algorithms perform better than others, but it’s impossible to tell in advance. With OptaPlanner, it is easy to switch the optimization algorithm, by changing the solver configuration in a few lines of XML or code.

1.3. Requirements

OptaPlanner is open source software, released under the Apache Software License 2.0. This license is very liberal and allows reuse for commercial purposes. Read the layman’s explanation.

OptaPlanner is 100% pure JavaTM and runs on any JVM 8 or higher. It integrates very easily with other JavaTM technologies. OptaPlanner is available in the Maven Central Repository.

Planner works on any Java Virtual Machine and is compatible with Standard Java, Enterprise Java, and all JVM languages.

compatibility

1.4. Governance

1.4.1. Status of OptaPlanner

OptaPlanner is stable, reliable and scaleable. It has been heavily tested with unit, integration, and stress tests, and is used in production throughout the world. One example handles over 50 000 variables with 5000 variables each, multiple constraint types and billions of possible constraint matches.

1.4.3. Backwards Compatibility

OptaPlanner separates its API and implementation:

  • Public API: All classes in the package namespace org.optaplanner.core.api are 100% backwards compatible in future releases (especially minor and hotfix releases). In rare circumstances, if the major version number changes, a few specific classes might have a few backwards incompatible changes, but those will be clearly documented in the upgrade recipe.

  • XML configuration: The XML solver configuration is backwards compatible for all elements, except for elements that require the use of non public API classes. The XML solver configuration is defined by the classes in the package namespace org.optaplanner.core.config.

  • Implementation classes: All classes in the package namespace org.optaplanner.core.impl are not backwards compatible: they will change in future major or minor releases (but probably not in hotfix releases). The upgrade recipe describes every such relevant change and on how to quickly deal with it when upgrading to a newer version.

This documentation covers some impl classes too. Those documented impl classes are reliable and safe to use (unless explicitly marked as experimental in this documentation), but we’re just not entirely comfortable yet to write their signatures in stone.

1.4.4. Community and Support

For news and articles, check our blog, twitter (including Geoffrey’s twitter) and facebook.
If you’re happy with OptaPlanner, make us happy by posting a tweet or blog article about it.

Public questions are welcome on here. Bugs and feature requests are welcome in our issue tracker. Pull requests are very welcome on GitHub and get priority treatment! By open sourcing your improvements, you 'll benefit from our peer review and from our improvements made on top of your improvements.

Red Hat sponsors OptaPlanner development by employing the core team. For enterprise support and consulting, take a look at these services.

1.4.5. Relationship with Drools and jBPM

OptaPlanner is part of the KIE group of projects. It releases regularly (often once or twice per month) together with the Drools rule engine and the jBPM workflow engine.

kieFunctionalityOverview

See the architecture overview to learn more about the optional integration with Drools.

1.5. Download and Run the Examples

1.5.1. Get the Release zip and Run the Examples

To try it now:

  1. Download a release zip of OptaPlanner from the OptaPlanner website and unzip it.

  2. Open the directory examples and run the script.

    Linux or Mac:

    $ cd examples
    $ ./runExamples.sh

    Windows:

    $ cd examples
    $ runExamples.bat
distributionZip

The Examples GUI application will open. Pick an example to try it out:

plannerExamplesAppScreenshot

OptaPlanner itself has no GUI dependencies. It runs just as well on a server or a mobile JVM as it does on the desktop.

1.5.2. Run the Webexamples

Besides the GUI examples, there are also a set of webexamples to try out. The webexamples include:

  • Vehicle routing: calculating the shortest possible route to pick up all items required for a number of different customers using either Leaflet or Google Maps visualizations.

  • Cloud balancing: Assigning processes across computers with different specifications and costs.

Prerequisites

The webexamples require several JEE APIs to run, such as:

  • Servlet

  • JAX-RS

  • CDI

These are not required for Planner itself.

Running the Webexamples on a JEE Application Server

  1. Download a JEE application server, such as JBoss EAP or WildFly and unzip it.

  2. Download a release zip of OptaPlanner from the OptaPlanner website and unzip it.

  3. Open the directory webexamples and deploy the optaplanner-webexamples-*.war file on the JEE application server.

    If using JBoss EAP in standalone mode, this can be done by adding the optaplanner-webexamples-.war file to the jboss-eap-/standalone/deployments folder.

  4. Open the following address in a web browser: http://localhost:8080/optaplanner-webexamples-*/ (replace the * with the actual version).

Deploying Webexamples on a Servlet Container

To successfully deploy the webexamples on a servlet container (such as Jetty or Tomcat) instead of on a real JEE application server (such as WildFly):

  1. Add the missing implementation libraries (for example RestEasy and Weld) in the optaplanner-webexamples-*.war manually.

  2. Deploy the optaplanner-webexamples-*.war on the servlet container.

Pick an example to try it out, such as the Vehicle Routing example:

plannerWebexamplesScreenshot

1.5.3. Run the Examples in an IDE (IntelliJ, Eclipse, NetBeans)

To run the examples in your favorite IDE:

  • In IntelliJ IDEA, NetBeans or a non-vanilla Eclipse:

    1. Open the file examples/sources/pom.xml as a new project, the maven integration will take care of the rest.

    2. Run the examples from the project.

  • In a vanilla Eclipse (which lacks the M2Eclipse plugin):

    1. Open a new project for the directory examples/sources .

    2. Add all the jars to the classpath from the directory binaries and the directory examples/binaries , except for the file examples/binaries/optaplanner-examples-*.jar .

    3. Add the Java source directory src/main/java and the Java resources directory src/main/resources .

    4. Create a run configuration:

      • Main class: org.optaplanner.examples.app.OptaPlannerExamplesApp

      • VM parameters (optional): -Xmx512M -server

        1. To run a specific example directly and skip the example selection window, run its App class (for example CloudBalancingApp) instead of OptaPlannerExamplesApp.

    5. Run that run configuration.

1.5.4. Use OptaPlanner with Maven, Gradle, Ivy, Buildr or ANT

The OptaPlanner jars are also available in the central maven repository (and also in the JBoss maven repository).

If you use Maven, add a dependency to optaplanner-core in your project’s pom.xml :

    <dependency>
      <groupId>org.optaplanner</groupId>
      <artifactId>optaplanner-core</artifactId>
    </dependency>

This is similar for Gradle, Ivy and Buildr. To identify the latest version, check the central maven repository.

Because you might end up using other OptaPlanner modules too, it’s recommended to import the optaplanner-bom in Maven’s dependencyManagement so the OptaPlanner version is specified only once:

  <dependencyManagement>
    <dependencies>
      <dependency>
        <groupId>org.optaplanner</groupId>
        <artifactId>optaplanner-bom</artifactId>
        <type>pom</type>
        <version>...</version>
        <scope>import</scope>
      </dependency>
      ...
    </dependencies>
  </dependencyManagement>

If you’re still using ANT (without Ivy), copy all the jars from the download zip’s binaries directory in your classpath.

The download zip’s binaries directory contains far more jars then optaplanner-core actually uses. It also contains the jars used by other modules, such as optaplanner-benchmark.

Check the maven repository pom.xml files to determine the minimal dependency set of a specific module (for a specific version).

1.5.5. Build OptaPlanner from Source

Prerequisites

  • Set up Git.

  • Authenticate on GitHub using either HTTPS or SSH.

    • See GitHub for more information about setting up and authenticating Git.

  • Set up Maven.

Build and run the examples from source.

  1. Clone optaplanner from GitHub (or alternatively, download the zipball):

    $ git clone https://github.com/kiegroup/optaplanner.git
    ...
  2. Build it with Maven:

    $ cd optaplanner
    $ mvn clean install -DskipTests
    ...

    The first time, Maven might take a long time, because it needs to download jars.

  3. Run the examples:

    $ cd optaplanner-examples
    $ mvn exec:java
    ...
  4. Edit the sources in your favorite IDE.

    1. Optional: use a Java profiler.

2. Getting Started: A Cloud Balancing Demonstration

2.1. Cloud Balancing Tutorial

2.1.1. Problem Description

Suppose your company owns a number of cloud computers and needs to run a number of processes on those computers. Assign each process to a computer.

The following hard constraints must be fulfilled:

  • Every computer must be able to handle the minimum hardware requirements of the sum of its processes:

    • CPU capacity: The CPU power of a computer must be at least the sum of the CPU power required by the processes assigned to that computer.

    • Memory capacity: The RAM memory of a computer must be at least the sum of the RAM memory required by the processes assigned to that computer.

    • Network capacity: The network bandwidth of a computer must be at least the sum of the network bandwidth required by the processes assigned to that computer.

The following soft constraints should be optimized:

  • Each computer that has one or more processes assigned, incurs a maintenance cost (which is fixed per computer).

    • Cost: Minimize the total maintenance cost.

This problem is a form of bin packing. The following is a simplified example, in which we assign four processes to two computers with two constraints (CPU and RAM) with a simple algorithm:

cloudBalanceUseCase

The simple algorithm used here is the First Fit Decreasing algorithm, which assigns the bigger processes first and assigns the smaller processes to the remaining space. As you can see, it is not optimal, as it does not leave enough room to assign the yellow process D.

Planner does find the more optimal solution by using additional, smarter algorithms. It also scales: both in data (more processes, more computers) and constraints (more hardware requirements, other constraints). So let’s see how Planner can be used in this scenario.

Here’s an executive summary of this example and an advanced implementation with more constraints:

cloudOptimizationValueProposition

2.1.2. Problem Size

Table 1. Cloud Balancing Problem Size
Problem Size Computers Processes Search Space

2computers-6processes

2

6

64

3computers-9processes

3

9

10^4

4computers-012processes

4

12

10^7

100computers-300processes

100

300

10^600

200computers-600processes

200

600

10^1380

400computers-1200processes

400

1200

10^3122

800computers-2400processes

800

2400

10^6967

2.2. Using the Domain Model

2.2.1. Domain Model Design

Using a domain model helps determine which classes are planning entities and which of their properties are planning variables. It also helps to simplify contraints, improve performance, and increase flexibility for future needs.

To create a domain model, define all the objects that represent the input data for the problem. In this simple example, the objects are processes and computers.

A separate object in the domain model must represent a full data set of problem, which contains the input data as well as a solution. In this example, this object holds a list of computers and a list of processes. Each process is assigned to a compter; the distribution of processes between computers is the solution.

  1. Draw a class diagram of your domain model.

  2. Normalize it to remove duplicate data.

  3. Write down some sample instances for each class.

    • Computer: represents a computer with certain hardware and maintenance costs.

      In this example, the sample instances for the Computer class are: cpuPower, memory, networkBandwidth, cost.

    • Process: represents a process with a demand. Needs to be assigned to a Computer by Planner.

      Sample instances for Process are: requiredCpuPower, requiredMemory, and requiredNetworkBandwidth.

    • CloudBalance: represents a problem. Contains every Computer and Process for a certain data set.

      For an object representing the full data set and solution, a sample instance holding the score must be present. Planner can calculate and compare the scores for different solutions; the solution with the highest score is the optimal solution. Therefore, the sample instance for CloudBalance is score.

  4. Determine which relationships (or fields) change during planning.

    • Planning entity: The class (or classes) that Planner can change during solving. In this example, it is the class Process, because Planner can assign processes to computers.

    • Problem fact: A class representing input data that Planner can not change.

    • Planning variable: The property (or properties) of a planning entity class that changes during solving. In this example, it is the property computer on the class Process.

    • Planning solution: The class that represents a solution to the problem. This class must represent the full data set and contain all planning entities. In this example that is the class CloudBalance.

In the UML class diagram below, the Planner concepts are already annotated:

cloudBalanceClassDiagram

2.2.2. Domain Model Implementation

2.2.2.1. The Computer Class

The Computer class is a POJO (Plain Old Java Object). Usually, you will have more of this kind of classes with input data.

Example 1. CloudComputer.java
public class CloudComputer ... {

    private int cpuPower;
    private int memory;
    private int networkBandwidth;
    private int cost;

    ... // getters
}
2.2.2.2. The Process Class

The Process class is particularly important. It is the class that is modified during solving.

We need to tell Planner that it can change the property computer. To do this: . Annotate the class with @PlanningEntity. . Annotate the getter getComputer() with @PlanningVariable.

Of course, the property computer needs a setter too, so Planner can change it during solving.

Example 2. CloudProcess.java
@PlanningEntity(...)
public class CloudProcess ... {

    private int requiredCpuPower;
    private int requiredMemory;
    private int requiredNetworkBandwidth;

    private CloudComputer computer;

    ... // getters

    @PlanningVariable(valueRangeProviderRefs = {"computerRange"})
    public CloudComputer getComputer() {
        return computer;
    }

    public void setComputer(CloudComputer computer) {
        computer = computer;
    }

    // ************************************************************************
    // Complex methods
    // ************************************************************************

    ...

}
  • Planner needs to know which values it can choose from to assign to the property computer. Those values are retrieved from the method CloudBalance.getComputerList() on the planning solution, which returns a list of all computers in the current data set.

  • The @PlanningVariable's valueRangeProviderRefs parameter on CloudProcess.getComputer() needs to match with the @ValueRangeProvider's id on CloudBalance.getComputerList().

Instead of getter annotations, it is also possible to use field annotations.

2.2.2.3. The CloudBalance Class

The CloudBalance class has a @PlanningSolution annotation.

  • It holds a list of all computers and a list of all processes.

  • It represents both the planning problem and (if it is initialized) the planning solution.

  • To save a solution, Planner initializes a new instance of the class.

    1. The processList property holds a list of processes. Planner can change the processes, allocating them to different computers. Therefore, a process is a planing entity and the list of processes is a collection of planning entities. We annotate the getter getProcessList() with @PlanningEntityCollectionProperty.

    2. The computerList property holds a list of computers. Planner can not change the computers. Therefore, a computer is a problem fact. Especially for score calculation with Drools, the property computerList needs to be annotated with a @ProblemFactCollectionProperty so that Planner can retrieve the list of computers (problem facts) and make it available to the Drools engine.

    3. The CloudBalance class also has a @PlanningScore annotated property score, which is the Score of that solution in its current state. Planner automatically updates it when it calculates a Score for a solution instance. Therefore, this property needs a setter.

Example 3. CloudBalance.java
@PlanningSolution
public class CloudBalance ... {

    private List<CloudComputer> computerList;

    private List<CloudProcess> processList;

    private HardSoftScore score;

    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "computerRange")
    @ProblemFactCollectionProperty
    public List<CloudComputer> getComputerList() {
        return computerList;
    }

    @PlanningEntityCollectionProperty
    public List<CloudProcess> getProcessList() {
        return processList;
    }

    @PlanningScore
    public HardSoftScore getScore() {
        return score;
    }

    public void setScore(HardSoftScore score) {
        this.score = score;
    }

    ...
}

2.3. Run the Cloud Balancing Hello World

  1. Download and configure the examples in your preferred IDE.

  2. Create a run configuration with the following main class: org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.app.CloudBalancingHelloWorld

    By default, the Cloud Balancing Hello World is configured to run for 120 seconds.

It will execute the following code:

Example 4. CloudBalancingHelloWorld.java
public class CloudBalancingHelloWorld {

    public static void main(String[] args) {
        // Build the Solver
        SolverFactory<CloudBalance> solverFactory = SolverFactory.createFromXmlResource(
                "org/optaplanner/examples/cloudbalancing/solver/cloudBalancingSolverConfig.xml");
        Solver<CloudBalance> solver = solverFactory.buildSolver();

        // Load a problem with 400 computers and 1200 processes
        CloudBalance unsolvedCloudBalance = new CloudBalancingGenerator().createCloudBalance(400, 1200);

        // Solve the problem
        CloudBalance solvedCloudBalance = solver.solve(unsolvedCloudBalance);

        // Display the result
        System.out.println("\nSolved cloudBalance with 400 computers and 1200 processes:\n"
                + toDisplayString(solvedCloudBalance));
    }

    ...
}

The code example does the following:

  1. Build the Solver based on a solver configuration (in this case an XML file, cloudBalancingSolverConfig.xml, from the classpath).

    Building the Solver is the most complicated part of this procedure. For more detail, see Solver Configuration.

            SolverFactory<CloudBalance> solverFactory = SolverFactory.createFromXmlResource(
                    "org/optaplanner/examples/cloudbalancing/solver/cloudBalancingSolverConfig.xml");
            Solver solver<CloudBalance> = solverFactory.buildSolver();
  2. Load the problem.

    CloudBalancingGenerator generates a random problem: you will replace this with a class that loads a real problem, for example from a database.

            CloudBalance unsolvedCloudBalance = new CloudBalancingGenerator().createCloudBalance(400, 1200);
  3. Solve the problem.

            CloudBalance solvedCloudBalance = solver.solve(unsolvedCloudBalance);
  4. Display the result.

            System.out.println("\nSolved cloudBalance with 400 computers and 1200 processes:\n"
                    + toDisplayString(solvedCloudBalance));

2.4. Solver Configuration

The solver configuration file determines how the solving process works; it is considered a part of the code. The file is named cloudBalancingSolverConfig.xml.

Example 5. cloudBalancingSolverConfig.xml
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<solver>
  <!-- Domain model configuration -->
  <scanAnnotatedClasses/>

  <!-- Score configuration -->
  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <easyScoreCalculatorClass>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.optional.score.CloudBalancingEasyScoreCalculator</easyScoreCalculatorClass>
    <!--<scoreDrl>org/optaplanner/examples/cloudbalancing/solver/cloudBalancingScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>-->
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

  <!-- Optimization algorithms configuration -->
  <termination>
    <secondsSpentLimit>30</secondsSpentLimit>
  </termination>
</solver>

This solver configuration consists of three parts:

  1. Domain model configuration: What can Planner change?

    We need to make Planner aware of our domain classes. In this configuration, it will automatically scan all classes in your classpath (for a @PlanningEntity or @PlanningSolution annotation):

      <scanAnnotatedClasses/>
  2. Score configuration: How should Planner optimize the planning variables? What is our goal?

    Since we have hard and soft constraints, we use a HardSoftScore. But we need to tell Planner how to calculate the score, depending on our business requirements. Further down, we will look into two alternatives to calculate the score: using an easy Java implementation, or using Drools DRL.

      <scoreDirectorFactory>
        <easyScoreCalculatorClass>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.optional.score.CloudBalancingEasyScoreCalculator</easyScoreCalculatorClass>
        <!--<scoreDrl>org/optaplanner/examples/cloudbalancing/solver/cloudBalancingScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>-->
      </scoreDirectorFactory>
  3. Optimization algorithms configuration: How should Planner optimize it?

    In this case, we use the default optimization algorithms (because no explicit optimization algorithms are configured) for 30 seconds:

      <termination>
        <secondsSpentLimit>30</secondsSpentLimit>
      </termination>

    Planner should get a good result in seconds (and even in less than 15 milliseconds with real-time planning), but the more time it has, the better the result will be. Advanced use cases might use different termination criteria than a hard time limit.

    The default algorithms will already easily surpass human planners and most in-house implementations. Use the Benchmarker to power tweak to get even better results.

2.5. Score Configuration

Planner will search for the Solution with the highest Score. This example uses a HardSoftScore, which means Planner will look for the solution with no hard constraints broken (fulfill hardware requirements) and as little as possible soft constraints broken (minimize maintenance cost).

scoreComparisonCloudBalancing

Of course, Planner needs to be told about these domain-specific score constraints. There are several ways to implement such a score function:

2.5.1. Easy Java Score Configuration

One way to define a score function is to implement the interface EasyScoreCalculator in plain Java.

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <easyScoreCalculatorClass>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.optional.score.CloudBalancingEasyScoreCalculator</easyScoreCalculatorClass>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

Just implement the calculateScore(Solution) method to return a HardSoftScore instance.

Example 6. CloudBalancingEasyScoreCalculator.java
public class CloudBalancingEasyScoreCalculator implements EasyScoreCalculator<CloudBalance> {

    /**
     * A very simple implementation. The double loop can easily be removed by using Maps as shown in
     * {@link CloudBalancingMapBasedEasyScoreCalculator#calculateScore(CloudBalance)}.
     */
    public HardSoftScore calculateScore(CloudBalance cloudBalance) {
        int hardScore = 0;
        int softScore = 0;
        for (CloudComputer computer : cloudBalance.getComputerList()) {
            int cpuPowerUsage = 0;
            int memoryUsage = 0;
            int networkBandwidthUsage = 0;
            boolean used = false;

            // Calculate usage
            for (CloudProcess process : cloudBalance.getProcessList()) {
                if (computer.equals(process.getComputer())) {
                    cpuPowerUsage += process.getRequiredCpuPower();
                    memoryUsage += process.getRequiredMemory();
                    networkBandwidthUsage += process.getRequiredNetworkBandwidth();
                    used = true;
                }
            }

            // Hard constraints
            int cpuPowerAvailable = computer.getCpuPower() - cpuPowerUsage;
            if (cpuPowerAvailable < 0) {
                hardScore += cpuPowerAvailable;
            }
            int memoryAvailable = computer.getMemory() - memoryUsage;
            if (memoryAvailable < 0) {
                hardScore += memoryAvailable;
            }
            int networkBandwidthAvailable = computer.getNetworkBandwidth() - networkBandwidthUsage;
            if (networkBandwidthAvailable < 0) {
                hardScore += networkBandwidthAvailable;
            }

            // Soft constraints
            if (used) {
                softScore -= computer.getCost();
            }
        }
        return HardSoftScore.valueOf(hardScore, softScore);
    }

}

Even if we optimize the code above to use Maps to iterate through the processList only once, it is still slow because it does not do incremental score calculation. To fix that, either use incremental Java score calculation or Drools score calculation.

2.5.2. Drools Score Configuration

Drools score calculation uses incremental calculation, where every score constraint is written as one or more score rules.

Using the Drools rule engine for score calculation, allows you to integrate with other Drools technologies, such as decision tables (XLS or web based), the KIE Workbench, …​

Prerequisite To use the Drools rule engine as a score function, simply add a scoreDrl resource in the classpath:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <scoreDrl>org/optaplanner/examples/cloudbalancing/solver/cloudBalancingScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>
  1. We want to make sure that all computers have enough CPU, RAM and network bandwidth to support all their processes, so we make these hard constraints:

    Example 7. cloudBalancingScoreRules.drl - Hard Constraints
    ...
    
    import org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.domain.CloudBalance;
    import org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.domain.CloudComputer;
    import org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.domain.CloudProcess;
    
    global HardSoftScoreHolder scoreHolder;
    
    // ############################################################################
    // Hard constraints
    // ############################################################################
    
    rule "requiredCpuPowerTotal"
        when
            $computer : CloudComputer($cpuPower : cpuPower)
            accumulate(
                CloudProcess(
                    computer == $computer,
                    $requiredCpuPower : requiredCpuPower);
                $requiredCpuPowerTotal : sum($requiredCpuPower);
                $requiredCpuPowerTotal > $cpuPower
            )
        then
            scoreHolder.addHardConstraintMatch(kcontext, $cpuPower - $requiredCpuPowerTotal);
    end
    
    rule "requiredMemoryTotal"
        ...
    end
    
    rule "requiredNetworkBandwidthTotal"
        ...
    end
  2. If those constraints are met, we want to minimize the maintenance cost, so we add that as a soft constraint:

    Example 8. cloudBalancingScoreRules.drl - Soft Constraints
    // ############################################################################
    // Soft constraints
    // ############################################################################
    
    rule "computerCost"
        when
            $computer : CloudComputer($cost : cost)
            exists CloudProcess(computer == $computer)
        then
            scoreHolder.addSoftConstraintMatch(kcontext, - $cost);
    end

2.6. Beyond this Tutorial

Now that this simple example works, you can try going further. For example, you can enrich the domain model and add extra constraints such as these:

  • Each Process belongs to a Service. A computer might crash, so processes running the same service must be assigned to different computers.

  • Each Computer is located in a Building. A building might burn down, so processes of the same services should (or must) be assigned to computers in different buildings.

3. Use Cases and Examples

3.1. Examples Overview

Planner has several examples. In this manual we explain mainly using the n queens example and cloud balancing example. So it is advisable to read at least those sections.

Some of the examples solve problems that are presented in academic contests. The Contest column in the following table lists the contests. It also identifies an example as being either realistic or unrealistic for the purpose of a contest. A realistic contest is an official, independent contest:

  • that clearly defines a real-word use case.

  • with real-world constraints.

  • with multiple, real-world datasets.

  • that expects reproducible results within a specific time limit on specific hardware.

  • that has had serious participation from the academic and/or enterprise Operations Research community.

Realistic contests provide an objective comparison of Planner with competitive software and academic research.

The source code of all these examples is available in the distribution zip under examples/sources and also in git under optaplanner/optaplanner-examples.

Table 2. Examples Overview
Example Domain Size Contest Special features used

N queens

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 variable

  • Entity ⇐ 256

  • Value ⇐ 256

  • Search space ⇐ 10^616

None

Cloud balancing

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 variable

  • Entity ⇐ 2400

  • Value ⇐ 800

  • Search space ⇐ 10^6967

  • No

  • Defined by us

Traveling salesman

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 chained variable

  • Entity ⇐ 980

  • Value ⇐ 980

  • Search space ⇐ 10^2504

Dinner party

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 variable

  • Entity ⇐ 144

  • Value ⇐ 72

  • Search space ⇐ 10^310

  • Unrealistic

  • Decision Table spreadsheet (XLS) for score constraints

Tennis club scheduling

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 variable

  • Entity ⇐ 72

  • Value ⇐ 7

  • Search space ⇐ 10^60

  • No

  • Defined by us

Meeting scheduling

  • 1 entity class

    • 2 variables

  • Entity ⇐ 10

  • Value ⇐ 320 and ⇐ 5

  • Search space ⇐ 10^320

  • No

  • Defined by us

Course timetabling

  • 1 entity class

    • 2 variables

  • Entity ⇐ 434

  • Value ⇐ 25 and ⇐ 20

  • Search space ⇐ 10^1171

Machine reassignment

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 variable

  • Entity ⇐ 50000

  • Value ⇐ 5000

  • Search space ⇐ 10^184948

Vehicle routing

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 chained variable

  • 1 shadow entity class

    • 1 automatic shadow variable

  • Entity ⇐ 2740

  • Value ⇐ 2795

  • Search space ⇐ 10^8380

Vehicle routing with time windows

  • All of Vehicle routing

  • 1 shadow variable

  • Entity ⇐ 2740

  • Value ⇐ 2795

  • Search space ⇐ 10^8380

Project job scheduling

  • 1 entity class

    • 2 variables

    • 1 shadow variable

  • Entity ⇐ 640

  • Value ⇐ ? and ⇐ ?

  • Search space ⇐ ?

Hospital bed planning

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 nullable variable

  • Entity ⇐ 2750

  • Value ⇐ 471

  • Search space ⇐ 10^6851

Task assigning

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 chained variable

    • 1 shadow variable

  • 1 shadow entity class

    • 1 automatic shadow variable

  • Entity ⇐ 500

  • Value ⇐ 520

  • Search space ⇐ 10^1168

  • No

  • Defined by us

Exam timetabling

  • 2 entity classes (same hierarchy)

    • 2 variables

  • Entity ⇐ 1096

  • Value ⇐ 80 and ⇐ 49

  • Search space ⇐ 10^3374

Nurse rostering

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 variable

  • Entity ⇐ 752

  • Value ⇐ 50

  • Search space ⇐ 10^1277

Traveling tournament

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 variable

  • Entity ⇐ 1560

  • Value ⇐ 78

  • Search space ⇐ 10^2301

  • Unrealistic

  • TTP

Cheap time scheduling

  • 1 entity class

    • 2 variables

  • Entity ⇐ 500

  • Value ⇐ 100 and ⇐ 288

  • Search space ⇐ 10^20078

Investment

  • 1 entity class

  • 1 variable

  • Entity ⇐ 11

  • Value = 1000

  • Search space ⇐ 10^4

  • No

  • Defined by us

Conference scheduling

  • 1 entity class

    • 2 variables

  • Entity ⇐ 216

  • Value ⇐ 18 and ⇐ 20

  • Search space ⇐ 10^552

  • No

  • Defined by us

Rock tour

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 chained variable

    • 4 shadow variables

  • 1 shadow entity class

    • 1 automatic shadow variable

  • Entity ⇐ 47

  • Value ⇐ 48

  • Search space ⇐ 10^59

  • No

  • Defined by us

Flight crew scheduling

  • 1 entity class

    • 1 variable

  • 1 shadow entity class

    • 1 automatic shadow variable

  • Entity ⇐ 4375

  • Value ⇐ 750

  • Search space ⇐ 10^12578

  • No

  • Defined by us

3.2. N Queens

3.2.1. Problem Description

Place n queens on a n sized chessboard so that no two queens can attack each other. The most common n queens puzzle is the eight queens puzzle, with n = 8:

nQueensScreenshot

Constraints:

  • Use a chessboard of n columns and n rows.

  • Place n queens on the chessboard.

  • No two queens can attack each other. A queen can attack any other queen on the same horizontal, vertical or diagonal line.

This documentation heavily uses the four queens puzzle as the primary example.

A proposed solution could be:

partiallySolvedNQueens04Explained
Figure 1. A Wrong Solution for the Four Queens Puzzle

The above solution is wrong because queens A1 and B0 can attack each other (so can queens B0 and D0). Removing queen B0 would respect the "no two queens can attack each other" constraint, but would break the "place n queens" constraint.

Below is a correct solution:

solvedNQueens04
Figure 2. A Correct Solution for the Four Queens Puzzle

All the constraints have been met, so the solution is correct.

Note that most n queens puzzles have multiple correct solutions. We will focus on finding a single correct solution for a given n, not on finding the number of possible correct solutions for a given n.

3.2.2. Problem Size

4queens   has   4 queens with a search space of    256.
8queens   has   8 queens with a search space of   10^7.
16queens  has  16 queens with a search space of  10^19.
32queens  has  32 queens with a search space of  10^48.
64queens  has  64 queens with a search space of 10^115.
256queens has 256 queens with a search space of 10^616.

The implementation of the n queens example has not been optimized because it functions as a beginner example. Nevertheless, it can easily handle 64 queens. With a few changes it has been shown to easily handle 5000 queens and more.

3.2.3. Domain Model

This example uses the domain model to solve the four queens problem.

  1. Creating a Domain Model A good domain model will make it easier to understand and solve your planning problem.

    This is the domain model for the n queens example:

    public class Column {
    
        private int index;
    
        // ... getters and setters
    }
    public class Row {
    
        private int index;
    
        // ... getters and setters
    }
    public class Queen {
    
        private Column column;
        private Row row;
    
        public int getAscendingDiagonalIndex() {...}
        public int getDescendingDiagonalIndex() {...}
    
        // ... getters and setters
    }
  2. Calculating the Search Space.

    A Queen instance has a Column (for example: 0 is column A, 1 is column B, …​) and a Row (its row, for example: 0 is row 0, 1 is row 1, …​).

    The ascending diagonal line and the descending diagonal line can be calculated based on the column and the row.

    The column and row indexes start from the upper left corner of the chessboard.

    public class NQueens {
    
        private int n;
        private List<Column> columnList;
        private List<Row> rowList;
    
        private List<Queen> queenList;
    
        private SimpleScore score;
    
        // ... getters and setters
    }
  3. Finding the Solution

    A single NQueens instance contains a list of all Queen instances. It is the Solution implementation which will be supplied to, solved by, and retrieved from the Solver.

Notice that in the four queens example, NQueens’s getN() method will always return four.

Table 3. A Solution for Four Queens Shown in the Domain Model
A solution Queen columnIndex rowIndex ascendingDiagonalIndex (columnIndex + rowIndex) descendingDiagonalIndex (columnIndex - rowIndex)
partiallySolvedNQueens04Explained

A1

0

1

1 (**)

-1

B0

1

0 (*)

1 (**)

1

C2

2

2

4

0

D0

3

0 (*)

3

3

When two queens share the same column, row or diagonal line, such as (*) and (**), they can attack each other.

3.3. Cloud Balancing

This example is explained in a tutorial.

3.4. Traveling Salesman (TSP - Traveling Salesman Problem)

3.4.1. Problem Description

Given a list of cities, find the shortest tour for a salesman that visits each city exactly once.

The problem is defined by Wikipedia. It is one of the most intensively studied problems in computational mathematics. Yet, in the real world, it is often only part of a planning problem, along with other constraints, such as employee shift rostering constraints.

3.4.2. Problem Size

dj38     has  38 cities with a search space of   10^43.
europe40 has  40 cities with a search space of   10^46.
st70     has  70 cities with a search space of   10^98.
pcb442   has 442 cities with a search space of  10^976.
lu980    has 980 cities with a search space of 10^2504.

3.4.3. Problem Difficulty

Despite TSP’s simple definition, the problem is surprisingly hard to solve. Because it is an NP-hard problem (like most planning problems), the optimal solution for a specific problem dataset can change a lot when that problem dataset is slightly altered:

tspOptimalSolutionVolatility

3.5. Dinner Party

3.5.1. Problem Description

Miss Manners is throwing another dinner party.

  • This time she invited 144 guests and prepared 12 round tables with 12 seats each.

  • Every guest should sit next to someone (left and right) of the opposite gender.

  • And that neighbour should have at least one hobby in common with the guest.

  • At every table, there should be two politicians, two doctors, two socialites, two coaches, two teachers and two programmers.

  • And the two politicians, two doctors, two coaches and two programmers should not be the same kind at a table.

Drools Expert also has the normal Miss Manners example (which is much smaller) and employs an exhaustive heuristic to solve it. Planner’s implementation is far more scalable because it uses heuristics to find the best solution and Drools Expert to calculate the score of each solution.

3.5.2. Problem Size

wedding01 has 18 jobs, 144 guests, 288 hobby practicians, 12 tables and 144 seats with a search space of 10^310.

3.6. Tennis Club Scheduling

3.6.1. Problem Description

Every week the tennis club has four teams playing round robin against each other. Assign those four spots to the teams fairly.

Hard constraints:

  • Conflict: A team can only play once per day.

  • Unavailability: Some teams are unavailable on some dates.

Medium constraints:

  • Fair assignment: All teams should play an (almost) equal number of times.

Soft constraints:

  • Evenly confrontation: Each team should play against every other team an equal number of times.

3.6.2. Problem Size

munich-7teams has 7 teams, 18 days, 12 unavailabilityPenalties and 72 teamAssignments with a search space of 10^60.

3.7. Meeting Scheduling

3.7.1. Problem Description

Assign each meeting to a starting time and a room. Meetings have different durations.

Hard constraints:

  • Room conflict: two meetings must not use the same room at the same time.

  • Required attendance: A person cannot have two required meetings at the same time.

  • Required room capacity: A meeting must not be in a room that doesn’t fit all of the meeting’s attendees.

  • Start and end on same day: A meeting shouldn’t be scheduled over multiple days.

Medium constraints:

  • Preferred attendance: A person cannot have two preferred meetings at the same time, nor a preferred and a required meeting at the same time.

Soft constraints:

  • Sooner rather than later: Schedule all meetings as soon as possible.

  • A break between meetings: Any two meetings should have at least one time grain break between them.

  • Overlapping meetings: To minimize the number of meetings in parallel so people don’t have to choose one meeting over the other.

  • Assign larger rooms first: If a larger room is available any meeting should be assigned to that room in order to accommodate as many people as possible even if they haven’t signed up to that meeting.

  • Room stability: If a person has two consecutive meetings with two or less time grains break between them they better be in the same room.

3.7.2. Problem Size

50meetings-160timegrains-5rooms  has  50 meetings, 160 timeGrains and 5 rooms with a search space of 10^145.
100meetings-320timegrains-5rooms has 100 meetings, 320 timeGrains and 5 rooms with a search space of 10^320.
200meetings-640timegrains-5rooms has 200 meetings, 640 timeGrains and 5 rooms with a search space of 10^701.
400meetings-1280timegrains-5rooms has 400 meetings, 1280 timeGrains and 5 rooms with a search space of 10^1522.
800meetings-2560timegrains-5rooms has 800 meetings, 2560 timeGrains and 5 rooms with a search space of 10^3285.

3.8. Course Timetabling (ITC 2007 Track 3 - Curriculum Course Scheduling)

3.8.1. Problem Description

Schedule each lecture into a timeslot and into a room.

Hard constraints:

  • Teacher conflict: A teacher must not have two lectures in the same period.

  • Curriculum conflict: A curriculum must not have two lectures in the same period.

  • Room occupancy: two lectures must not be in the same room in the same period.

  • Unavailable period (specified per dataset): A specific lecture must not be assigned to a specific period.

Soft constraints:

  • Room capacity: A room’s capacity should not be less than the number of students in its lecture.

  • Minimum working days: Lectures of the same course should be spread out into a minimum number of days.

  • Curriculum compactness: Lectures belonging to the same curriculum should be adjacent to each other (so in consecutive periods).

  • Room stability: Lectures of the same course should be assigned to the same room.

3.8.2. Problem Size

comp01 has 24 teachers,  14 curricula,  30 courses, 160 lectures, 30 periods,  6 rooms and   53 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^360.
comp02 has 71 teachers,  70 curricula,  82 courses, 283 lectures, 25 periods, 16 rooms and  513 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^736.
comp03 has 61 teachers,  68 curricula,  72 courses, 251 lectures, 25 periods, 16 rooms and  382 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^653.
comp04 has 70 teachers,  57 curricula,  79 courses, 286 lectures, 25 periods, 18 rooms and  396 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^758.
comp05 has 47 teachers, 139 curricula,  54 courses, 152 lectures, 36 periods,  9 rooms and  771 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^381.
comp06 has 87 teachers,  70 curricula, 108 courses, 361 lectures, 25 periods, 18 rooms and  632 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^957.
comp07 has 99 teachers,  77 curricula, 131 courses, 434 lectures, 25 periods, 20 rooms and  667 unavailable period constraints with a search space of 10^1171.
comp08 has 76 teachers,  61 curricula,  86 courses, 324 lectures, 25 periods, 18 rooms and  478 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^859.
comp09 has 68 teachers,  75 curricula,  76 courses, 279 lectures, 25 periods, 18 rooms and  405 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^740.
comp10 has 88 teachers,  67 curricula, 115 courses, 370 lectures, 25 periods, 18 rooms and  694 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^981.
comp11 has 24 teachers,  13 curricula,  30 courses, 162 lectures, 45 periods,  5 rooms and   94 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^381.
comp12 has 74 teachers, 150 curricula,  88 courses, 218 lectures, 36 periods, 11 rooms and 1368 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^566.
comp13 has 77 teachers,  66 curricula,  82 courses, 308 lectures, 25 periods, 19 rooms and  468 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^824.
comp14 has 68 teachers,  60 curricula,  85 courses, 275 lectures, 25 periods, 17 rooms and  486 unavailable period constraints with a search space of  10^722.

3.9. Machine Reassignment (Google ROADEF 2012)

3.9.1. Problem Description

Assign each process to a machine. All processes already have an original (unoptimized) assignment. Each process requires an amount of each resource (such as CPU, RAM, …​). This is a more complex version of the Cloud Balancing example.

Hard constraints:

  • Maximum capacity: The maximum capacity for each resource for each machine must not be exceeded.

  • Conflict: Processes of the same service must run on distinct machines.

  • Spread: Processes of the same service must be spread out across locations.

  • Dependency: The processes of a service depending on another service must run in the neighborhood of a process of the other service.

  • Transient usage: Some resources are transient and count towards the maximum capacity of both the original machine as the newly assigned machine.

Soft constraints:

  • Load: The safety capacity for each resource for each machine should not be exceeded.

  • Balance: Leave room for future assignments by balancing the available resources on each machine.

  • Process move cost: A process has a move cost.

  • Service move cost: A service has a move cost.

  • Machine move cost: Moving a process from machine A to machine B has another A-B specific move cost.

The problem is defined by the Google ROADEF/EURO Challenge 2012.

cloudOptimizationIsLikeTetris

3.9.3. Problem Size

model_a1_1 has  2 resources,  1 neighborhoods,   4 locations,    4 machines,    79 services,   100 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of     10^60.
model_a1_2 has  4 resources,  2 neighborhoods,   4 locations,  100 machines,   980 services,  1000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^2000.
model_a1_3 has  3 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  25 locations,  100 machines,   216 services,  1000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^2000.
model_a1_4 has  3 resources, 50 neighborhoods,  50 locations,   50 machines,   142 services,  1000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^1698.
model_a1_5 has  4 resources,  2 neighborhoods,   4 locations,   12 machines,   981 services,  1000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^1079.
model_a2_1 has  3 resources,  1 neighborhoods,   1 locations,  100 machines,  1000 services,  1000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^2000.
model_a2_2 has 12 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  25 locations,  100 machines,   170 services,  1000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^2000.
model_a2_3 has 12 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  25 locations,  100 machines,   129 services,  1000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^2000.
model_a2_4 has 12 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  25 locations,   50 machines,   180 services,  1000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^1698.
model_a2_5 has 12 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  25 locations,   50 machines,   153 services,  1000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of   10^1698.
model_b_1  has 12 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  10 locations,  100 machines,  2512 services,  5000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of  10^10000.
model_b_2  has 12 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  10 locations,  100 machines,  2462 services,  5000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of  10^10000.
model_b_3  has  6 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  10 locations,  100 machines, 15025 services, 20000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of  10^40000.
model_b_4  has  6 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  50 locations,  500 machines,  1732 services, 20000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of  10^53979.
model_b_5  has  6 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  10 locations,  100 machines, 35082 services, 40000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of  10^80000.
model_b_6  has  6 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  50 locations,  200 machines, 14680 services, 40000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of  10^92041.
model_b_7  has  6 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  50 locations, 4000 machines, 15050 services, 40000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of 10^144082.
model_b_8  has  3 resources,  5 neighborhoods,  10 locations,  100 machines, 45030 services, 50000 processes and 0 balancePenalties with a search space of 10^100000.
model_b_9  has  3 resources,  5 neighborhoods, 100 locations, 1000 machines,  4609 services, 50000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of 10^150000.
model_b_10 has  3 resources,  5 neighborhoods, 100 locations, 5000 machines,  4896 services, 50000 processes and 1 balancePenalties with a search space of 10^184948.

3.10. Vehicle Routing

3.10.1. Problem Description

Using a fleet of vehicles, pick up the objects of each customer and bring them to the depot. Each vehicle can service multiple customers, but it has a limited capacity.

vehicleRoutingUseCase

Besides the basic case (CVRP), there is also a variant with time windows (CVRPTW).

Hard constraints:

  • Vehicle capacity: a vehicle cannot carry more items then its capacity.

  • Time windows (only in CVRPTW):

    • Travel time: Traveling from one location to another takes time.

    • Customer service duration: a vehicle must stay at the customer for the length of the service duration.

    • Customer ready time: a vehicle may arrive before the customer’s ready time, but it must wait until the ready time before servicing.

    • Customer due time: a vehicle must arrive on time, before the customer’s due time.

Soft constraints:

  • Total distance: minimize the total distance driven (fuel consumption) of all vehicles.

The capacitated vehicle routing problem (CVRP) and its timewindowed variant (CVRPTW) are defined by the VRP web.

3.10.3. Problem Size

CVRP instances (without time windows):

belgium-n50-k10             has  1 depots, 10 vehicles and   49 customers with a search space of   10^74.
belgium-n100-k10            has  1 depots, 10 vehicles and   99 customers with a search space of  10^170.
belgium-n500-k20            has  1 depots, 20 vehicles and  499 customers with a search space of 10^1168.
belgium-n1000-k20           has  1 depots, 20 vehicles and  999 customers with a search space of 10^2607.
belgium-n2750-k55           has  1 depots, 55 vehicles and 2749 customers with a search space of 10^8380.
belgium-road-km-n50-k10     has  1 depots, 10 vehicles and   49 customers with a search space of   10^74.
belgium-road-km-n100-k10    has  1 depots, 10 vehicles and   99 customers with a search space of  10^170.
belgium-road-km-n500-k20    has  1 depots, 20 vehicles and  499 customers with a search space of 10^1168.
belgium-road-km-n1000-k20   has  1 depots, 20 vehicles and  999 customers with a search space of 10^2607.
belgium-road-km-n2750-k55   has  1 depots, 55 vehicles and 2749 customers with a search space of 10^8380.
belgium-road-time-n50-k10   has  1 depots, 10 vehicles and   49 customers with a search space of   10^74.
belgium-road-time-n100-k10  has  1 depots, 10 vehicles and   99 customers with a search space of  10^170.
belgium-road-time-n500-k20  has  1 depots, 20 vehicles and  499 customers with a search space of 10^1168.
belgium-road-time-n1000-k20 has  1 depots, 20 vehicles and  999 customers with a search space of 10^2607.
belgium-road-time-n2750-k55 has  1 depots, 55 vehicles and 2749 customers with a search space of 10^8380.
belgium-d2-n50-k10          has  2 depots, 10 vehicles and   48 customers with a search space of   10^74.
belgium-d3-n100-k10         has  3 depots, 10 vehicles and   97 customers with a search space of  10^170.
belgium-d5-n500-k20         has  5 depots, 20 vehicles and  495 customers with a search space of 10^1168.
belgium-d8-n1000-k20        has  8 depots, 20 vehicles and  992 customers with a search space of 10^2607.
belgium-d10-n2750-k55       has 10 depots, 55 vehicles and 2740 customers with a search space of 10^8380.

A-n32-k5  has 1 depots,  5 vehicles and  31 customers with a search space of  10^40.
A-n33-k5  has 1 depots,  5 vehicles and  32 customers with a search space of  10^41.
A-n33-k6  has 1 depots,  6 vehicles and  32 customers with a search space of  10^42.
A-n34-k5  has 1 depots,  5 vehicles and  33 customers with a search space of  10^43.
A-n36-k5  has 1 depots,  5 vehicles and  35 customers with a search space of  10^46.
A-n37-k5  has 1 depots,  5 vehicles and  36 customers with a search space of  10^48.
A-n37-k6  has 1 depots,  6 vehicles and  36 customers with a search space of  10^49.
A-n38-k5  has 1 depots,  5 vehicles and  37 customers with a search space of  10^49.
A-n39-k5  has 1 depots,  5 vehicles and  38 customers with a search space of  10^51.
A-n39-k6  has 1 depots,  6 vehicles and  38 customers with a search space of  10^52.
A-n44-k7  has 1 depots,  7 vehicles and  43 customers with a search space of  10^61.
A-n45-k6  has 1 depots,  6 vehicles and  44 customers with a search space of  10^62.
A-n45-k7  has 1 depots,  7 vehicles and  44 customers with a search space of  10^63.
A-n46-k7  has 1 depots,  7 vehicles and  45 customers with a search space of  10^65.
A-n48-k7  has 1 depots,  7 vehicles and  47 customers with a search space of  10^68.
A-n53-k7  has 1 depots,  7 vehicles and  52 customers with a search space of  10^77.
A-n54-k7  has 1 depots,  7 vehicles and  53 customers with a search space of  10^79.
A-n55-k9  has 1 depots,  9 vehicles and  54 customers with a search space of  10^82.
A-n60-k9  has 1 depots,  9 vehicles and  59 customers with a search space of  10^91.
A-n61-k9  has 1 depots,  9 vehicles and  60 customers with a search space of  10^93.
A-n62-k8  has 1 depots,  8 vehicles and  61 customers with a search space of  10^94.
A-n63-k9  has 1 depots,  9 vehicles and  62 customers with a search space of  10^97.
A-n63-k10 has 1 depots, 10 vehicles and  62 customers with a search space of  10^98.
A-n64-k9  has 1 depots,  9 vehicles and  63 customers with a search space of  10^99.
A-n65-k9  has 1 depots,  9 vehicles and  64 customers with a search space of 10^101.
A-n69-k9  has 1 depots,  9 vehicles and  68 customers with a search space of 10^108.
A-n80-k10 has 1 depots, 10 vehicles and  79 customers with a search space of 10^130.
F-n45-k4  has 1 depots,  4 vehicles and  44 customers with a search space of  10^60.
F-n72-k4  has 1 depots,  4 vehicles and  71 customers with a search space of 10^108.
F-n135-k7 has 1 depots,  7 vehicles and 134 customers with a search space of 10^240.

CVRPTW instances (with time windows):

belgium-tw-d2-n50-k10    has  2 depots, 10 vehicles and   48 customers with a search space of   10^74.
belgium-tw-d3-n100-k10   has  3 depots, 10 vehicles and   97 customers with a search space of  10^170.
belgium-tw-d5-n500-k20   has  5 depots, 20 vehicles and  495 customers with a search space of 10^1168.
belgium-tw-d8-n1000-k20  has  8 depots, 20 vehicles and  992 customers with a search space of 10^2607.
belgium-tw-d10-n2750-k55 has 10 depots, 55 vehicles and 2740 customers with a search space of 10^8380.
belgium-tw-n50-k10       has  1 depots, 10 vehicles and   49 customers with a search space of   10^74.
belgium-tw-n100-k10      has  1 depots, 10 vehicles and   99 customers with a search space of  10^170.
belgium-tw-n500-k20      has  1 depots, 20 vehicles and  499 customers with a search space of 10^1168.
belgium-tw-n1000-k20     has  1 depots, 20 vehicles and  999 customers with a search space of 10^2607.
belgium-tw-n2750-k55     has  1 depots, 55 vehicles and 2749 customers with a search space of 10^8380.

Solomon_025_C101       has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and   25 customers with a search space of   10^40.
Solomon_025_C201       has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and   25 customers with a search space of   10^40.
Solomon_025_R101       has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and   25 customers with a search space of   10^40.
Solomon_025_R201       has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and   25 customers with a search space of   10^40.
Solomon_025_RC101      has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and   25 customers with a search space of   10^40.
Solomon_025_RC201      has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and   25 customers with a search space of   10^40.
Solomon_100_C101       has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and  100 customers with a search space of  10^185.
Solomon_100_C201       has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and  100 customers with a search space of  10^185.
Solomon_100_R101       has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and  100 customers with a search space of  10^185.
Solomon_100_R201       has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and  100 customers with a search space of  10^185.
Solomon_100_RC101      has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and  100 customers with a search space of  10^185.
Solomon_100_RC201      has 1 depots,  25 vehicles and  100 customers with a search space of  10^185.
Homberger_0200_C1_2_1  has 1 depots,  50 vehicles and  200 customers with a search space of  10^429.
Homberger_0200_C2_2_1  has 1 depots,  50 vehicles and  200 customers with a search space of  10^429.
Homberger_0200_R1_2_1  has 1 depots,  50 vehicles and  200 customers with a search space of  10^429.
Homberger_0200_R2_2_1  has 1 depots,  50 vehicles and  200 customers with a search space of  10^429.
Homberger_0200_RC1_2_1 has 1 depots,  50 vehicles and  200 customers with a search space of  10^429.
Homberger_0200_RC2_2_1 has 1 depots,  50 vehicles and  200 customers with a search space of  10^429.
Homberger_0400_C1_4_1  has 1 depots, 100 vehicles and  400 customers with a search space of  10^978.
Homberger_0400_C2_4_1  has 1 depots, 100 vehicles and  400 customers with a search space of  10^978.
Homberger_0400_R1_4_1  has 1 depots, 100 vehicles and  400 customers with a search space of  10^978.
Homberger_0400_R2_4_1  has 1 depots, 100 vehicles and  400 customers with a search space of  10^978.
Homberger_0400_RC1_4_1 has 1 depots, 100 vehicles and  400 customers with a search space of  10^978.
Homberger_0400_RC2_4_1 has 1 depots, 100 vehicles and  400 customers with a search space of  10^978.
Homberger_0600_C1_6_1  has 1 depots, 150 vehicles and  600 customers with a search space of 10^1571.
Homberger_0600_C2_6_1  has 1 depots, 150 vehicles and  600 customers with a search space of 10^1571.
Homberger_0600_R1_6_1  has 1 depots, 150 vehicles and  600 customers with a search space of 10^1571.
Homberger_0600_R2_6_1  has 1 depots, 150 vehicles and  600 customers with a search space of 10^1571.
Homberger_0600_RC1_6_1 has 1 depots, 150 vehicles and  600 customers with a search space of 10^1571.
Homberger_0600_RC2_6_1 has 1 depots, 150 vehicles and  600 customers with a search space of 10^1571.
Homberger_0800_C1_8_1  has 1 depots, 200 vehicles and  800 customers with a search space of 10^2195.
Homberger_0800_C2_8_1  has 1 depots, 200 vehicles and  800 customers with a search space of 10^2195.
Homberger_0800_R1_8_1  has 1 depots, 200 vehicles and  800 customers with a search space of 10^2195.
Homberger_0800_R2_8_1  has 1 depots, 200 vehicles and  800 customers with a search space of 10^2195.
Homberger_0800_RC1_8_1 has 1 depots, 200 vehicles and  800 customers with a search space of 10^2195.
Homberger_0800_RC2_8_1 has 1 depots, 200 vehicles and  800 customers with a search space of 10^2195.
Homberger_1000_C110_1  has 1 depots, 250 vehicles and 1000 customers with a search space of 10^2840.
Homberger_1000_C210_1  has 1 depots, 250 vehicles and 1000 customers with a search space of 10^2840.
Homberger_1000_R110_1  has 1 depots, 250 vehicles and 1000 customers with a search space of 10^2840.
Homberger_1000_R210_1  has 1 depots, 250 vehicles and 1000 customers with a search space of 10^2840.
Homberger_1000_RC110_1 has 1 depots, 250 vehicles and 1000 customers with a search space of 10^2840.
Homberger_1000_RC210_1 has 1 depots, 250 vehicles and 1000 customers with a search space of 10^2840.

3.10.4. Domain Model

vehicleRoutingClassDiagram

The vehicle routing with timewindows domain model makes heavily use of shadow variables. This allows it to express its constraints more naturally, because properties such as arrivalTime and departureTime, are directly available on the domain model.

3.10.4.1. Road Distances Instead of Air Distances

In the real world, vehicles cannot follow a straight line from location to location: they have to use roads and highways. From a business point of view, this matters a lot:

vehicleRoutingDistanceType

For the optimization algorithm, this does not matter much, as long as the distance between two points can be looked up (and are preferably precalculated). The road cost does not even need to be a distance, it can also be travel time, fuel cost, or a weighted function of those. There are several technologies available to precalculate road costs, such as GraphHopper (embeddable, offline Java engine), Open MapQuest (web service) and Google Maps Client API (web service).

integrationWithRealMaps

There are also several technologies to render it, such as Leaflet and Google Maps for developers: the optaplanner-webexamples-*.war has an example which demonstrates such rendering:

vehicleRoutingLeafletAndGoogleMaps

It is even possible to render the actual road routes with GraphHopper or Google Map Directions, but because of route overlaps on highways, it can become harder to see the standstill order:

vehicleRoutingGoogleMapsDirections

Take special care that the road costs between two points use the same optimization criteria as the one used in Planner. For example, GraphHopper etc will by default return the fastest route, not the shortest route. Don’t use the km (or miles) distances of the fastest GPS routes to optimize the shortest trip in Planner: this leads to a suboptimal solution as shown below:

roadDistanceTriangleInequality

Contrary to popular belief, most users do not want the shortest route: they want the fastest route instead. They prefer highways over normal roads. They prefer normal roads over dirt roads. In the real world, the fastest and shortest route are rarely the same.

3.11. Project Job Scheduling

3.11.1. Problem Description

Schedule all jobs in time and execution mode to minimize project delays. Each job is part of a project. A job can be executed in different ways: each way is an execution mode that implies a different duration but also different resource usages. This is a form of flexible job shop scheduling.

projectJobSchedulingUseCase

Hard constraints:

  • Job precedence: a job can only start when all its predecessor jobs are finished.

  • Resource capacity: do not use more resources than available.

    • Resources are local (shared between jobs of the same project) or global (shared between all jobs)

    • Resource are renewable (capacity available per day) or nonrenewable (capacity available for all days)

Medium constraints:

  • Total project delay: minimize the duration (makespan) of each project.

Soft constraints:

  • Total makespan: minimize the duration of the whole multi-project schedule.

The problem is defined by the MISTA 2013 challenge.

3.11.2. Problem Size

Schedule A-1  has  2 projects,  24 jobs,   64 execution modes,  7 resources and  150 resource requirements.
Schedule A-2  has  2 projects,  44 jobs,  124 execution modes,  7 resources and  420 resource requirements.
Schedule A-3  has  2 projects,  64 jobs,  184 execution modes,  7 resources and  630 resource requirements.
Schedule A-4  has  5 projects,  60 jobs,  160 execution modes, 16 resources and  390 resource requirements.
Schedule A-5  has  5 projects, 110 jobs,  310 execution modes, 16 resources and  900 resource requirements.
Schedule A-6  has  5 projects, 160 jobs,  460 execution modes, 16 resources and 1440 resource requirements.
Schedule A-7  has 10 projects, 120 jobs,  320 execution modes, 22 resources and  900 resource requirements.
Schedule A-8  has 10 projects, 220 jobs,  620 execution modes, 22 resources and 1860 resource requirements.
Schedule A-9  has 10 projects, 320 jobs,  920 execution modes, 31 resources and 2880 resource requirements.
Schedule A-10 has 10 projects, 320 jobs,  920 execution modes, 31 resources and 2970 resource requirements.
Schedule B-1  has 10 projects, 120 jobs,  320 execution modes, 31 resources and  900 resource requirements.
Schedule B-2  has 10 projects, 220 jobs,  620 execution modes, 22 resources and 1740 resource requirements.
Schedule B-3  has 10 projects, 320 jobs,  920 execution modes, 31 resources and 3060 resource requirements.
Schedule B-4  has 15 projects, 180 jobs,  480 execution modes, 46 resources and 1530 resource requirements.
Schedule B-5  has 15 projects, 330 jobs,  930 execution modes, 46 resources and 2760 resource requirements.
Schedule B-6  has 15 projects, 480 jobs, 1380 execution modes, 46 resources and 4500 resource requirements.
Schedule B-7  has 20 projects, 240 jobs,  640 execution modes, 61 resources and 1710 resource requirements.
Schedule B-8  has 20 projects, 440 jobs, 1240 execution modes, 42 resources and 3180 resource requirements.
Schedule B-9  has 20 projects, 640 jobs, 1840 execution modes, 61 resources and 5940 resource requirements.
Schedule B-10 has 20 projects, 460 jobs, 1300 execution modes, 42 resources and 4260 resource requirements.

3.12. Hospital Bed Planning (PAS - Patient Admission Scheduling)

3.12.1. Problem Description

Assign each patient (that will come to the hospital) into a bed for each night that the patient will stay in the hospital. Each bed belongs to a room and each room belongs to a department. The arrival and departure dates of the patients is fixed: only a bed needs to be assigned for each night.

This problem features overconstrained datasets.

patientAdmissionScheduleUseCase

Hard constraints:

  • Two patients must not be assigned to the same bed in the same night. Weight: -1000hard * conflictNightCount.

  • A room can have a gender limitation: only females, only males, the same gender in the same night or no gender limitation at all. Weight: -50hard * nightCount.

  • A department can have a minimum or maximum age. Weight: -100hard * nightCount.

  • A patient can require a room with specific equipment(s). Weight: -50hard * nightCount.

Medium constraints:

  • Assign every patient to a bed, unless the dataset is overconstrained. Weight: -1medium * nightCount.

Soft constraints:

  • A patient can prefer a maximum room size, for example if he/she wants a single room. Weight: -8soft * nightCount.

  • A patient is best assigned to a department that specializes in his/her problem. Weight: -10soft * nightCount.

  • A patient is best assigned to a room that specializes in his/her problem. Weight: -20soft * nightCount.

    • That room speciality should be priority 1. Weight: -10soft * (priority - 1) * nightCount.

  • A patient can prefer a room with specific equipment(s). Weight: -20soft * nightCount.

The problem is a variant on Kaho’s Patient Scheduling and the datasets come from real world hospitals.

3.12.2. Problem Size

testdata01 has 4 specialisms, 2 equipments, 4 departments,  98 rooms, 286 beds, 14 nights,  652 patients and  652 admissions with a search space of 10^1601.
testdata02 has 6 specialisms, 2 equipments, 6 departments, 151 rooms, 465 beds, 14 nights,  755 patients and  755 admissions with a search space of 10^2013.
testdata03 has 5 specialisms, 2 equipments, 5 departments, 131 rooms, 395 beds, 14 nights,  708 patients and  708 admissions with a search space of 10^1838.
testdata04 has 6 specialisms, 2 equipments, 6 departments, 155 rooms, 471 beds, 14 nights,  746 patients and  746 admissions with a search space of 10^1994.
testdata05 has 4 specialisms, 2 equipments, 4 departments, 102 rooms, 325 beds, 14 nights,  587 patients and  587 admissions with a search space of 10^1474.
testdata06 has 4 specialisms, 2 equipments, 4 departments, 104 rooms, 313 beds, 14 nights,  685 patients and  685 admissions with a search space of 10^1709.
testdata07 has 6 specialisms, 4 equipments, 6 departments, 162 rooms, 472 beds, 14 nights,  519 patients and  519 admissions with a search space of 10^1387.
testdata08 has 6 specialisms, 4 equipments, 6 departments, 148 rooms, 441 beds, 21 nights,  895 patients and  895 admissions with a search space of 10^2366.
testdata09 has 4 specialisms, 4 equipments, 4 departments, 105 rooms, 310 beds, 28 nights, 1400 patients and 1400 admissions with a search space of 10^3487.
testdata10 has 4 specialisms, 4 equipments, 4 departments, 104 rooms, 308 beds, 56 nights, 1575 patients and 1575 admissions with a search space of 10^3919.
testdata11 has 4 specialisms, 4 equipments, 4 departments, 107 rooms, 318 beds, 91 nights, 2514 patients and 2514 admissions with a search space of 10^6291.
testdata12 has 4 specialisms, 4 equipments, 4 departments, 105 rooms, 310 beds, 84 nights, 2750 patients and 2750 admissions with a search space of 10^6851.
testdata13 has 5 specialisms, 4 equipments, 5 departments, 125 rooms, 368 beds, 28 nights,  907 patients and 1109 admissions with a search space of 10^2845.

3.13. Task assigning

3.13.1. Problem Description

Assign each task to a spot in an employee’s queue. Each task has a duration which is affected by the employee’s affinity level with the task’s customer.

Hard constraints:

  • Skill: Each task requires one or more skills. The employee must posses all these skills.

Soft level 0 constraints:

  • Critical tasks: Complete critical tasks first, sooner than major and minor tasks.

Soft level 1 constraints:

  • Minimize makespan: Reduce the time to complete all tasks.

    • Start with the longest working employee first, then the second longest working employee and so forth, to creates fairness and load balancing.

Soft level 2 constraints:

  • Major tasks: Complete major tasks as soon as possible, sooner than minor tasks.

Soft level 3 constraints:

  • Minor tasks: Complete minor tasks as soon as possible.

3.13.3. Problem Size

24tasks-8employees   has  24 tasks, 6 skills,  8 employees,   4 task types and  4 customers with a search space of   10^30.
50tasks-5employees   has  50 tasks, 5 skills,  5 employees,  10 task types and 10 customers with a search space of   10^69.
100tasks-5employees  has 100 tasks, 5 skills,  5 employees,  20 task types and 15 customers with a search space of  10^164.
500tasks-20employees has 500 tasks, 6 skills, 20 employees, 100 task types and 60 customers with a search space of 10^1168.

3.14. Exam Timetabling (ITC 2007 track 1 - Examination)

3.14.1. Problem Description

Schedule each exam into a period and into a room. Multiple exams can share the same room during the same period.

examinationTimetablingUseCase

Hard constraints:

  • Exam conflict: two exams that share students must not occur in the same period.

  • Room capacity: A room’s seating capacity must suffice at all times.

  • Period duration: A period’s duration must suffice for all of its exams.

  • Period related hard constraints (specified per dataset):

    • Coincidence: two specified exams must use the same period (but possibly another room).

    • Exclusion: two specified exams must not use the same period.

    • After: A specified exam must occur in a period after another specified exam’s period.

  • Room related hard constraints (specified per dataset):

    • Exclusive: one specified exam should not have to share its room with any other exam.

Soft constraints (each of which has a parametrized penalty):

  • The same student should not have two exams in a row.

  • The same student should not have two exams on the same day.

  • Period spread: two exams that share students should be a number of periods apart.

  • Mixed durations: two exams that share a room should not have different durations.

  • Front load: Large exams should be scheduled earlier in the schedule.

  • Period penalty (specified per dataset): Some periods have a penalty when used.

  • Room penalty (specified per dataset): Some rooms have a penalty when used.

It uses large test data sets of real-life universities.

The problem is defined by the International Timetabling Competition 2007 track 1. Geoffrey De Smet finished 4th in that competition with a very early version of Planner. Many improvements have been made since then.

3.14.2. Problem Size

exam_comp_set1 has  7883 students,  607 exams, 54 periods,  7 rooms,  12 period constraints and  0 room constraints with a search space of 10^1564.
exam_comp_set2 has 12484 students,  870 exams, 40 periods, 49 rooms,  12 period constraints and  2 room constraints with a search space of 10^2864.
exam_comp_set3 has 16365 students,  934 exams, 36 periods, 48 rooms, 168 period constraints and 15 room constraints with a search space of 10^3023.
exam_comp_set4 has  4421 students,  273 exams, 21 periods,  1 rooms,  40 period constraints and  0 room constraints with a search space of  10^360.
exam_comp_set5 has  8719 students, 1018 exams, 42 periods,  3 rooms,  27 period constraints and  0 room constraints with a search space of 10^2138.
exam_comp_set6 has  7909 students,  242 exams, 16 periods,  8 rooms,  22 period constraints and  0 room constraints with a search space of  10^509.
exam_comp_set7 has 13795 students, 1096 exams, 80 periods, 15 rooms,  28 period constraints and  0 room constraints with a search space of 10^3374.
exam_comp_set8 has  7718 students,  598 exams, 80 periods,  8 rooms,  20 period constraints and  1 room constraints with a search space of 10^1678.

3.14.3. Domain Model

Below you can see the main examination domain classes:

examinationDomainDiagram
Figure 3. Examination Domain Class Diagram

Notice that we’ve split up the exam concept into an Exam class and a Topic class. The Exam instances change during solving (this is the planning entity class), when their period or room property changes. The Topic, Period and Room instances never change during solving (these are problem facts, just like some other classes).

3.15. Nurse Rostering (INRC 2010)

3.15.1. Problem Description

For each shift, assign a nurse to work that shift.

employeeShiftRosteringUseCase

Hard constraints:

  • No unassigned shifts (built-in): Every shift need to be assigned to an employee.

  • Shift conflict: An employee can have only one shift per day.

Soft constraints:

  • Contract obligations. The business frequently violates these, so they decided to define these as soft constraints instead of hard constraints.

    • Minimum and maximum assignments: Each employee needs to work more than x shifts and less than y shifts (depending on their contract).

    • Minimum and maximum consecutive working days: Each employee needs to work between x and y days in a row (depending on their contract).

    • Minimum and maximum consecutive free days: Each employee needs to be free between x and y days in a row (depending on their contract).

    • Minimum and maximum consecutive working weekends: Each employee needs to work between x and y weekends in a row (depending on their contract).

    • Complete weekends: Each employee needs to work every day in a weekend or not at all.

    • Identical shift types during weekend: Each weekend shift for the same weekend of the same employee must be the same shift type.

    • Unwanted patterns: A combination of unwanted shift types in a row. For example: a late shift followed by an early shift followed by a late shift.

  • Employee wishes:

    • Day on request: An employee wants to work on a specific day.

    • Day off request: An employee does not want to work on a specific day.

    • Shift on request: An employee wants to be assigned to a specific shift.

    • Shift off request: An employee does not want to be assigned to a specific shift.

  • Alternative skill: An employee assigned to a skill should have a proficiency in every skill required by that shift.

3.15.3. Problem Size

There are three dataset types:

  • sprint: must be solved in seconds.

  • medium: must be solved in minutes.

  • long: must be solved in hours.

toy1          has 1 skills, 3 shiftTypes, 2 patterns, 1 contracts,  6 employees,  7 shiftDates,  35 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of   10^27.
toy2          has 1 skills, 3 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 2 contracts, 20 employees, 28 shiftDates, 180 shiftAssignments and 140 requests with a search space of  10^234.

sprint01      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint02      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint03      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint04      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint05      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint06      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint07      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint08      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint09      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint10      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 4 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_hint01 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 8 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_hint02 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_hint03 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 8 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_late01 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 8 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_late02 has 1 skills, 3 shiftTypes, 4 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 144 shiftAssignments and 139 requests with a search space of  10^144.
sprint_late03 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 8 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 160 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^160.
sprint_late04 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 8 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 160 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^160.
sprint_late05 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 8 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_late06 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_late07 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_late08 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_late09 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of  10^152.
sprint_late10 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 3 contracts, 10 employees, 28 shiftDates, 152 shiftAssignments and 150 requests with a search space of  10^152.

medium01      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 4 contracts, 31 employees, 28 shiftDates, 608 shiftAssignments and 403 requests with a search space of  10^906.
medium02      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 4 contracts, 31 employees, 28 shiftDates, 608 shiftAssignments and 403 requests with a search space of  10^906.
medium03      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 4 contracts, 31 employees, 28 shiftDates, 608 shiftAssignments and 403 requests with a search space of  10^906.
medium04      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 4 contracts, 31 employees, 28 shiftDates, 608 shiftAssignments and 403 requests with a search space of  10^906.
medium05      has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 4 contracts, 31 employees, 28 shiftDates, 608 shiftAssignments and 403 requests with a search space of  10^906.
medium_hint01 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 4 contracts, 30 employees, 28 shiftDates, 428 shiftAssignments and 390 requests with a search space of  10^632.
medium_hint02 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 3 contracts, 30 employees, 28 shiftDates, 428 shiftAssignments and 390 requests with a search space of  10^632.
medium_hint03 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 4 contracts, 30 employees, 28 shiftDates, 428 shiftAssignments and 390 requests with a search space of  10^632.
medium_late01 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 4 contracts, 30 employees, 28 shiftDates, 424 shiftAssignments and 390 requests with a search space of  10^626.
medium_late02 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 3 contracts, 30 employees, 28 shiftDates, 428 shiftAssignments and 390 requests with a search space of  10^632.
medium_late03 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 0 patterns, 4 contracts, 30 employees, 28 shiftDates, 428 shiftAssignments and 390 requests with a search space of  10^632.
medium_late04 has 1 skills, 4 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 3 contracts, 30 employees, 28 shiftDates, 416 shiftAssignments and 390 requests with a search space of  10^614.
medium_late05 has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 4 contracts, 30 employees, 28 shiftDates, 452 shiftAssignments and 390 requests with a search space of  10^667.

long01        has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 3 contracts, 49 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and 735 requests with a search space of 10^1250.
long02        has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 3 contracts, 49 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and 735 requests with a search space of 10^1250.
long03        has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 3 contracts, 49 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and 735 requests with a search space of 10^1250.
long04        has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 3 contracts, 49 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and 735 requests with a search space of 10^1250.
long05        has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 3 patterns, 3 contracts, 49 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and 735 requests with a search space of 10^1250.
long_hint01   has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 9 patterns, 3 contracts, 50 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of 10^1257.
long_hint02   has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 3 contracts, 50 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of 10^1257.
long_hint03   has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 7 patterns, 3 contracts, 50 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of 10^1257.
long_late01   has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 9 patterns, 3 contracts, 50 employees, 28 shiftDates, 752 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of 10^1277.
long_late02   has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 9 patterns, 4 contracts, 50 employees, 28 shiftDates, 752 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of 10^1277.
long_late03   has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 9 patterns, 3 contracts, 50 employees, 28 shiftDates, 752 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of 10^1277.
long_late04   has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 9 patterns, 4 contracts, 50 employees, 28 shiftDates, 752 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of 10^1277.
long_late05   has 2 skills, 5 shiftTypes, 9 patterns, 3 contracts, 50 employees, 28 shiftDates, 740 shiftAssignments and   0 requests with a search space of 10^1257.

3.16. Traveling Tournament Problem (TTP)

3.16.1. Problem Description

Schedule matches between n teams.

travelingTournamentUseCase

Hard constraints:

  • Each team plays twice against every other team: once home and once away.

  • Each team has exactly one match on each timeslot.

  • No team must have more than three consecutive home or three consecutive away matches.

  • No repeaters: no two consecutive matches of the same two opposing teams.

Soft constraints:

  • Minimize the total distance traveled by all teams.

3.16.2. Problem Size

1-nl04     has  6 days,  4 teams and   12 matches with a search space of    10^5.
1-nl06     has 10 days,  6 teams and   30 matches with a search space of   10^19.
1-nl08     has 14 days,  8 teams and   56 matches with a search space of   10^43.
1-nl10     has 18 days, 10 teams and   90 matches with a search space of   10^79.
1-nl12     has 22 days, 12 teams and  132 matches with a search space of  10^126.
1-nl14     has 26 days, 14 teams and  182 matches with a search space of  10^186.
1-nl16     has 30 days, 16 teams and  240 matches with a search space of  10^259.
2-bra24    has 46 days, 24 teams and  552 matches with a search space of  10^692.
3-nfl16    has 30 days, 16 teams and  240 matches with a search space of  10^259.
3-nfl18    has 34 days, 18 teams and  306 matches with a search space of  10^346.
3-nfl20    has 38 days, 20 teams and  380 matches with a search space of  10^447.
3-nfl22    has 42 days, 22 teams and  462 matches with a search space of  10^562.
3-nfl24    has 46 days, 24 teams and  552 matches with a search space of  10^692.
3-nfl26    has 50 days, 26 teams and  650 matches with a search space of  10^838.
3-nfl28    has 54 days, 28 teams and  756 matches with a search space of  10^999.
3-nfl30    has 58 days, 30 teams and  870 matches with a search space of 10^1175.
3-nfl32    has 62 days, 32 teams and  992 matches with a search space of 10^1367.
4-super04  has  6 days,  4 teams and   12 matches with a search space of    10^5.
4-super06  has 10 days,  6 teams and   30 matches with a search space of   10^19.
4-super08  has 14 days,  8 teams and   56 matches with a search space of   10^43.
4-super10  has 18 days, 10 teams and   90 matches with a search space of   10^79.
4-super12  has 22 days, 12 teams and  132 matches with a search space of  10^126.
4-super14  has 26 days, 14 teams and  182 matches with a search space of  10^186.
5-galaxy04 has  6 days,  4 teams and   12 matches with a search space of    10^5.
5-galaxy06 has 10 days,  6 teams and   30 matches with a search space of   10^19.
5-galaxy08 has 14 days,  8 teams and   56 matches with a search space of   10^43.
5-galaxy10 has 18 days, 10 teams and   90 matches with a search space of   10^79.
5-galaxy12 has 22 days, 12 teams and  132 matches with a search space of  10^126.
5-galaxy14 has 26 days, 14 teams and  182 matches with a search space of  10^186.
5-galaxy16 has 30 days, 16 teams and  240 matches with a search space of  10^259.
5-galaxy18 has 34 days, 18 teams and  306 matches with a search space of  10^346.
5-galaxy20 has 38 days, 20 teams and  380 matches with a search space of  10^447.
5-galaxy22 has 42 days, 22 teams and  462 matches with a search space of  10^562.
5-galaxy24 has 46 days, 24 teams and  552 matches with a search space of  10^692.
5-galaxy26 has 50 days, 26 teams and  650 matches with a search space of  10^838.
5-galaxy28 has 54 days, 28 teams and  756 matches with a search space of  10^999.
5-galaxy30 has 58 days, 30 teams and  870 matches with a search space of 10^1175.
5-galaxy32 has 62 days, 32 teams and  992 matches with a search space of 10^1367.
5-galaxy34 has 66 days, 34 teams and 1122 matches with a search space of 10^1576.
5-galaxy36 has 70 days, 36 teams and 1260 matches with a search space of 10^1801.
5-galaxy38 has 74 days, 38 teams and 1406 matches with a search space of 10^2042.
5-galaxy40 has 78 days, 40 teams and 1560 matches with a search space of 10^2301.

3.17. Cheap Time Scheduling

3.17.1. Problem Description

Schedule all tasks in time and on a machine to minimize power cost. Power prices differs in time. This is a form of job shop scheduling.

Hard constraints:

  • Start time limits: each task must start between its earliest start and latest start limit.

  • Maximum capacity: the maximum capacity for each resource for each machine must not be exceeded.

  • Startup and shutdown: each machine must be active in the periods during which it has assigned tasks. Between tasks it is allowed to be idle to avoid startup and shutdown costs.

Medium constraints:

  • Power cost: minimize the total power cost of the whole schedule.

    • Machine power cost: Each active or idle machine consumes power, which infers a power cost (depending on the power price during that time).

    • Task power cost: Each task consumes power too, which infers a power cost (depending on the power price during its time).

    • Machine startup and shutdown cost: Every time a machine starts up or shuts down, an extra cost is inflicted.

Soft constraints (addendum to the original problem definition):

  • Start early: prefer starting a task sooner rather than later.

The problem is defined by the ICON challenge.

3.17.2. Problem Size

sample01   has 3 resources,   2 machines, 288 periods and   25 tasks with a search space of    10^53.
sample02   has 3 resources,   2 machines, 288 periods and   50 tasks with a search space of   10^114.
sample03   has 3 resources,   2 machines, 288 periods and  100 tasks with a search space of   10^226.
sample04   has 3 resources,   5 machines, 288 periods and  100 tasks with a search space of   10^266.
sample05   has 3 resources,   2 machines, 288 periods and  250 tasks with a search space of   10^584.
sample06   has 3 resources,   5 machines, 288 periods and  250 tasks with a search space of   10^673.
sample07   has 3 resources,   2 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^2388.
sample08   has 3 resources,   5 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^2748.
sample09   has 4 resources,  20 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^6668.
instance00 has 1 resources,  10 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^595.
instance01 has 1 resources,  10 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^599.
instance02 has 1 resources,  10 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^599.
instance03 has 1 resources,  10 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^591.
instance04 has 1 resources,  10 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^590.
instance05 has 2 resources,  25 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^667.
instance06 has 2 resources,  25 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^660.
instance07 has 2 resources,  25 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^662.
instance08 has 2 resources,  25 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^651.
instance09 has 2 resources,  25 machines, 288 periods and  200 tasks with a search space of   10^659.
instance10 has 2 resources,  20 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1657.
instance11 has 2 resources,  20 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1644.
instance12 has 2 resources,  20 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1637.
instance13 has 2 resources,  20 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1659.
instance14 has 2 resources,  20 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1643.
instance15 has 3 resources,  40 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1782.
instance16 has 3 resources,  40 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1778.
instance17 has 3 resources,  40 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1764.
instance18 has 3 resources,  40 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1769.
instance19 has 3 resources,  40 machines, 288 periods and  500 tasks with a search space of  10^1778.
instance20 has 3 resources,  50 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3689.
instance21 has 3 resources,  50 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3678.
instance22 has 3 resources,  50 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3706.
instance23 has 3 resources,  50 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3676.
instance24 has 3 resources,  50 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3681.
instance25 has 3 resources,  60 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3774.
instance26 has 3 resources,  60 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3737.
instance27 has 3 resources,  60 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3744.
instance28 has 3 resources,  60 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3731.
instance29 has 3 resources,  60 machines, 288 periods and 1000 tasks with a search space of  10^3746.
instance30 has 4 resources,  70 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7718.
instance31 has 4 resources,  70 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7740.
instance32 has 4 resources,  70 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7686.
instance33 has 4 resources,  70 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7672.
instance34 has 4 resources,  70 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7695.
instance35 has 4 resources,  80 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7807.
instance36 has 4 resources,  80 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7814.
instance37 has 4 resources,  80 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7764.
instance38 has 4 resources,  80 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7736.
instance39 has 4 resources,  80 machines, 288 periods and 2000 tasks with a search space of  10^7783.
instance40 has 4 resources,  90 machines, 288 periods and 4000 tasks with a search space of 10^15976.
instance41 has 4 resources,  90 machines, 288 periods and 4000 tasks with a search space of 10^15935.
instance42 has 4 resources,  90 machines, 288 periods and 4000 tasks with a search space of 10^15887.
instance43 has 4 resources,  90 machines, 288 periods and 4000 tasks with a search space of 10^15896.
instance44 has 4 resources,  90 machines, 288 periods and 4000 tasks with a search space of 10^15885.
instance45 has 4 resources, 100 machines, 288 periods and 5000 tasks with a search space of 10^20173.
instance46 has 4 resources, 100 machines, 288 periods and 5000 tasks with a search space of 10^20132.
instance47 has 4 resources, 100 machines, 288 periods and 5000 tasks with a search space of 10^20126.
instance48 has 4 resources, 100 machines, 288 periods and 5000 tasks with a search space of 10^20110.
instance49 has 4 resources, 100 machines, 288 periods and 5000 tasks with a search space of 10^20078.

3.18. Investment Asset Class Allocation (Portfolio Optimization)

3.18.1. Problem Description

Decide the relative quantity to invest in each asset class.

Hard constraints:

  • Risk maximum: the total standard deviation must not be higher than the standard deviation maximum.

  • Region maximum: Each region has a quantity maximum.

  • Sector maximum: Each sector has a quantity maximum.

Soft constraints:

  • Maximize expected return.

3.18.2. Problem Size

de_smet_1 has 1 regions, 3 sectors and 11 asset classes with a search space of 10^4.
irrinki_1 has 2 regions, 3 sectors and 6 asset classes with a search space of 10^3.

Larger datasets have not been created or tested yet, but should not pose a problem. A good source of data is this Asset Correlation website.

3.19. Conference Scheduling

3.19.1. Problem Description

Assign each conference talk to a timeslot and a room, after the talks have been accepted.

conferenceSchedulingMilestonesTimeline

Timeslots can overlap. It reads/writes to/from an *.xlsx file that can be edited with LibreOffice or Excel.

conferenceSchedulingProblem

Built-in hard constraints:

  • Talk type of timeslot: The type of a talk must match the timeslot’s talk type.

  • Room unavailable timeslots: A talk’s room must be available during the talk’s timeslot.

Hard constraints (unless configured otherwise):

  • Room conflict: Two talks can’t use the same room during overlapping timeslots.

  • Speaker unavailable timeslots: Every talk’s speaker must be available during the talk’s timeslot.

  • Speaker conflict: Two talks can’t share a speaker during overlapping timeslots.

  • Talk prerequisite talks: A talk must be scheduled after all its prerequisite talks.

  • Talk mutually-exclusive-talks tags: Talks that share such tags must not be scheduled in overlapping timeslots.

  • Consecutive talks pause: A speaker who has more than one talk must have a break between them.

  • Generic purpose timeslot and room tags

    • Speaker required timeslot tags: If a speaker has a required timeslot tag, then all his/her talks must be assigned to a timeslot with that tag.

    • Speaker prohibited timeslot tags: If a speaker has a prohibited timeslot tag, then all his/her talks cannot be assigned to a timeslot with that tag.

    • Talk required timeslot tags: If a talk has a required timeslot tag, then it must be assigned to a timeslot with that tag.

    • Talk prohibited timeslot tags: If a talk has a prohibited timeslot tag, then it cannot be assigned to a timeslot with that tag.

    • Speaker required room tags: If a speaker has a required room tag, then all his/her talks must be assigned to a room with that tag.

    • Speaker prohibited room tags: If a speaker has a prohibited room tag, then all his/her talks cannot be assigned to a room with that tag.

    • Talk required room tags: If a talk has a required room tag, then it must be assigned to a room with that tag.

    • Talk prohibited room tags: If a talk has a prohibited room tag, then it cannot be assigned to a room with that tag.

Medium constraints (unless configured otherwise):

  • Published timeslot: A published talk must not be scheduled at a different timeslot than currently published. If a hard constraint’s input data changes after publishing (such as speaker unavailability), then this medium constraint will be minimally broken to attain a new feasible solution.

Soft constraints (unless configured otherwise):

  • Published room: Minimize the number of talks scheduled in different rooms than published ones.

  • Theme track conflict: Minimize the number of talks that share a same theme tag during overlapping timeslots.

  • Theme track room stability: Talks with common theme track tag should be scheduled in the same room throughout the day.

  • Sector conflict: Minimize the number of talks that share a same sector tag during overlapping timeslots.

  • Content audience level flow violation: For every content tag, schedule the introductory talks before the advanced talks.

  • Audience level diversity: For every timeslot, maximize the number of talks with a different audience level.

  • Language diversity: For every timeslot, maximize the number of talks with a different language.

  • Same day talks: All talks that share a theme track tag or content tag should be scheduled in the minimum number of days (ideally in the same day).

  • Popular talks: Talks with higher favoriteCount should be scheduled in larger rooms.

  • Crowd control: Talks with higher crowdControlRisk should be scheduled in pairs at the same timeslot to avoid having most participants going to the same room.

  • Generic purpose timeslot and room tags

    • Speaker preferred timeslot tag: If a speaker has a preferred timeslot tag, then all his/her talks should be assigned to a timeslot with that tag.

    • Speaker undesired timeslot tag: If a speaker has a undesired timeslot tag, then all his/her talks should not be assigned to a timeslot with that tag.

    • Talk preferred timeslot tag: If a talk has a preferred timeslot tag, then it should be assigned to a timeslot with that tag.

    • Talk undesired timeslot tag: If a talk has a undesired timeslot tag, then it should not be assigned to a timeslot with that tag.

    • Speaker preferred room tag: If a speaker has a preferred room tag, then all his/her talks should be assigned to a room with that tag.

    • Speaker undesired room tag: If a speaker has a undesired room tag, then all his/her talks should not be assigned to a room with that tag.

    • Talk preferred room tag: If a talk has a preferred room tag, then it should be assigned to a room with that tag.

    • Talk undesired room tag: If a talk has a undesired room tag, then it should not be assigned to a room with that tag.

Every constraint can be configured to use a different score level (hard/medium/soft) or a different score weight.

conferenceSchedulingConstraints

3.19.3. Problem Size

18talks-6timeslots-5rooms    has  18 talks,  6 timeslots and  5 rooms with a search space of  10^26.
36talks-12timeslots-5rooms   has  36 talks, 12 timeslots and  5 rooms with a search space of  10^64.
72talks-12timeslots-10rooms  has  72 talks, 12 timeslots and 10 rooms with a search space of 10^149.
108talks-18timeslots-10rooms has 108 talks, 18 timeslots and 10 rooms with a search space of 10^243.
216talks-18timeslots-20rooms has 216 talks, 18 timeslots and 20 rooms with a search space of 10^552.

3.20. Rock Tour

3.20.1. Problem Description

Drive the rock bus from show to show, but schedule shows only on available days.

Hard constraints:

  • Schedule every required show.

  • Schedule as many shows as possible.

Medium constraints:

  • Maximize revenue opportunity.

  • Minimize driving time.

  • Visit sooner than later.

Soft constraints:

  • Avoid long driving times.

3.20.2. Problem Size

47shows has 47 shows with a search space of 10^59.

3.21. Flight Crew Scheduling

3.21.1. Problem Description

Assign flights to pilots and flight attendants.

Hard constraints:

  • Required skill: each flight assignment has a required skill. For example, flight AB0001 requires 2 pilots and 3 flight attendants.

  • Flight conflict: each employee can only attend one flight at the same time

  • Transfer between two flights: between two flights, an employee must be able to transfer from the arrival airport to the departure airport. For example, Ann arrives in Brussels at 10:00 and departs in Amsterdam at 15:00.

  • Employee unavailability: the employee must be available on the day of the flight. For example, Ann is on PTO on 1-Feb.

Soft constraints:

  • First assignment departing from home

  • Last assignment arriving at home

  • Load balance flight duration total per employee

3.21.2. Problem Size

175flights-7days-Europe  has 2 skills, 50 airports, 150 employees, 175 flights and  875 flight assignments with a search space of  10^1904.
700flights-28days-Europe has 2 skills, 50 airports, 150 employees, 700 flights and 3500 flight assignments with a search space of  10^7616.
875flights-7days-Europe  has 2 skills, 50 airports, 750 employees, 875 flights and 4375 flight assignments with a search space of 10^12578.
175flights-7days-US      has 2 skills, 48 airports, 150 employees, 175 flights and  875 flight assignments with a search space of  10^1904.

4. Planner Configuration

4.1. Overview

Solving a planning problem with Planner consists of the following steps:

  1. Model your planning problem as a class that implements the interface Solution, for example the class NQueens.

  2. Configure a Solver, for example a First Fit and Tabu Search solver for any NQueens instance.

  3. Load a problem data set from your data layer, for example a Four Queens instance. That is the planning problem.

  4. Solve it with Solver.solve(problem) which returns the best solution found.

inputOutputOverview

4.2. Solver Configuration

4.2.1. Solver Configuration by XML

Build a Solver instance with the SolverFactory. Configure the SolverFactory with a solver configuration XML file, provided as a classpath resource (as defined by ClassLoader.getResource()):

       SolverFactory<NQueens> solverFactory = SolverFactory.createFromXmlResource(
               "org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nqueensSolverConfig.xml");
       Solver<NQueens> solver = solverFactory.buildSolver();

In a typical project (following the Maven directory structure), that solverConfig XML file would be located at $PROJECT_DIR/src/main/resources/org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nqueensSolverConfig.xml. Alternatively, a SolverFactory can be created from a File, an InputStream or a Reader with methods such as SolverFactory.createFromXmlFile(). However, for portability reasons, a classpath resource is recommended.

On some environments (OSGi, JBoss modules, …​), classpath resources (such as the solver config, score DRL’s and domain classes) in your jars might not be available to the default ClassLoader of the optaplanner-core jar. In those cases, provide the ClassLoader of your classes as a parameter:

       SolverFactory<NQueens> solverFactory = SolverFactory.createFromXmlResource(
               ".../nqueensSolverConfig.xml", getClass().getClassLoader());

When using Workbench or Execution Server or to take advantage of Drools’s KieContainer features, provide the KieContainer as a parameter:

       KieServices kieServices = KieServices.Factory.get();
       KieContainer kieContainer = kieServices.newKieContainer(
               kieServices.newReleaseId("org.nqueens", "nqueens", "1.0.0"));
       SolverFactory<NQueens> solverFactory = SolverFactory.createFromKieContainerXmlResource(
               kieContainer, ".../nqueensSolverConfig.xml");

Both a Solver and a SolverFactory have a generic type called Solution_, which is the class representing a planning problem and solution.

A solver configuration XML file looks like this:

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<solver>
  <!-- Define the model -->
  <solutionClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.domain.NQueens</solutionClass>
  <entityClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.domain.Queen</entityClass>

  <!-- Define the score function -->
  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <scoreDrl>org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nQueensScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

  <!-- Configure the optimization algorithms (optional) -->
  <termination>
    ...
  </termination>
  <constructionHeuristic>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>
  <localSearch>
    ...
  </localSearch>
</solver>

Notice the three parts in it:

  • Define the model.

  • Define the score function.

  • Optionally configure the optimization algorithm(s).

These various parts of a configuration are explained further in this manual.

Planner makes it relatively easy to switch optimization algorithm(s) just by changing the configuration. There is even a Benchmarker which allows you to play out different configurations against each other and report the most appropriate configuration for your use case.

4.2.2. Solver Configuration by Java API

A solver configuration can also be configured with the SolverConfig API. This is especially useful to change some values dynamically at runtime. For example, to change the running time based on user input, before building the Solver:

        SolverFactory<NQueens> solverFactory = SolverFactory.createFromXmlResource(
                "org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nqueensSolverConfig.xml");

        TerminationConfig terminationConfig = new TerminationConfig();
        terminationConfig.setMinutesSpentLimit(userInput);
        solverFactory.getSolverConfig().setTerminationConfig(terminationConfig);

        Solver<NQueens> solver = solverFactory.buildSolver();

Every element in the solver configuration XML is available as a *Config class or a property on a *Config class in the package namespace org.optaplanner.core.config. These *Config classes are the Java representation of the XML format. They build the runtime components (of the package namespace org.optaplanner.core.impl) and assemble them into an efficient Solver.

The SolverFactory is only thread-safe after it’s configured. So the getSolverConfig() method is not thread-safe. To configure a SolverFactory dynamically for each user request, build a basic SolverFactory during initialization and clone it with the cloneSolverFactory() method for a user request:

    private SolverFactory<NQueens> base;

    public void init() {
        base = SolverFactory.createFromXmlResource(
                "org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nqueensSolverConfig.xml");
        base.getSolverConfig().setTerminationConfig(new TerminationConfig());
    }

    // Called concurrently from different threads
    public void userRequest(..., long userInput)
        SolverFactory<NQueens> solverFactory = base.cloneSolverFactory();
        solverFactory.getSolverConfig().getTerminationConfig().setMinutesSpentLimit(userInput);
        Solver<NQueens> solver = solverFactory.buildSolver();
        ...
    }

4.2.3. Annotations Configuration

4.2.3.1. Automatic Scanning for Annotations

Instead of the declaring the classes that have a @PlanningSolution or @PlanningEntity manually:

<solver>
  <!-- Define the model -->
  <solutionClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.domain.NQueens</solutionClass>
  <entityClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.domain.Queen</entityClass>

  ...
</solver>

Planner can find scan the classpath and find them automatically:

<solver>
  <!-- Define the model -->
  <scanAnnotatedClasses/>

  ...
</solver>

On environments such as OSGi and Android, which use a non-standard ClassLoader, automated scanning might not find the @PlanningSolution or @PlanningEntity classes.

Automated scanning inflicts a performance cost during bootstrap. To speed up scanning or if there are multiple models in your classpath, specify the packages to scan:

<solver>
  <!-- Define the model -->
  <scanAnnotatedClasses>
    <packageInclude>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing</packageInclude>
  </scanAnnotatedClasses>

  ...
</solver>

This finds all solution and entity classes in that package or its subpackages.

If scanAnnotatedClasses is not specified, the org.reflections transitive maven dependency can be excluded.

4.2.3.2. Annotation Alternatives

Planner needs to be told which classes in your domain model are planning entities, which properties are planning variables, etc. There are several ways to deliver this information:

  • Add class annotations and JavaBean property annotations on the domain model (recommended). The property annotations must be on the getter method, not on the setter method. Such a getter does not need to be public.

  • Add class annotations and field annotations on the domain model. Such a field does not need to be public.

  • No annotations: externalize the domain configuration in an XML file. This is not yet supported.

This manual focuses on the first manner, but every feature supports all three manners, even if it’s not explicitly mentioned.

4.2.4. Custom Properties Configuration

Solver configuration elements, that instantiate classes and explicitly mention it, support custom properties. Custom properties are useful to tweak dynamic values through the Benchmarker. For example, presume your EasyScoreCalculator has heavy calculations (which are cached) and you want to increase the cache size in one benchmark:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <easyScoreCalculatorClass>...MyEasyScoreCalculator</easyScoreCalculatorClass>
    <easyScoreCalculatorCustomProperties>
      <myCacheSize>1000</myCacheSize><!-- Override value -->
    </easyScoreCalculatorCustomProperties>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

Add a public setter for each custom property, which is called when a Solver is build.

public class MyEasyScoreCalculator extends EasyScoreCalculator<MySolution> {

        private int myCacheSize = 500; // Default value

        @SuppressWarnings("unused")
        public void setMyCacheSize(int myCacheSize) {
            this.myCacheSize = myCacheSize;
        }

    ...
}

Most value types are supported (including boolean, int, double, BigDecimal, String and enums).

4.3. Model a Planning Problem

4.3.1. Is This Class a Problem Fact or Planning Entity?

Look at a dataset of your planning problem. You will recognize domain classes in there, each of which can be categorized as one of the following:

  • An unrelated class: not used by any of the score constraints. From a planning standpoint, this data is obsolete.

  • A problem fact class: used by the score constraints, but does NOT change during planning (as long as the problem stays the same). For example: Bed, Room, Shift, Employee, Topic, Period, …​ All the properties of a problem fact class are problem properties.

  • A planning entity class: used by the score constraints and changes during planning. For example: BedDesignation, ShiftAssignment, Exam, …​ The properties that change during planning are planning variables. The other properties are problem properties.

Ask yourself: What class changes during planning? Which class has variables that I want the Solver to change for me? That class is a planning entity. Most use cases have only one planning entity class. Most use cases also have only one planning variable per planning entity class.

In real-time planning, even though the problem itself changes, problem facts do not really change during planning, instead they change between planning (because the Solver temporarily stops to apply the problem fact changes).

To create a good domain model, read the domain modeling guide.

In Planner, all problem facts and planning entities are plain old JavaBeans (POJOs). Load them from a database, an XML file, a data repository, a REST service, a noSQL cloud, …​ (see integration): it doesn’t matter.

4.3.2. Problem Fact

A problem fact is any JavaBean (POJO) with getters that does not change during planning. Implementing the interface Serializable is recommended (but not required). For example in n queens, the columns and rows are problem facts:

public class Column implements Serializable {

    private int index;

    // ... getters
}
public class Row implements Serializable {

    private int index;

    // ... getters
}

A problem fact can reference other problem facts of course:

public class Course implements Serializable {

    private String code;

    private Teacher teacher; // Other problem fact
    private int lectureSize;
    private int minWorkingDaySize;

    private List<Curriculum> curriculumList; // Other problem facts
    private int studentSize;

    // ... getters
}

A problem fact class does not require any Planner specific code. For example, you can reuse your domain classes, which might have JPA annotations.

Generally, better designed domain classes lead to simpler and more efficient score constraints. Therefore, when dealing with a messy (denormalized) legacy system, it can sometimes be worthwhile to convert the messy domain model into a Planner specific model first. For example: if your domain model has two Teacher instances for the same teacher that teaches at two different departments, it is harder to write a correct score constraint that constrains a teacher’s spare time on the original model than on an adjusted model.

Alternatively, you can sometimes also introduce a cached problem fact to enrich the domain model for planning only.

4.3.3. Planning Entity

4.3.3.1. Planning Entity Annotation

A planning entity is a JavaBean (POJO) that changes during solving, for example a Queen that changes to another row. A planning problem has multiple planning entities, for example for a single n queens problem, each Queen is a planning entity. But there is usually only one planning entity class, for example the Queen class.

A planning entity class needs to be annotated with the @PlanningEntity annotation.

Each planning entity class has one or more planning variables (which can be genuine or shadows). It should also have one or more defining properties. For example in n queens, a Queen is defined by its Column and has a planning variable Row. This means that a Queen’s column never changes during solving, while its row does change.

@PlanningEntity
public class Queen {

    private Column column;

    // Planning variables: changes during planning, between score calculations.
    private Row row;

    // ... getters and setters
}

A planning entity class can have multiple planning variables. For example, a Lecture is defined by its Course and its index in that course (because one course has multiple lectures). Each Lecture needs to be scheduled into a Period and a Room so it has two planning variables (period and room). For example: the course Mathematics has eight lectures per week, of which the first lecture is Monday morning at 08:00 in room 212.

@PlanningEntity
public class Lecture {

    private Course course;
    private int lectureIndexInCourse;

    // Planning variables: changes during planning, between score calculations.
    private Period period;
    private Room room;

    // ...
}

Without automated scanning, the solver configuration also needs to declare each planning entity class:

<solver>
  ...
  <entityClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.domain.Queen</entityClass>
  ...
</solver>

Some uses cases have multiple planning entity classes. For example: route freight and trains into railway network arcs, where each freight can use multiple trains over its journey and each train can carry multiple freights per arc. Having multiple planning entity classes directly raises the implementation complexity of your use case.

Do not create unnecessary planning entity classes. This leads to difficult Move implementations and slower score calculation.

For example, do not create a planning entity class to hold the total free time of a teacher, which needs to be kept up to date as the Lecture planning entities change. Instead, calculate the free time in the score constraints (or as a shadow variable) and put the result per teacher into a logically inserted score object.

If historic data needs to be considered too, then create problem fact to hold the total of the historic assignments up to, but not including, the planning window (so that it does not change when a planning entity changes) and let the score constraints take it into account.

4.3.3.2. Planning Entity Difficulty

Some optimization algorithms work more efficiently if they have an estimation of which planning entities are more difficult to plan. For example: in bin packing bigger items are harder to fit, in course scheduling lectures with more students are more difficult to schedule, and in n queens the middle queens are more difficult to fit on the board.

Do not try to use planning entity difficulty to implement a business constraint. It will not affect the score function: if we have infinite solving time, the returned solution will be the same.

To attain a schedule in which certain entities are scheduled earlier in the schedule, add a score constraint to change the score function so it prefers such solutions. Only consider adding planning entity difficulty too if it can make the solver more efficient.

To allow the heuristics to take advantage of that domain specific information, set a difficultyComparatorClass to the @PlanningEntity annotation:

@PlanningEntity(difficultyComparatorClass = CloudProcessDifficultyComparator.class)
public class CloudProcess {
    // ...
}
public class CloudProcessDifficultyComparator implements Comparator<CloudProcess> {

    public int compare(CloudProcess a, CloudProcess b) {
        return new CompareToBuilder()
                .append(a.getRequiredMultiplicand(), b.getRequiredMultiplicand())
                .append(a.getId(), b.getId())
                .toComparison();
    }

}

Alternatively, you can also set a difficultyWeightFactoryClass to the @PlanningEntity annotation, so that you have access to the rest of the problem facts from the Solution too:

@PlanningEntity(difficultyWeightFactoryClass = QueenDifficultyWeightFactory.class)
public class Queen {
    // ...
}

See sorted selection for more information.

Difficulty should be implemented ascending: easy entities are lower, difficult entities are higher. For example, in bin packing: small item < medium item < big item.

Although most algorithms start with the more difficult entities first, they just reverse the ordering.

None of the current planning variable states should be used to compare planning entity difficulty. During Construction Heuristics, those variables are likely to be null anyway. For example, a Queen's row variable should not be used.

4.3.4. Planning Variable (genuine)

4.3.4.1. Planning Variable Annotation

A planning variable is a JavaBean property (so a getter and setter) on a planning entity. It points to a planning value, which changes during planning. For example, a Queen's row property is a genuine planning variable. Note that even though a Queen's row property changes to another Row during planning, no Row instance itself is changed. Normally planning variables are genuine, but advanced cases can also have shadows.

A genuine planning variable getter needs to be annotated with the @PlanningVariable annotation, which needs a non-empty valueRangeProviderRefs property.

@PlanningEntity
public class Queen {
    ...

    private Row row;

    @PlanningVariable(valueRangeProviderRefs = {"rowRange"})
    public Row getRow() {
        return row;
    }

    public void setRow(Row row) {
        this.row = row;
    }

}

The valueRangeProviderRefs property defines what are the possible planning values for this planning variable. It references one or more @ValueRangeProvider id's.

A @PlanningVariable annotation needs to be on a member in a class with a @PlanningEntity annotation. It is ignored on parent classes or subclasses without that annotation.

Annotating the field instead of the property works too:

@PlanningEntity
public class Queen {
    ...

    @PlanningVariable(valueRangeProviderRefs = {"rowRange"})
    private Row row;

}
4.3.4.2. Nullable Planning Variable

By default, an initialized planning variable cannot be null, so an initialized solution will never use null for any of its planning variables. In an over-constrained use case, this can be counterproductive. For example: in task assignment with too many tasks for the workforce, we would rather leave low priority tasks unassigned instead of assigning them to an overloaded worker.

To allow an initialized planning variable to be null, set nullable to true:

    @PlanningVariable(..., nullable = true)
    public Worker getWorker() {
        return worker;
    }

Planner will automatically add the value null to the value range. There is no need to add null in a collection used by a ValueRangeProvider.

Using a nullable planning variable implies that your score calculation is responsible for punishing (or even rewarding) variables with a null value.

Repeated planning (especially real-time planning) does not mix well with a nullable planning variable. Every time the Solver starts or a problem fact change is made, the Construction Heuristics will try to initialize all the null variables again, which can be a huge waste of time. One way to deal with this, is to change when a planning entity should be reinitialized with an reinitializeVariableEntityFilter:

    @PlanningVariable(..., nullable = true, reinitializeVariableEntityFilter = ReinitializeTaskFilter.class)
    public Worker getWorker() {
        return worker;
    }
4.3.4.3. When is a Planning Variable Considered Initialized?

A planning variable is considered initialized if its value is not null or if the variable is nullable. So a nullable variable is always considered initialized, even when a custom reinitializeVariableEntityFilter triggers a reinitialization during construction heuristics.

A planning entity is initialized if all of its planning variables are initialized.

A Solution is initialized if all of its planning entities are initialized.

4.3.5. Planning Value and Planning Value Range

4.3.5.1. Planning Value

A planning value is a possible value for a genuine planning variable. Usually, a planning value is a problem fact, but it can also be any object, for example a double. It can even be another planning entity or even a interface implemented by both a planning entity and a problem fact.

A planning value range is the set of possible planning values for a planning variable. This set can be a countable (for example row 1, 2, 3 or 4) or uncountable (for example any double between 0.0 and 1.0).

4.3.5.2. Planning Value Range Provider
4.3.5.2.1. Overview

The value range of a planning variable is defined with the @ValueRangeProvider annotation. A @ValueRangeProvider annotation always has a property id, which is referenced by the @PlanningVariable's property valueRangeProviderRefs.

This annotation can be located on two types of methods:

  • On the Solution: All planning entities share the same value range.

  • On the planning entity: The value range differs per planning entity. This is less common.

A @ValueRangeProvider annotation needs to be on a member in a class with a @PlanningSolution or a @PlanningEntity annotation. It is ignored on parent classes or subclasses without those annotations.

The return type of that method can be three types:

  • Collection: The value range is defined by a Collection (usually a List) of its possible values.

  • Array: The value range is defined by an array of its possible values.

  • ValueRange: The value range is defined by its bounds. This is less common.

4.3.5.2.2. ValueRangeProvider on the Solution

All instances of the same planning entity class share the same set of possible planning values for that planning variable. This is the most common way to configure a value range.

The Solution implementation has method that returns a Collection (or a ValueRange). Any value from that Collection is a possible planning value for this planning variable.

    @PlanningVariable(valueRangeProviderRefs = {"rowRange"})
    public Row getRow() {
        return row;
    }
@PlanningSolution
public class NQueens {
    ...

    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "rowRange")
    public List<Row> getRowList() {
        return rowList;
    }

}

That Collection (or ValueRange) must not contain the value null, not even for a nullable planning variable.

Annotating the field instead of the property works too:

@PlanningSolution
public class NQueens {
    ...

    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "rowRange")
    private List<Row> rowList;

}
4.3.5.2.3. ValueRangeProvider on the Planning Entity

Each planning entity has its own value range (a set of possible planning values) for the planning variable. For example, if a teacher can never teach in a room that does not belong to his department, lectures of that teacher can limit their room value range to the rooms of his department.

    @PlanningVariable(valueRangeProviderRefs = {"departmentRoomRange"})
    public Room getRoom() {
        return room;
    }

    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "departmentRoomRange")
    public List<Room> getPossibleRoomList() {
        return getCourse().getTeacher().getDepartment().getRoomList();
    }

Never use this to enforce a soft constraint (or even a hard constraint when the problem might not have a feasible solution). For example: Unless there is no other way, a teacher can not teach in a room that does not belong to his department. In this case, the teacher should not be limited in his room value range (because sometimes there is no other way).

By limiting the value range specifically of one planning entity, you are effectively creating a built-in hard constraint. This can have the benefit of severely lowering the number of possible solutions; however, it can also take away the freedom of the optimization algorithms to temporarily break that constraint in order to escape from a local optimum.

A planning entity should not use other planning entities to determinate its value range. That would only try to make the planning entity solve the planning problem itself and interfere with the optimization algorithms.

Every entity has its own List instance, unless multiple entities have the same value range. For example, if teacher A and B belong to the same department, they use the same List<Room> instance. Furthermore, each List contains a subset of the same set of planning value instances. For example, if department A and B can both use room X, then their List<Room> instances contain the same Room instance.

A ValueRangeProvider on the planning entity consumes more memory than ValueRangeProvider on the Solution and disables certain automatic performance optimizations.

A ValueRangeProvider on the planning entity is not currently compatible with a chained variable.

4.3.5.2.4. ValueRangeFactory

Instead of a Collection, you can also return a ValueRange or CountableValueRange, build by the ValueRangeFactory:

    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "delayRange")
    public CountableValueRange<Integer> getDelayRange() {
        return ValueRangeFactory.createIntValueRange(0, 5000);
    }

A ValueRange uses far less memory, because it only holds the bounds. In the example above, a Collection would need to hold all 5000 ints, instead of just the two bounds.

Furthermore, an incrementUnit can be specified, for example if you have to buy stocks in units of 200 pieces:

    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "stockAmountRange")
    public CountableValueRange<Integer> getStockAmountRange() {
         // Range: 0, 200, 400, 600, ..., 9999600, 9999800, 10000000
        return ValueRangeFactory.createIntValueRange(0, 10000000, 200);
    }

Return CountableValueRange instead of ValueRange whenever possible (so Planner knows that it’s countable).

The ValueRangeFactory has creation methods for several value class types:

  • boolean: A boolean range.

  • int: A 32bit integer range.

  • long: A 64bit integer range.

  • double: A 64bit floating point range which only supports random selection (because it does not implement CountableValueRange).

  • BigInteger: An arbitrary-precision integer range.

  • BigDecimal: A decimal point range. By default, the increment unit is the lowest non-zero value in the scale of the bounds.

  • Temporal (such as LocalDate, LocalDateTime, …​): A time range.

4.3.5.2.5. Combine ValueRangeProviders

Value range providers can be combined, for example:

    @PlanningVariable(valueRangeProviderRefs = {"companyCarRange", "personalCarRange"})
    public Car getCar() {
        return car;
    }
    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "companyCarRange")
    public List<CompanyCar> getCompanyCarList() {
        return companyCarList;
    }

    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "personalCarRange")
    public List<PersonalCar> getPersonalCarList() {
        return personalCarList;
    }
4.3.5.3. Planning Value Strength

Some optimization algorithms work a bit more efficiently if they have an estimation of which planning values are stronger, which means they are more likely to satisfy a planning entity. For example: in bin packing bigger containers are more likely to fit an item and in course scheduling bigger rooms are less likely to break the student capacity constraint. Usually, the efficiency gain of planning value strength is far less than that of planning entity difficulty.

Do not try to use planning value strength to implement a business constraint. It will not affect the score function: if we have infinite solving time, the returned solution will be the same.

To affect the score function, add a score constraint. Only consider adding planning value strength too if it can make the solver more efficient.

To allow the heuristics to take advantage of that domain specific information, set a strengthComparatorClass to the @PlanningVariable annotation:

    @PlanningVariable(..., strengthComparatorClass = CloudComputerStrengthComparator.class)
    public CloudComputer getComputer() {
        return computer;
    }
public class CloudComputerStrengthComparator implements Comparator<CloudComputer> {

    public int compare(CloudComputer a, CloudComputer b) {
        return new CompareToBuilder()
                .append(a.getMultiplicand(), b.getMultiplicand())
                .append(b.getCost(), a.getCost()) // Descending (but this is debatable)
                .append(a.getId(), b.getId())
                .toComparison();
    }

}

If you have multiple planning value classes in the same value range, the strengthComparatorClass needs to implement a Comparator of a common superclass (for example Comparator<Object>) and be able to handle comparing instances of those different classes.

Alternatively, you can also set a strengthWeightFactoryClass to the @PlanningVariable annotation, so you have access to the rest of the problem facts from the solution too:

    @PlanningVariable(..., strengthWeightFactoryClass = RowStrengthWeightFactory.class)
    public Row getRow() {
        return row;
    }

See sorted selection for more information.

Strength should be implemented ascending: weaker values are lower, stronger values are higher. For example in bin packing: small container < medium container < big container.

None of the current planning variable state in any of the planning entities should be used to compare planning values. During construction heuristics, those variables are likely to be null. For example, none of the row variables of any Queen may be used to determine the strength of a Row.

4.3.5.4. Chained Planning Variable (TSP, VRP, …​)

Some use cases, such as TSP and Vehicle Routing, require chaining. This means the planning entities point to each other and form a chain. By modeling the problem as a set of chains (instead of a set of trees/loops), the search space is heavily reduced.

A planning variable that is chained either:

  • Directly points to a problem fact (or planning entity), which is called an anchor.

  • Points to another planning entity with the same planning variable, which recursively points to an anchor.

Here are some example of valid and invalid chains:

chainPrinciples

Every initialized planning entity is part of an open-ended chain that begins from an anchor. A valid model means that:

  • A chain is never a loop. The tail is always open.

  • Every chain always has exactly one anchor. The anchor is a problem fact, never a planning entity.

  • A chain is never a tree, it is always a line. Every anchor or planning entity has at most one trailing planning entity.

  • Every initialized planning entity is part of a chain.

  • An anchor with no planning entities pointing to it, is also considered a chain.

A planning problem instance given to the Solver must be valid.

If your constraints dictate a closed chain, model it as an open-ended chain (which is easier to persist in a database) and implement a score constraint for the last entity back to the anchor.

The optimization algorithms and built-in Moves do chain correction to guarantee that the model stays valid:

chainCorrection

A custom Move implementation must leave the model in a valid state.

For example, in TSP the anchor is a Domicile (in vehicle routing it is Vehicle):

public class Domicile ... implements Standstill {
    ...

    public City getCity() {...}

}

The anchor (which is a problem fact) and the planning entity implement a common interface, for example TSP’s Standstill:

public interface Standstill {

    City getCity();

}

That interface is the return type of the planning variable. Furthermore, the planning variable is chained. For example TSP’s Visit (in vehicle routing it is Customer):

@PlanningEntity
public class Visit ... implements Standstill {
    ...

    public City getCity() {...}

    @PlanningVariable(graphType = PlanningVariableGraphType.CHAINED,
        valueRangeProviderRefs = {"domicileRange", "visitRange"})
    public Standstill getPreviousStandstill() {
        return previousStandstill;
    }

    public void setPreviousStandstill(Standstill previousStandstill) {
        this.previousStandstill = previousStandstill;
    }

}

Notice how two value range providers are usually combined:

  • The value range provider that holds the anchors, for example domicileList.

  • The value range provider that holds the initialized planning entities, for example visitList.

4.3.6. Planning Problem and Planning Solution

4.3.6.1. Planning Problem Instance

A dataset for a planning problem needs to be wrapped in a class for the Solver to solve. That solution class represents both the planning problem and (if solved) a solution. It is annotated with a @PlanningSolution annotation. For example in n queens, the solution class is the NQueens class, which contains a Column list, a Row list, and a Queen list.

A planning problem is actually an unsolved planning solution or - stated differently - an uninitialized solution. For example in n queens, that NQueens class has the @PlanningSolution annotation, yet every Queen in an unsolved NQueens class is not yet assigned to a Row (their row property is null). That’s not a feasible solution. It’s not even a possible solution. It’s an uninitialized solution.

4.3.6.2. Solution Class

A solution class holds all problem facts, planning entities and a score. It is annotated with a @PlanningSolution annotation. For example, an NQueens instance holds a list of all columns, all rows and all Queen instances:

@PlanningSolution
public class NQueens {

    // Problem facts
    private int n;
    private List<Column> columnList;
    private List<Row> rowList;

    // Planning entities
    private List<Queen> queenList;

    private SimpleScore score;

    ...
}

Without automated scanning, the solver configuration also needs to declare the planning solution class:

<solver>
  ...
  <solutionClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.domain.NQueens</solutionClass>
  ...
</solver>
4.3.6.3. Planning Entities of a Solution (@PlanningEntityCollectionProperty)

Planner needs to extract the entity instances from the solution instance. It gets those collection(s) by calling every getter (or field) that is annotated with @PlanningEntityCollectionProperty:

@PlanningSolution
public class NQueens {
    ...

    private List<Queen> queenList;

    @PlanningEntityCollectionProperty
    public List<Queen> getQueenList() {
        return queenList;
    }

}

There can be multiple @PlanningEntityCollectionProperty annotated members. Those can even return a Collection with the same entity class type. Instead of Collection, it can also return an array.

A @PlanningEntityCollectionProperty annotation needs to be on a member in a class with a @PlanningSolution annotation. It is ignored on parent classes or subclasses without that annotation.

In rare cases, a planning entity might be a singleton: use @PlanningEntityProperty on its getter (or field) instead.

Both annotations can also be auto discovered if enabled.

4.3.6.4. Score of a Solution (@PlanningScore)

A Solution requires a score property (or field), which is annotated with a @PlanningScore annotation. The score property is null if the the score hasn’t been calculated yet. The score property is typed to the specific Score implementation of your use case. For example, NQueens uses a SimpleScore:

@PlanningSolution
public class NQueens {
    ...

    private SimpleScore score;

    @PlanningScore
    public SimpleScore getScore() {
        return score;
    }
    public void setScore(SimpleScore score) {
        this.score = score;
    }

}

Most use cases use a HardSoftScore instead:

@PlanningSolution
public class CloudBalance {
    ...

    private HardSoftScore score;

    @PlanningScore
    public HardSoftScore getScore() {
        return score;
    }

    public void setScore(HardSoftScore score) {
        this.score = score;
    }

}

Some use cases use other score types.

This annotation can also be auto discovered if enabled.

4.3.6.5. Problem Facts of a Solution (@ProblemFactCollectionProperty)

For constraint streams and Drools score calculation, Planner needs to extract the problem fact instances from the solution instance. It gets those collection(s) by calling every method (or field) that is annotated with @ProblemFactCollectionProperty. All objects returned by those methods will be inserted into the ConstrainStreams or Drools session, so the constraint steams or score rules can access them. For example in NQueens all Column and Row instances are problem facts.

@PlanningSolution
public class NQueens {
    ...

    private List<Column> columnList;
    private List<Row> rowList;

    @ProblemFactCollectionProperty
    public List<Column> getColumnList() {
        return columnList;
    }

    @ProblemFactCollectionProperty
    public List<Row> getRowList() {
        return rowList;
    }

}

All planning entities are automatically inserted into the Drools working memory. Do note add an annotation on their properties.

The problem facts methods are not called often: at most only once per solver phase per solver thread.

There can be multiple @ProblemFactCollectionProperty annotated members. Those can even return a Collection with the same class type, but they shouldn’t return the same instance twice. Instead of Collection, it can also return an array.

A @ProblemFactCollectionProperty annotation needs to be on a member in a class with a @PlanningSolution annotation. It is ignored on parent classes or subclasses without that annotation.

In rare cases, a problem fact might be a singleton: use @ProblemFactProperty on its method (or field) instead.

Both annotations can also be auto discovered if enabled.

4.3.6.5.1. Cached Problem Fact

A cached problem fact is a problem fact that does not exist in the real domain model, but is calculated before the Solver really starts solving. The problem facts methods have the opportunity to enrich the domain model with such cached problem facts, which can lead to simpler and faster score constraints.

For example in examination, a cached problem fact TopicConflict is created for every two Topics which share at least one Student.

    @ProblemFactCollectionProperty
    private List<TopicConflict> calculateTopicConflictList() {
        List<TopicConflict> topicConflictList = new ArrayList<TopicConflict>();
        for (Topic leftTopic : topicList) {
            for (Topic rightTopic : topicList) {
                if (leftTopic.getId() < rightTopic.getId()) {
                    int studentSize = 0;
                    for (Student student : leftTopic.getStudentList()) {
                        if (rightTopic.getStudentList().contains(student)) {
                            studentSize++;
                        }
                    }
                    if (studentSize > 0) {
                        topicConflictList.add(new TopicConflict(leftTopic, rightTopic, studentSize));
                    }
                }
            }
        }
        return topicConflictList;
    }

Where a score constraint needs to check that no two exams with a topic that shares a student are scheduled close together (depending on the constraint: at the same time, in a row, or in the same day), the TopicConflict instance can be used as a problem fact, rather than having to combine every two Student instances.

4.3.6.6. Auto Discover Solution Properties

Instead of configuring each property (or field) annotation explicitly, some can also be deduced automatically by Planner. For example, on the cloud balancing example:

@PlanningSolution(autoDiscoverMemberType = AutoDiscoverMemberType.FIELD)
public class CloudBalance {

    // Auto discovered as @ProblemFactCollectionProperty
    @ValueRangeProvider(id = "computerRange") // Not (yet) auto discovered
    private List<CloudComputer> computerList;

    // Auto discovered as @PlanningEntityCollectionProperty
    private List<CloudProcess> processList;

    // Auto discovered as @PlanningScore
    private HardSoftScore score;

    ...
}

The AutoDiscoverMemberType can be:

  • NONE: No auto discovery.

  • FIELD: Auto discover all fields on the @PlanningSolution class

  • GETTER: Auto discover all getters on the @PlanningSolution class

The automatic annotation is based on the field type (or getter return type):

  • @ProblemFactProperty: when it isn’t a Collection, an array, a @PlanningEntity class or a Score

  • @ProblemFactCollectionProperty: when it’s a Collection (or array) of a type that isn’t a @PlanningEntity class

  • @PlanningEntityProperty: when it is a configured @PlanningEntity class or subclass

  • @PlanningEntityCollectionProperty: when it’s a Collection (or array) of a type that is a configured @PlanningEntity class or subclass

  • @PlanningScore: when it is a Score or subclass

These automatic annotation can still be overwritten per field (or getter). Specifically, a BendableScore always needs to override with an explicit @PlanningScore annotation to define the number of hard and soft levels.

4.3.6.7. Cloning a Solution

Most (if not all) optimization algorithms clone the solution each time they encounter a new best solution (so they can recall it later) or to work with multiple solutions in parallel.

There are many ways to clone, such as a shallow clone, deep clone, …​ This context focuses on a planning clone.

A planning clone of a solution must fulfill these requirements:

  • The clone must represent the same planning problem. Usually it reuses the same instances of the problem facts and problem fact collections as the original.

  • The clone must use different, cloned instances of the entities and entity collections. Changes to an original Solution entity’s variables must not affect its clone.

solutionCloning

Implementing a planning clone method is hard, therefore you do not need to implement it.

4.3.6.7.1. FieldAccessingSolutionCloner

This SolutionCloner is used by default. It works well for most use cases.

When the FieldAccessingSolutionCloner clones one of your collections or maps, it may not recognize the implementation and replace it with ArrayList, LinkedHashSet, TreeSet, LinkedHashMap or TreeMap (whichever is more applicable) . It recognizes most of the common JDK collection and map implementations.

The FieldAccessingSolutionCloner does not clone problem facts by default. If any of your problem facts needs to be deep cloned for a planning clone, for example if the problem fact references a planning entity or the planning solution, mark it with a @DeepPlanningClone annotation:

@DeepPlanningClone
public class SeatDesignationDependency {
    private SeatDesignation leftSeatDesignation; // planning entity
    private SeatDesignation rightSeatDesignation; // planning entity
    ...
}

In the example above, because SeatDesignation is a planning entity (which is deep planning cloned automatically), SeatDesignationDependency must also be deep planning cloned.

Alternatively, the @DeepPlanningClone annotation can also be used on a getter method.

4.3.6.7.2. Custom Cloning with a SolutionCloner

To use a custom cloner, configure it on the planning solution:

@PlanningSolution(solutionCloner = NQueensSolutionCloner.class)
public class NQueens {
    ...
}

For example, a NQueens planning clone only deep clones all Queen instances. So when the original solution changes (later on during planning) and one or more Queen instances change, the planning clone isn’t affected.

public class NQueensSolutionCloner implements SolutionCloner<NQueens> {

    @Override
    public NQueens cloneSolution(CloneLedger ledger, NQueens original) {
        NQueens clone = new NQueens();
        ledger.registerClone(original, clone);
        clone.setId(original.getId());
        clone.setN(original.getN());
        clone.setColumnList(original.getColumnList());
        clone.setRowList(original.getRowList());
        List<Queen> queenList = original.getQueenList();
        List<Queen> clonedQueenList = new ArrayList<Queen>(queenList.size());
        for (Queen originalQueen : queenList) {
            Queen cloneQueen = new Queen();
            ledger.registerClone(originalQueen, cloneQueen);
            cloneQueen.setId(originalQueen.getId());
            cloneQueen.setColumn(originalQueen.getColumn());
            cloneQueen.setRow(originalQueen.getRow());
            clonedQueenList.add(cloneQueen);
        }
        clone.setQueenList(clonedQueenList);
        clone.setScore(original.getScore());
        return clone;
    }

}

The cloneSolution() method should only deep clone the planning entities. Notice that the problem facts, such as Column and Row are normally not cloned: even their List instances are not cloned. If the problem facts were cloned too, then you would have to make sure that the new planning entity clones also refer to the new problem facts clones used by the cloned solution. For example, if you were to clone all Row instances, then each Queen clone and the NQueens clone itself should refer to those new Row clones.

Cloning an entity with a chained variable is devious: a variable of an entity A might point to another entity B. If A is cloned, then its variable must point to the clone of B, not the original B.

4.3.6.8. Create an Uninitialized Solution

Create a Solution instance to represent your planning problem’s dataset, so it can be set on the Solver as the planning problem to solve. For example in n queens, an NQueens instance is created with the required Column and Row instances and every Queen set to a different column and every row set to null.

    private NQueens createNQueens(int n) {
        NQueens nQueens = new NQueens();
        nQueens.setId(0L);
        nQueens.setN(n);
        nQueens.setColumnList(createColumnList(nQueens));
        nQueens.setRowList(createRowList(nQueens));
        nQueens.setQueenList(createQueenList(nQueens));
        return nQueens;
    }

    private List<Queen> createQueenList(NQueens nQueens) {
        int n = nQueens.getN();
        List<Queen> queenList = new ArrayList<Queen>(n);
        long id = 0L;
        for (Column column : nQueens.getColumnList()) {
            Queen queen = new Queen();
            queen.setId(id);
            id++;
            queen.setColumn(column);
            // Notice that we leave the PlanningVariable properties on null
            queenList.add(queen);
        }
        return queenList;
    }
uninitializedNQueens04
Figure 4. Uninitialized Solution for the Four Queens Puzzle

Usually, most of this data comes from your data layer, and your Solution implementation just aggregates that data and creates the uninitialized planning entity instances to plan:

        private void createLectureList(CourseSchedule schedule) {
            List<Course> courseList = schedule.getCourseList();
            List<Lecture> lectureList = new ArrayList<Lecture>(courseList.size());
            long id = 0L;
            for (Course course : courseList) {
                for (int i = 0; i < course.getLectureSize(); i++) {
                    Lecture lecture = new Lecture();
                    lecture.setId(id);
                    id++;
                    lecture.setCourse(course);
                    lecture.setLectureIndexInCourse(i);
                    // Notice that we leave the PlanningVariable properties (period and room) on null
                    lectureList.add(lecture);
                }
            }
            schedule.setLectureList(lectureList);
        }

4.4. Use the Solver

4.4.1. The Solver Interface

A Solver implementation will solve your planning problem.

public interface Solver<Solution_> {

    Solution_ solve(Solution_ problem);

    ...
}

A Solver can only solve one planning problem instance at a time. A Solver should only be accessed from a single thread, except for the methods that are specifically javadocced as being thread-safe. It is built with a SolverFactory, there is no need to implement it yourself.

4.4.2. Solving a Problem

Solving a problem is quite easy once you have:

  • A Solver built from a solver configuration

  • A Solution that represents the planning problem instance

Just provide the planning problem as argument to the solve() method and it will return the best solution found:

    NQueens bestSolution = solver.solve(problem);

For example in n queens, the solve() method will return an NQueens instance with every Queen assigned to a Row.

solvedNQueens04
Figure 5. Best Solution for the Four Queens Puzzle in 8ms (Also an Optimal Solution)

The solve(Solution) method can take a long time (depending on the problem size and the solver configuration). The Solver intelligently wades through the search space of possible solutions and remembers the best solution it encounters during solving. Depending on a number of factors (including problem size, how much time the Solver has, the solver configuration, …​), that best solution might or might not be an optimal solution.

The Solution instance given to the method solve(Solution) is changed by the Solver, but do not mistake it for the best solution.

The Solution instance returned by the methods solve(Solution) or getBestSolution() is most likely a planning clone of the instance given to the method solve(Solution), which implies it is a different instance.

The Solution instance given to the solve(Solution) method does not need to be uninitialized. It can be partially or fully initialized, which is often the case in repeated planning.

4.4.3. Environment Mode: Are There Bugs in my Code?

The environment mode allows you to detect common bugs in your implementation. It does not affect the logging level.

You can set the environment mode in the solver configuration XML file:

<solver>
  <environmentMode>FAST_ASSERT</environmentMode>
  ...
</solver>

A solver has a single Random instance. Some solver configurations use the Random instance a lot more than others. For example, Simulated Annealing depends highly on random numbers, while Tabu Search only depends on it to deal with score ties. The environment mode influences the seed of that Random instance.

These are the environment modes:

4.4.3.1. FULL_ASSERT

The FULL_ASSERT mode turns on all assertions (such as assert that the incremental score calculation is uncorrupted for each move) to fail-fast on a bug in a Move implementation, a score rule, the rule engine itself, …​

This mode is reproducible (see the reproducible mode). It is also intrusive because it calls the method calculateScore() more frequently than a non-assert mode.

The FULL_ASSERT mode is horribly slow (because it does not rely on incremental score calculation).

4.4.3.2. NON_INTRUSIVE_FULL_ASSERT

The NON_INTRUSIVE_FULL_ASSERT turns on several assertions to fail-fast on a bug in a Move implementation, a score rule, the rule engine itself, …​

This mode is reproducible (see the reproducible mode). It is non-intrusive because it does not call the method calculateScore() more frequently than a non assert mode.

The NON_INTRUSIVE_FULL_ASSERT mode is horribly slow (because it does not rely on incremental score calculation).

4.4.3.3. FAST_ASSERT

The FAST_ASSERT mode turns on most assertions (such as assert that an undoMove’s score is the same as before the Move) to fail-fast on a bug in a Move implementation, a score rule, the rule engine itself, …​

This mode is reproducible (see the reproducible mode). It is also intrusive because it calls the method calculateScore() more frequently than a non assert mode.

The FAST_ASSERT mode is slow.

It is recommended to write a test case that does a short run of your planning problem with the FAST_ASSERT mode on.

4.4.3.4. REPRODUCIBLE (default)

The reproducible mode is the default mode because it is recommended during development. In this mode, two runs in the same Planner version will execute the same code in the same order. Those two runs will have the same result at every step, except if the note below applies. This enables you to reproduce bugs consistently. It also allows you to benchmark certain refactorings (such as a score constraint performance optimization) fairly across runs.

Despite the reproducible mode, your application might still not be fully reproducible because of:

  • Use of HashSet (or another Collection which has an inconsistent order between JVM runs) for collections of planning entities or planning values (but not normal problem facts), especially in the Solution implementation. Replace it with LinkedHashSet.

  • Combining a time gradient dependent algorithms (most notably Simulated Annealing) together with time spent termination. A sufficiently large difference in allocated CPU time will influence the time gradient values. Replace Simulated Annealing with Late Acceptance. Or instead, replace time spent termination with step count termination.

The reproducible mode can be slightly slower than the non-reproducible mode. If your production environment can benefit from reproducibility, use this mode in production.

In practice, this mode uses the default, fixed random seed if no seed is specified, and it also disables certain concurrency optimizations (such as work stealing).

4.4.3.5. NON_REPRODUCIBLE

The non-reproducible mode can be slightly faster than the reproducible mode. Avoid using it during development as it makes debugging and bug fixing painful. If your production environment doesn’t care about reproducibility, use this mode in production.

In practice, this mode uses no fixed random seed if no seed is specified.

4.4.4. Logging Level: What is the Solver Doing?

The best way to illuminate the black box that is a Solver, is to play with the logging level:

  • error: Log errors, except those that are thrown to the calling code as a RuntimeException.

    If an error happens, Planner normally fails fast: it throws a subclass of RuntimeException with a detailed message to the calling code. It does not log it as an error itself to avoid duplicate log messages. Except if the calling code explicitly catches and eats that RuntimeException, a Thread's default ExceptionHandler will log it as an error anyway. Meanwhile, the code is disrupted from doing further harm or obfuscating the error.

  • warn: Log suspicious circumstances.

  • info: Log every phase and the solver itself. See scope overview.

  • debug: Log every step of every phase. See scope overview.

  • trace: Log every move of every step of every phase. See scope overview.

Turning on trace logging, will slow down performance considerably: it is often four times slower. However, it is invaluable during development to discover a bottleneck.

Even debug logging can slow down performance considerably for fast stepping algorithms (such as Late Acceptance and Simulated Annealing), but not for slow stepping algorithms (such as Tabu Search).

Both cause congestion in multithreaded solving with most appenders, see below.

In Eclipse, debug logging to the console tends to cause congestion with a score calculation speeds above 10 000 per second. Nor IntelliJ, nor the Maven command line suffer from this problem.

For example, set it to debug logging, to see when the phases end and how fast steps are taken:

INFO  Solving started: time spent (3), best score (-4init/0), random (JDK with seed 0).
DEBUG     CH step (0), time spent (5), score (-3init/0), selected move count (1), picked move (Queen-2 {null -> Row-0}).
DEBUG     CH step (1), time spent (7), score (-2init/0), selected move count (3), picked move (Queen-1 {null -> Row-2}).
DEBUG     CH step (2), time spent (10), score (-1init/0), selected move count (4), picked move (Queen-3 {null -> Row-3}).
DEBUG     CH step (3), time spent (12), score (-1), selected move count (4), picked move (Queen-0 {null -> Row-1}).
INFO  Construction Heuristic phase (0) ended: time spent (12), best score (-1), score calculation speed (9000/sec), step total (4).
DEBUG     LS step (0), time spent (19), score (-1),     best score (-1), accepted/selected move count (12/12), picked move (Queen-1 {Row-2 -> Row-3}).
DEBUG     LS step (1), time spent (24), score (0), new best score (0), accepted/selected move count (9/12), picked move (Queen-3 {Row-3 -> Row-2}).
INFO  Local Search phase (1) ended: time spent (24), best score (0), score calculation speed (4000/sec), step total (2).
INFO  Solving ended: time spent (24), best score (0), score calculation speed (7000/sec), phase total (2), environment mode (REPRODUCIBLE).

All time spent values are in milliseconds.

Everything is logged to SLF4J, which is a simple logging facade which delegates every log message to Logback, Apache Commons Logging, Log4j or java.util.logging. Add a dependency to the logging adaptor for your logging framework of choice.

If you are not using any logging framework yet, use Logback by adding this Maven dependency (there is no need to add an extra bridge dependency):

    <dependency>
      <groupId>ch.qos.logback</groupId>
      <artifactId>logback-classic</artifactId>
      <version>1.x</version>
    </dependency>

Configure the logging level on the org.optaplanner package in your logback.xml file:

<configuration>

  <logger name="org.optaplanner" level="debug"/>

  ...

</configuration>

If it isn’t picked up, temporarily add the system property -Dlogback.debug=true to figure out why.

When running multiple solvers or one multithreaded solver, most appenders (including the console) cause congestion with debug and trace logging. Switch to an async appender to avoid this problem or turn off debug logging.

If instead, you are still using Log4J 1.x (and you do not want to switch to its faster successor, Logback), add the bridge dependency:

    <dependency>
      <groupId>org.slf4j</groupId>
      <artifactId>slf4j-log4j12</artifactId>
      <version>1.x</version>
    </dependency>

And configure the logging level on the package org.optaplanner in your log4j.xml file:

<log4j:configuration xmlns:log4j="http://jakarta.apache.org/log4j/">

  <category name="org.optaplanner">
    <priority value="debug" />
  </category>

  ...

</log4j:configuration>

In a multitenant application, multiple Solver instances might be running at the same time. To separate their logging into distinct files, surround the solve() call with an MDC:

        MDC.put("tenant.name",tenantName);
        MySolution bestSolution = solver.solve(problem);
        MDC.remove("tenant.name");

Then configure your logger to use different files for each ${tenant.name}. For example in Logback, use a SiftingAppender in logback.xml:

  <appender name="fileAppender" class="ch.qos.logback.classic.sift.SiftingAppender">
    <discriminator>
      <key>tenant.name</key>
      <defaultValue>unknown</defaultValue>
    </discriminator>
    <sift>
      <appender name="fileAppender.${tenant.name}" class="...FileAppender">
        <file>local/log/optaplanner-${tenant.name}.log</file>
        ...
      </appender>
    </sift>
  </appender>

4.4.5. Random Number Generator

Many heuristics and metaheuristics depend on a pseudorandom number generator for move selection, to resolve score ties, probability based move acceptance, …​ During solving, the same Random instance is reused to improve reproducibility, performance and uniform distribution of random values.

To change the random seed of that Random instance, specify a randomSeed:

<solver>
  <randomSeed>0</randomSeed>
  ...
</solver>

To change the pseudorandom number generator implementation, specify a randomType:

<solver>
  <randomType>MERSENNE_TWISTER</randomType>
  ...
</solver>

The following types are supported:

  • JDK (default): Standard implementation (java.util.Random).

  • MERSENNE_TWISTER: Implementation by Commons Math.

  • WELL512A, WELL1024A, WELL19937A, WELL19937C, WELL44497A and WELL44497B: Implementation by Commons Math.

For most use cases, the randomType has no significant impact on the average quality of the best solution on multiple datasets. If you want to confirm this on your use case, use the benchmarker.

5. Score Calculation

5.1. Score Terminology

5.1.1. What is a Score?

Every Solution has a score. The score is an objective way to compare two solutions. The solution with the higher score is better. The Solver aims to find the Solution with the highest Score of all possible solutions. The best solution is the Solution with the highest Score that Solver has encountered during solving, which might be the optimal solution.

Planner cannot automatically know which Solution is best for your business, so you need to tell it how to calculate the score of a given Solution according to your business needs. If you forget or are unable to implement an important business constraint, the solution is probably useless:

optimalWithIncompleteConstraints

5.1.2. Formalize the Business Constraints

To implement a verbal business constraint, it needs to be formalized as a score constraint. Luckily, defining constraints in Planner is very flexible through the following score techniques:

  • Score signum (positive or negative): maximize or minimize a constraint type

  • Score weight: put a cost/profit on a constraint type

  • Score level (hard, soft, …​): prioritize a group of constraint types

  • Pareto scoring (rarely used)

Take the time to acquaint yourself with the first three techniques. Once you understand them, formalizing most business constraints becomes straightforward.

Do not presume that your business knows all its score constraints in advance. Expect score constraints to be added, changed or removed after the first releases.

5.1.3. Score Constraint Signum (Positive or Negative)

All score techniques are based on constraints. A constraint can be a simple pattern (such as Maximize the apple harvest in the solution) or a more complex pattern. A positive constraint is a constraint you want to maximize. A negative constraint is a constraint you want to minimize.

positiveAndNegativeConstraints

The image above illustrates that the optimal solution always has the highest score, regardless if the constraints are positive or negative.

Most planning problems have only negative constraints and therefore have a negative score. In that case, the score is the sum of the weight of the negative constraints being broken, with a perfect score of 0. For example in n queens, the score is the negative of the number of queen pairs which can attack each other.

Negative and positive constraints can be combined, even in the same score level.

When a constraint activates (because the negative constraint is broken or the positive constraint is fulfilled) on a certain planning entity set, it is called a constraint match.

5.1.4. Score Constraint Weight

Not all score constraints are equally important. If breaking one constraint is equally bad as breaking another constraint x times, then those two constraints have a different weight (but they are in the same score level). For example in vehicle routing, you can make one unhappy driver constraint match count as much as two fuel tank usage constraint matches:

scoreWeighting

Score weighting is easy in use cases where you can put a price tag on everything. In that case, the positive constraints maximize revenue and the negative constraints minimize expenses, so together they maximize profit. Alternatively, score weighting is also often used to create social fairness. For example, a nurse, who requests a free day, pays a higher weight on New Years eve than on a normal day.

The weight of a constraint match can depend on the planning entities involved. For example in cloud balancing, the weight of the soft constraint match for an active Computer is the maintenance cost of that Computer (which differs per computer).

Putting a good weight on a constraint is often a difficult analytical decision, because it is about making choices and trade-offs against other constraints. Different stakeholders have different priorities. Don’t waste time with constraint weight discussions at the start of an implementation, instead add a constraint configuration and allow users to change them through a UI. A non-accurate weight is less damaging than mediocre algorithms:

scoreTradeoffInPerspective

Most use cases use a Score with int weights, such as HardSoftScore.

5.1.5. Score Constraint Level (hard, soft, …​)

Sometimes a score constraint outranks another score constraint, no matter how many times the latter is broken. In that case, those score constraints are in different levels. For example, a nurse cannot do two shifts at the same time (due to the constraints of physical reality), so this outranks all nurse happiness constraints.

Most use cases have only two score levels, hard and soft. The levels of two scores are compared lexicographically. The first score level gets compared first. If those differ, the remaining score levels are ignored. For example, a score that breaks 0 hard constraints and 1000000 soft constraints is better than a score that breaks 1 hard constraint and 0 soft constraints.

scoreLevels

If there are two (or more) score levels, for example HardSoftScore, then a score is feasible if no hard constraints are broken.

By default, Planner will always assign all planning variables a planning value. If there is no feasible solution, this means the best solution will be infeasible. To instead leave some of the planning entities unassigned, apply overconstrained planning.

For each constraint, you need to pick a score level, a score weight and a score signum. For example: -1soft which has score level of soft, a weight of 1 and a negative signum. Do not use a big constraint weight when your business actually wants different score levels. That hack, known as score folding, is broken:

scoreFoldingIsBroken

Your business might tell you that your hard constraints all have the same weight, because they cannot be broken (so the weight does not matter). This is not true because if no feasible solution exists for a specific dataset, the least infeasible solution allows the business to estimate how many business resources they are lacking. For example in cloud balancing, how many new computers to buy.

Furthermore, it will likely create a score trap. For example in cloud balance if a Computer has seven CPU too little for its Processes, then it must be weighted seven times as much as if it had only one CPU too little.

Three or more score levels are also supported. For example: a company might decide that profit outranks employee satisfaction (or vice versa), while both are outranked by the constraints of physical reality.

To model fairness or load balancing, there is no need to use lots of score levels (even though Planner can handle many score levels).

Most use cases use a Score with two or three weights, such as HardSoftScore and HardMediumSoftScore.

5.1.6. Pareto Scoring (AKA Multi-objective Optimization Scoring)

Far less common is the use case of pareto optimization, which is also known as multi-objective optimization. In pareto scoring, score constraints are in the same score level, yet they are not weighted against each other. When two scores are compared, each of the score constraints are compared individually and the score with the most dominating score constraints wins. Pareto scoring can even be combined with score levels and score constraint weighting.

Consider this example with positive constraints, where we want to get the most apples and oranges. Since it is impossible to compare apples and oranges, we can not weight them against each other. Yet, despite that we can not compare them, we can state that two apples are better then one apple. Similarly, we can state that two apples and one orange are better than just one orange. So despite our inability to compare some Scores conclusively (at which point we declare them equal), we can find a set of optimal scores. Those are called pareto optimal.

paretoOptimizationScoring

Scores are considered equal far more often. It is left up to a human to choose the better out of a set of best solutions (with equal scores) found by Planner. In the example above, the user must choose between solution A (three apples and one orange) and solution B (one apple and six oranges). It is guaranteed that Planner has not found another solution which has more apples or more oranges or even a better combination of both (such as two apples and three oranges).

To implement pareto scoring in Planner, implement a custom ScoreDefinition and Score (and replace the BestSolutionRecaller). Future versions will provide out-of-the-box support.

A pareto Score's compareTo method is not transitive because it does a pareto comparison. For example: having two apples is greater than one apple. One apple is equal to One orange. Yet, two apples are not greater than one orange (but actually equal). Pareto comparison violates the contract of the interface java.lang.Comparable's compareTo method, but Planners systems are pareto comparison safe, unless explicitly stated otherwise in this documentation.

5.1.7. Combining Score Techniques

All the score techniques mentioned above, can be combined seamlessly:

scoreComposition

5.1.8. Score interface

A score is represented by the Score interface, which naturally extends Comparable:

public interface Score<...> extends Comparable<...> {
    ...
}

The Score implementation to use depends on your use case. Your score might not efficiently fit in a single long value. Planner has several built-in Score implementations, but you can implement a custom Score too. Most use cases tend to use the built-in HardSoftScore.

scoreClassDiagram

All Score implementations also have an initScore (which is an int). It is mostly intended for internal use in Planner: it is the negative number of uninitialized planning variables. From a user’s perspective this is 0, unless a Construction Heuristic is terminated before it could initialize all planning variables (in which case Score.isSolutionInitialized() returns false).

The Score implementation (for example HardSoftScore) must be the same throughout a Solver runtime. The Score implementation is configured in the solution domain class:

@PlanningSolution
public class CloudBalance {
    ...

    @PlanningScore
    private HardSoftScore score;

}

5.1.9. Avoid Floating Point Numbers in Score Calculation

Avoid the use of float or double in score calculation. Use BigDecimal or scaled long instead.

Floating point numbers (float and double) cannot represent a decimal number correctly. For example: a double cannot hold the value 0.05 correctly. Instead, it holds the nearest representable value. Arithmetic (including addition and subtraction) with floating point numbers, especially for planning problems, leads to incorrect decisions:

scoreWeightType

Additionally, floating point number addition is not associative:

System.out.println( ((0.01 + 0.02) + 0.03) == (0.01 + (0.02 + 0.03)) ); // returns false

This leads to score corruption.

Decimal numbers (BigDecimal) have none of these problems.

BigDecimal arithmetic is considerably slower than int, long or double arithmetic. In experiments we have seen the score calculation take five times longer.

Therefore, in many cases, it can be worthwhile to multiply all numbers for a single score weight by a plural of ten, so the score weight fits in a scaled int or long. For example, if we multiply all weights by 1000, a fuelCost of 0.07 becomes a fuelCostMillis of 70 and no longer uses a decimal score weight.

5.2. Choose a Score Type

Depending on the number of score levels and type of score weights you need, choose a Score type. Most use cases use a HardSoftScore.

To properly write a Score to a database (with JPA/Hibernate) or to XML/JSON (with XStream/JAXB/Jackson), see the integration chapter.

5.2.1. SimpleScore

A SimpleScore has a single int value, for example -123. It has a single score level.

    @PlanningScore
    private SimpleScore score;

Variants of this Score type:

  • SimpleLongScore uses a long value instead of an int value.

  • SimpleDoubleScore uses a double value instead of an int value. Not recommended to use.

  • SimpleBigDecimalScore uses a BigDecimal value instead of an int value.

5.2.2. HardSoftScore (Recommended)

A HardSoftScore has a hard int value and a soft int value, for example -123hard/-456soft. It has two score levels (hard and soft).

    @PlanningScore
    private HardSoftScore score;

Variants of this Score type:

  • HardSoftLongScore uses long values instead of int values.

  • HardSoftDoubleScore uses double values instead of int values. Not recommended to use.

  • HardSoftBigDecimalScore uses BigDecimal values instead of int values.

5.2.3. HardMediumSoftScore

A HardMediumSoftScore which has a hard int value, a medium int value and a soft int value, for example -123hard/-456medium/-789soft. It has three score levels (hard, medium and soft). The hard level determines if the solution is feasible, and the medium level and soft level score values determine how well the solution meets business goals. Higher medium values take precedence over soft values irrespective of the soft value.

    @PlanningScore
    private HardMediumSoftScore score;

Variants of this Score type:

  • HardMediumSoftLongScore uses long values instead of int values.

  • HardMediumSoftBigDecimalScore uses BigDecimal values instead of int values.

5.2.4. BendableScore

A BendableScore has a configurable number of score levels. It has an array of hard int values and an array of soft int values, for example with two hard levels and three soft levels, the score can be [-123/-456]hard/[-789/-012/-345]soft. In that case, it has five score levels. A solution is feasible if all hard levels are at least zero.

A BendableScore with one hard level and one soft level is equivalent to a HardSoftScore, while a BendableScore with one hard level and two soft levels is equivalent to a HardMediumSoftScore.

    @PlanningScore(bendableHardLevelsSize = 2, bendableSoftLevelsSize = 3)
    private BendableScore score;

The number of hard and soft score levels need to be set at compilation time. It is not flexible to change during solving.

Do not use a BendableScore with seven levels just because you have seven constraints. It is extremely rare to use a different score level for each constraint, because that means one constraint match on soft 0 outweighs even a million constraint matches of soft 1.

Usually, multiple constraints share the same level and are weighted against each other. Use explaining the score to get the weight of individual constraints in the same level.

Variants of this Score type:

  • BendableLongScore uses long values instead of int values.

  • BendableBigDecimalScore uses BigDecimal values instead of int values.

5.2.5. Implementing a Custom Score

Internally, each Score implementation also has a ScoreDefinition implementation. For example: SimpleScore is defined by SimpleScoreDefinition. The ScoreDefinition interface defines the score representation.

To implement a custom Score, also implement such a custom ScoreDefinition. Extend AbstractScoreDefinition (preferably by copy pasting HardSoftScoreDefinition) and start from there. Then hook your custom ScoreDefinition in the domain:

    @PlanningScore(scoreDefinitionClass = MyCustomScoreDefinition.class)
    private MyCustomScore score;

To have it integrate seamlessly with JPA/Hibernate, XStream, Jackson, …​, you’ll need to write custom glue code too.

5.3. Calculate the Score

5.3.1. Score Calculation Types

There are several ways to calculate the Score of a Solution:

Every score calculation type can work with any Score definition (such as HardSoftScore or HardMediumSoftScore). All score calculation types are Object Oriented and can reuse existing Java code.

The score calculation must be read-only. It must not change the planning entities or the problem facts in any way. For example, it must not call a setter method on a planning entity in the score calculation.

Planner will not recalculate the score of a Solution if it can predict it (unless an environmentMode assertion is enabled). For example, after a winning step is done, there is no need to calculate the score because that move was done and undone earlier. As a result, there is no guarantee that changes applied during score calculation actually happen.

To update planning entities when the planning variable change, use shadow variables instead.

5.3.2. Easy Java Score Calculation

An easy way to implement your score calculation in Java.

  • Advantages:

    • Plain old Java: no learning curve

    • Opportunity to delegate score calculation to an existing code base or legacy system

  • Disadvantages:

Implement the one method of the interface EasyScoreCalculator:

public interface EasyScoreCalculator<Solution_> {

    Score calculateScore(Solution_ solution);

}

For example in n queens:

public class NQueensEasyScoreCalculator implements EasyScoreCalculator<NQueens> {

    public SimpleScore calculateScore(NQueens nQueens) {
        int n = nQueens.getN();
        List<Queen> queenList = nQueens.getQueenList();

        int score = 0;
        for (int i = 0; i < n; i++) {
            for (int j = i + 1; j < n; j++) {
                Queen leftQueen = queenList.get(i);
                Queen rightQueen = queenList.get(j);
                if (leftQueen.getRow() != null && rightQueen.getRow() != null) {
                    if (leftQueen.getRowIndex() == rightQueen.getRowIndex()) {
                        score--;
                    }
                    if (leftQueen.getAscendingDiagonalIndex() == rightQueen.getAscendingDiagonalIndex()) {
                        score--;
                    }
                    if (leftQueen.getDescendingDiagonalIndex() == rightQueen.getDescendingDiagonalIndex()) {
                        score--;
                    }
                }
            }
        }
        return SimpleScore.valueOf(score);
    }

}

Configure it in the solver configuration:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <easyScoreCalculatorClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.solver.score.NQueensEasyScoreCalculator</easyScoreCalculatorClass>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

To configure values of an EasyScoreCalculator dynamically in the solver configuration (so the Benchmarker can tweak those parameters), add the easyScoreCalculatorCustomProperties element and use custom properties:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <easyScoreCalculatorClass>...MyEasyScoreCalculator</easyScoreCalculatorClass>
    <easyScoreCalculatorCustomProperties>
      <myCacheSize>1000</myCacheSize>
    </easyScoreCalculatorCustomProperties>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

5.3.3. Incremental Java Score Calculation

A way to implement your score calculation incrementally in Java.

  • Advantages:

    • Very fast and scalable

      • Currently the fastest if implemented correctly

  • Disadvantages:

    • Hard to write

      • A scalable implementation heavily uses maps, indexes, …​ (things the Drools rule engine can do for you)

      • You have to learn, design, write and improve all these performance optimizations yourself

    • Hard to read

      • Regular score constraint changes can lead to a high maintenance cost

Implement all the methods of the interface IncrementalScoreCalculator and extend the class AbstractIncrementalScoreCalculator:

public interface IncrementalScoreCalculator<Solution_> {

    void resetWorkingSolution(Solution_ workingSolution);

    void beforeEntityAdded(Object entity);

    void afterEntityAdded(Object entity);

    void beforeVariableChanged(Object entity, String variableName);

    void afterVariableChanged(Object entity, String variableName);

    void beforeEntityRemoved(Object entity);

    void afterEntityRemoved(Object entity);

    Score calculateScore();

}
incrementalScoreCalculatorSequenceDiagram

For example in n queens:

public class NQueensAdvancedIncrementalScoreCalculator extends AbstractIncrementalScoreCalculator<NQueens> {

    private Map<Integer, List<Queen>> rowIndexMap;
    private Map<Integer, List<Queen>> ascendingDiagonalIndexMap;
    private Map<Integer, List<Queen>> descendingDiagonalIndexMap;

    private int score;

    public void resetWorkingSolution(NQueens nQueens) {
        int n = nQueens.getN();
        rowIndexMap = new HashMap<Integer, List<Queen>>(n);
        ascendingDiagonalIndexMap = new HashMap<Integer, List<Queen>>(n * 2);
        descendingDiagonalIndexMap = new HashMap<Integer, List<Queen>>(n * 2);
        for (int i = 0; i < n; i++) {
            rowIndexMap.put(i, new ArrayList<Queen>(n));
            ascendingDiagonalIndexMap.put(i, new ArrayList<Queen>(n));
            descendingDiagonalIndexMap.put(i, new ArrayList<Queen>(n));
            if (i != 0) {
                ascendingDiagonalIndexMap.put(n - 1 + i, new ArrayList<Queen>(n));
                descendingDiagonalIndexMap.put((-i), new ArrayList<Queen>(n));
            }
        }
        score = 0;
        for (Queen queen : nQueens.getQueenList()) {
            insert(queen);
        }
    }

    public void beforeEntityAdded(Object entity) {
        // Do nothing
    }

    public void afterEntityAdded(Object entity) {
        insert((Queen) entity);
    }

    public void beforeVariableChanged(Object entity, String variableName) {
        retract((Queen) entity);
    }

    public void afterVariableChanged(Object entity, String variableName) {
        insert((Queen) entity);
    }

    public void beforeEntityRemoved(Object entity) {
        retract((Queen) entity);
    }

    public void afterEntityRemoved(Object entity) {
        // Do nothing
    }

    private void insert(Queen queen) {
        Row row = queen.getRow();
        if (row != null) {
            int rowIndex = queen.getRowIndex();
            List<Queen> rowIndexList = rowIndexMap.get(rowIndex);
            score -= rowIndexList.size();
            rowIndexList.add(queen);
            List<Queen> ascendingDiagonalIndexList = ascendingDiagonalIndexMap.get(queen.getAscendingDiagonalIndex());
            score -= ascendingDiagonalIndexList.size();
            ascendingDiagonalIndexList.add(queen);
            List<Queen> descendingDiagonalIndexList = descendingDiagonalIndexMap.get(queen.getDescendingDiagonalIndex());
            score -= descendingDiagonalIndexList.size();
            descendingDiagonalIndexList.add(queen);
        }
    }

    private void retract(Queen queen) {
        Row row = queen.getRow();
        if (row != null) {
            List<Queen> rowIndexList = rowIndexMap.get(queen.getRowIndex());
            rowIndexList.remove(queen);
            score += rowIndexList.size();
            List<Queen> ascendingDiagonalIndexList = ascendingDiagonalIndexMap.get(queen.getAscendingDiagonalIndex());
            ascendingDiagonalIndexList.remove(queen);
            score += ascendingDiagonalIndexList.size();
            List<Queen> descendingDiagonalIndexList = descendingDiagonalIndexMap.get(queen.getDescendingDiagonalIndex());
            descendingDiagonalIndexList.remove(queen);
            score += descendingDiagonalIndexList.size();
        }
    }

    public SimpleScore calculateScore() {
        return SimpleScore.valueOf(score);
    }

}

Configure it in the solver configuration:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <incrementalScoreCalculatorClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.solver.score.NQueensAdvancedIncrementalScoreCalculator</incrementalScoreCalculatorClass>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

A piece of incremental score calculator code can be difficult to write and to review. Assert its correctness by using an EasyScoreCalculator to fulfill the assertions triggered by the environmentMode.

To configure values of an IncrementalScoreCalculator dynamically in the solver configuration (so the Benchmarker can tweak those parameters), add the incrementalScoreCalculatorCustomProperties element and use custom properties:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <incrementalScoreCalculatorClass>...MyIncrementalScoreCalculator</incrementalScoreCalculatorClass>
    <incrementalScoreCalculatorCustomProperties>
      <myCacheSize>1000</myCacheSize>
    </incrementalScoreCalculatorCustomProperties>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>
5.3.3.1. ConstraintMatchAwareIncrementalScoreCalculator

Optionally, also implement the ConstraintMatchAwareIncrementalScoreCalculator interface to:

  • Explain a score by splitting it up per score constraint with ScoreDirector.getConstraintMatchTotals().

  • Visualize or sort planning entities by how many constraints each one breaks with ScoreDirector.getIndictmentMap().

  • Receive a detailed analysis if the IncrementalScoreCalculator is corrupted in FAST_ASSERT or FULL_ASSERT environmentMode,

public interface ConstraintMatchAwareIncrementalScoreCalculator<Solution_> {

    void resetWorkingSolution(Solution_ workingSolution, boolean constraintMatchEnabled);

    Collection<ConstraintMatchTotal> getConstraintMatchTotals();

    Map<Object, Indictment> getIndictmentMap();
}

For example in machine reassignment, create one ConstraintMatchTotal per constraint type and call addConstraintMatch() for each constraint match:

public class MachineReassignmentIncrementalScoreCalculator
        implements ConstraintMatchAwareIncrementalScoreCalculator<MachineReassignment> {
    ...

    @Override
    public void resetWorkingSolution(MachineReassignment workingSolution, boolean constraintMatchEnabled) {
        resetWorkingSolution(workingSolution);
        // ignore constraintMatchEnabled, it is always presumed enabled
    }

    @Override
    public Collection<ConstraintMatchTotal> getConstraintMatchTotals() {
        ConstraintMatchTotal maximumCapacityMatchTotal = new ConstraintMatchTotal(
                CONSTRAINT_PACKAGE, "maximumCapacity", HardSoftLongScore.ZERO);
        ...
        for (MrMachineScorePart machineScorePart : machineScorePartMap.values()) {
            for (MrMachineCapacityScorePart machineCapacityScorePart : machineScorePart.machineCapacityScorePartList) {
                if (machineCapacityScorePart.maximumAvailable < 0L) {
                    maximumCapacityMatchTotal.addConstraintMatch(
                            Arrays.asList(machineCapacityScorePart.machineCapacity),
                            HardSoftLongScore.valueOf(machineCapacityScorePart.maximumAvailable, 0));
                }
            }
        }
        ...
        List<ConstraintMatchTotal> constraintMatchTotalList = new ArrayList<>(4);
        constraintMatchTotalList.add(maximumCapacityMatchTotal);
        ...
        return constraintMatchTotalList;
    }

    @Override
    public Map<Object, Indictment> getIndictmentMap() {
        return null; // Calculate it non-incrementally from getConstraintMatchTotals()
    }
}

That getConstraintMatchTotals() code often duplicates some of the logic of the normal IncrementalScoreCalculator methods. Drools Score Calculation doesn’t have this disadvantage, because it is constraint match aware automatically when needed, without any extra domain-specific code.

5.3.4. InitializingScoreTrend

The InitializingScoreTrend specifies how the Score will change as more and more variables are initialized (while the already initialized variables do not change). Some optimization algorithms (such Construction Heuristics and Exhaustive Search) run faster if they have such information.

For the Score (or each score level separately), specify a trend:

  • ANY (default): Initializing an extra variable can change the score positively or negatively. Gives no performance gain.

  • ONLY_UP (rare): Initializing an extra variable can only change the score positively. Implies that:

    • There are only positive constraints

    • And initializing the next variable can not unmatch a positive constraint that was matched by a previous initialized variable.

  • ONLY_DOWN: Initializing an extra variable can only change the score negatively. Implies that:

    • There are only negative constraints

    • And initializing the next variable can not unmatch a negative constraint that was matched by a previous initialized variable.

Most use cases only have negative constraints. Many of those have an InitializingScoreTrend that only goes down:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <scoreDrl>.../cloudBalancingScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>
    <initializingScoreTrend>ONLY_DOWN</initializingScoreTrend>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

Alternatively, you can also specify the trend for each score level separately:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <scoreDrl>.../cloudBalancingScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>
    <initializingScoreTrend>ONLY_DOWN/ONLY_DOWN</initializingScoreTrend>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

5.3.5. Invalid Score Detection

When you put the environmentMode in FULL_ASSERT (or FAST_ASSERT), it will detect score corruption in the incremental score calculation. However, that will not verify that your score calculator actually implements your score constraints as your business desires. For example, one score rule might consistently match the wrong pattern. To verify the score rules against an independent implementation, configure a assertionScoreDirectorFactory:

  <environmentMode>FAST_ASSERT</environmentMode>
  ...
  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <scoreDrl>org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nQueensScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>
    <assertionScoreDirectorFactory>
      <easyScoreCalculatorClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.solver.score.NQueensEasyScoreCalculator</easyScoreCalculatorClass>
    </assertionScoreDirectorFactory>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

This way, the scoreDrl will be validated by the EasyScoreCalculator.

This works well to isolate score corruption, but to verify that the score rules implement the real business needs, a unit test with a ScoreVerifier is usually better.

5.4. Score Calculation Performance Tricks

5.4.1. Overview

The Solver will normally spend most of its execution time running the score calculation (which is called in its deepest loops). Faster score calculation will return the same solution in less time with the same algorithm, which normally means a better solution in equal time.

5.4.2. Score Calculation Speed

After solving a problem, the Solver will log the score calculation speed per second. This is a good measurement of Score calculation performance, despite that it is affected by non score calculation execution time. It depends on the problem scale of the problem dataset. Normally, even for high scale problems, it is higher than 1000, except if you are using an EasyScoreCalculator.

When improving your score calculation, focus on maximizing the score calculation speed, instead of maximizing the best score. A big improvement in score calculation can sometimes yield little or no best score improvement, for example when the algorithm is stuck in a local or global optima. If you are watching the calculation speed instead, score calculation improvements are far more visible.

Furthermore, watching the calculation speed allows you to remove or add score constraints, and still compare it with the original’s calculation speed. Comparing the best score with the original’s best score is pointless: it’s comparing apples and oranges.

5.4.3. Incremental Score Calculation (with Deltas)

When a Solution changes, incremental score calculation (AKA delta based score calculation) calculates the delta with the previous state to find the new Score, instead of recalculating the entire score on every solution evaluation.

For example, when a single queen A moves from row 1 to 2, it will not bother to check if queen B and C can attack each other, since neither of them changed:

incrementalScoreCalculationNQueens04

Similarly in employee rostering:

incrementalScoreCalculationEmployeeRostering

This is a huge performance and scalability gain. Drools score calculation gives you this huge scalability gain without forcing you to write a complicated incremental score calculation algorithm. Just let the Drools rule engine do the hard work.

Notice that the speedup is relative to the size of your planning problem (your n), making incremental score calculation far more scalable.

5.4.4. Avoid Calling Remote Services During Score Calculation

Do not call remote services in your score calculation (except if you are bridging EasyScoreCalculator to a legacy system). The network latency will kill your score calculation performance. Cache the results of those remote services if possible.

If some parts of a constraint can be calculated once, when the Solver starts, and never change during solving, then turn them into cached problem facts.

5.4.5. Pointless Constraints

If you know a certain constraint can never be broken (or it is always broken), do not write a score constraint for it. For example in n queens, the score calculation does not check if multiple queens occupy the same column, because a Queen's column never changes and every Solution starts with each Queen on a different column.

Do not go overboard with this. If some datasets do not use a specific constraint but others do, just return out of the constraint as soon as you can. There is no need to dynamically change your score calculation based on the dataset.

5.4.6. Built-in Hard Constraint

Instead of implementing a hard constraint, it can sometimes be built in. For example, if Lecture A should never be assigned to Room X, but it uses ValueRangeProvider on Solution, so the Solver will often try to assign it to Room X too (only to find out that it breaks a hard constraint). Use a ValueRangeProvider on the planning entity or filtered selection to define that Course A should only be assigned a Room different than X.

This can give a good performance gain in some use cases, not just because the score calculation is faster, but mainly because most optimization algorithms will spend less time evaluating infeasible solutions. However, usually this not a good idea because there is a real risk of trading short term benefits for long term harm:

  • Many optimization algorithms rely on the freedom to break hard constraints when changing planning entities, to get out of local optima.

  • Both implementation approaches have limitations (feature compatibility, disabling automatic performance optimizations), as explained in their documentation.

5.4.7. Other Score Calculation Performance Tricks

  • Verify that your score calculation happens in the correct Number type. If you are making the sum of int values, do not let Drools sum it in a double which takes longer.

  • For optimal performance, always use server mode (java -server). We have seen performance increases of 50% by turning on server mode.

  • For optimal performance, use the latest Java version. For example, in the past we have seen performance increases of 30% by switching from java 1.5 to 1.6.

  • Always remember that premature optimization is the root of all evil. Make sure your design is flexible enough to allow configuration based tweaking.

5.4.8. Score Trap

Make sure that none of your score constraints cause a score trap. A trapped score constraint uses the same weight for different constraint matches, when it could just as easily use a different weight. It effectively lumps its constraint matches together, which creates a flatlined score function for that constraint. This can cause a solution state in which several moves need to be done to resolve or lower the weight of that single constraint. Some examples of score traps:

  • You need two doctors at each table, but you are only moving one doctor at a time. So the solver has no incentive to move a doctor to a table with no doctors. Punish a table with no doctors more than a table with only one doctor in that score constraint in the score function.

  • Two exams need to be conducted at the same time, but you are only moving one exam at a time. So the solver has to move one of those exams to another timeslot without moving the other in the same move. Add a coarse-grained move that moves both exams at the same time.

For example, consider this score trap. If the blue item moves from an overloaded computer to an empty computer, the hard score should improve. The trapped score implementation fails to do that:

scoreTrap

The Solver should eventually get out of this trap, but it will take a lot of effort (especially if there are even more processes on the overloaded computer). Before they do that, they might actually start moving more processes into that overloaded computer, as there is no penalty for doing so.

Avoiding score traps does not mean that your score function should be smart enough to avoid local optima. Leave it to the optimization algorithms to deal with the local optima.

Avoiding score traps means to avoid, for each score constraint individually, a flatlined score function.

Always specify the degree of infeasibility. The business will often say "if the solution is infeasible, it does not matter how infeasible it is." While that is true for the business, it is not true for score calculation as it benefits from knowing how infeasible it is. In practice, soft constraints usually do this naturally and it is just a matter of doing it for the hard constraints too.

There are several ways to deal with a score trap:

  • Improve the score constraint to make a distinction in the score weight. For example, penalize -1hard for every missing CPU, instead of just -1hard if any CPU is missing.

  • If changing the score constraint is not allowed from the business perspective, add a lower score level with a score constraint that makes such a distinction. For example, penalize -1subsoft for every missing CPU, on top of -1hard if any CPU is missing. The business ignores the subsoft score level.

  • Add coarse-grained moves and union select them with the existing fine-grained moves. A coarse-grained move effectively does multiple moves to directly get out of a score trap with a single move. For example, move multiple items from the same container to another container.

5.4.9. stepLimit Benchmark

Not all score constraints have the same performance cost. Sometimes one score constraint can kill the score calculation performance outright. Use the Benchmarker to do a one minute run and check what happens to the score calculation speed if you comment out all but one of the score constraints.

5.4.10. Fairness Score Constraints

Some use cases have a business requirement to provide a fair schedule (usually as a soft score constraint), for example:

  • Fairly distribute the workload amongst the employees, to avoid envy.

  • Evenly distribute the workload amongst assets, to improve reliability.

Implementing such a constraint can seem difficult (especially because there are different ways to formalize fairness), but usually the squared workload implementation behaves most desirable. For each employee/asset, count the workload w and subtract w² from the score.

fairnessScoreConstraint

As shown above, the squared workload implementation guarantees that if you select two employees from a given solution and make their distribution between those two employees fairer, then the resulting new solution will have a better overall score. Do not just use the difference from the average workload, as that can lead to unfairness, as demonstrated below.

fairnessScoreConstraintPitfall

Instead of the squared workload, it is also possible to use the variance (squared difference to the average) or the standard deviation (square root of the variance). This has no effect on the score comparison, because the average will not change during planning. It is just more work to implement (because the average needs to be known) and trivially slower (because the calculation is a bit longer).

When the workload is perfectly balanced, the user often likes to see a 0 score, instead of the distracting -34soft in the image above (for the last solution which is almost perfectly balanced). To nullify this, either add the average multiplied by the number of entities to the score or instead show the variance or standard deviation in the UI.

5.5. Constraint Configuration: Adjust Constraint Weights dynamically

Deciding the correct weight and level for each constraint is not easy. It often involves negotiating with different stakeholders and their priorities. Furthermore, quantifying the impact of soft constraints is often a new experience for business managers, so they 'll need a number of iterations to get it right.

Don’t get stuck between a rock and a hard place. Provide a UI to adjust the constraint weights and visualize the resulting solution, so the business managers can tweak the constraint weights themselves:

parameterizeTheScoreWeights

5.5.1. Create a Constraint Configuration

First, create a new class to hold the constraint weights and other constraint parameters. Annotate it with @ConstraintConfiguration:

@ConstraintConfiguration
public class ConferenceConstraintConfiguration {
    ...
}

There will be exactly one instance of this class per planning solution. The planning solution and the constraint configuration have a one to one relationship, but they serve a different purpose, so they aren’t merged into a single class. A @ConstraintConfiguration class can extend a parent @ConstraintConfiguration class, which can be useful in international use cases with many regional constraints.

Add the constraint configuration on the planning solution and annotate that field or property with @ConstraintConfigurationProvider:

@PlanningSolution
public class ConferenceSolution {

    @ConstraintConfigurationProvider
    private ConferenceConstraintConfiguration constraintConfiguration;

    ...
}

The @ConstraintConfigurationProvider annotation automatically exposes the constraint configuration as a problem fact, there is no need to add a @ProblemFactProperty annotation.

The constraint configuration class holds the constraint weights, but it can also hold constraint parameters. For example in conference scheduling, the minimum pause constraint has a constraint weight (like any other constraint), but it also has a constraint parameter that defines the length of the minimum pause between two talks of the same speaker. That pause length depends on the conference (= the planning problem): in some big conferences 20 minutes isn’t enough to go from one room to the other. That pause length is a field in the constraint configuration without a @ConstraintWeight annotation.

5.5.2. Add a Constraint Weight for each Constraint

In the constraint configuration class, add a @ConstraintWeight field or property for each constraint:

@ConstraintConfiguration(constraintPackage = "...conferencescheduling.solver")
public class ConferenceConstraintConfiguration {

    @ConstraintWeight("Speaker conflict")
    private HardMediumSoftScore speakerConflict = HardMediumSoftScore.ofHard(10);

    @ConstraintWeight("Theme track conflict")
    private HardMediumSoftScore themeTrackConflict = HardMediumSoftScore.ofSoft(10);
    @ConstraintWeight("Content conflict")
    private HardMediumSoftScore contentConflict = HardMediumSoftScore.ofSoft(100);

    ...
}

The type of the constraint weights must be the same score class as the planning solution’s score member. For example in conference scheduling, ConferenceSolution.getScore() and ConferenceConstraintConfiguration.getSpeakerConflict() both return a HardMediumSoftScore.

A constraint weight cannot be null. Give each constraint weight a default value, but expose them in a UI so the business users can tweak them. The example above uses the ofHard(), ofMedium() and ofSoft() methods to do that. Notice how it defaults the content conflict constraint as ten times more important than the theme track conflict constraint. Normally, a constraint weight only uses one score level, but it’s possible to use multiple score levels (at a small performance cost).

Each constraint has a constraint package and a constraint name, together they form the constraint id. These connect the constraint weight with the constraint implementation. For each constraint weight, there must be a constraint implementation with the same package and the same name.

  • The @ConstraintConfiguration annotation has a constraintPackage property that defaults to the package of the constraint configuration class. Most cases with Drools score calculation, need to override that because the DRL’s use another package. For example, the DRL below uses the package …​conferencescheduling.solver, so the constraint configuration above specifies a constraintPackage. Cases with Constraint streams, normally don’t need to specify it.

  • The @ConstraintWeight annotation has a value which is the constraint name (for example "Speaker conflict"). It inherits the constraint package from the @ConstraintConfiguration, but it can override that, for example @ConstraintWeight(constraintPackage = "…​region.france", …​) to use a different constraint package than some of the other weights.

So every constraint weight ends up with a constraint package and a constraint name. Each constraint weight links with a constraint implementation, for example in Drools score calculation:

package ...conferencescheduling.solver;

rule "Speaker conflict"
    when
        ...
    then
        scoreHolder.penalize(kcontext);
end

rule "Theme track conflict"
    when
        ...
    then
        scoreHolder.penalize(kcontext, ...);
end

rule "Content conflict"
    when
        ...
    then
        scoreHolder.penalize(kcontext, ...);
end

Each of the constraint weights defines the score level and score weight of their constraint. The constraint implementation calls reward() or penalize() and the constraint weight is automatically applied.

If the constraint implementation provides a match weight, that match weight is multiplied with the constraint weight. For example, the content conflict constraint weight defaults to 100soft and the constraint implementation penalizes each match based on the number of shared content tags:

    @ConstraintWeight("Content conflict")
    private HardMediumSoftScore contentConflict = HardMediumSoftScore.ofSoft(100);
rule "Content conflict"
    when
        $talk1 : Talk(...)
        $talk2 : Talk(...)
    then
        scoreHolder.penalize(kcontext,
                $talk2.overlappingContentCount($talk1));
end

So when 2 overlapping talks share only 1 content tag, the score is impacted by -100soft. But when 2 overlapping talks share 3 content tags, the match weight is 3, so the score is impacted by -300soft.

5.6. Explaining the Score: Which Constraints Are Broken?

The easiest way to explain the score during development is to print the return value of explainBestScore(), but only use that method for diagnostic purposes:

System.out.println(solver.explainBestScore());

For example in conference scheduling, this prints that talk S51 is responsible for breaking the hard constraint Speaker required room tag:

Explanation of score (-1hard/-806soft):
    Constraint match totals:
        -1hard: constraint (Speaker required room tag) has 1 matches:
            -1hard: justifications ([S51])
        -340soft: constraint (Theme track conflict) has 32 matches:
            -20soft: justifications ([S68, S66])
            -20soft: justifications ([S61, S44])
            ...
        ...
    Indictments (top 5 of 72):
        -1hard/-22soft: justification (S51) has 12 matches:
            -1hard: constraint (Speaker required room tag)
            -10soft: constraint (Theme track conflict)
            ...
        ...

Do not attempt to parse this string or use it in your UI or exposed services. Instead use the ConstraintMatch API below and do it properly.

5.6.1. Using Score Calculation Outside the Solver

If other parts of your application, for example your webUI, need to calculate the score of a solution, reuse the ScoreDirectorFactory of the Solver to build a separate ScoreDirector for that webUI:

ScoreDirectorFactory<CloudBalance> scoreDirectorFactory = solver.getScoreDirectorFactory();
try (ScoreDirector<CloudBalance> guiScoreDirector = scoreDirectorFactory.buildScoreDirector()) {
    ...
}

The try ARM will call ScoreDirector.close() when the ScoreDirector becomes useless, to avoid a memory leak, especially with Drools score calculation.

Then use it when you need to calculate the Score of a Solution:

guiScoreDirector.setWorkingSolution(cloudBalance);
Score score = guiScoreDirector.calculateScore();

Furthermore, the ScoreDirector can explain the score through constraint match totals and/or indictments:

scoreVisualization

5.6.2. Constraint Match Total: Break down the Score by Constraint

To break down the score per constraint (so per score rule with Drools score calculation), get the ConstraintMatchTotals from the ScoreDirector:

Collection<ConstraintMatchTotal> constraintMatchTotals = guiScoreDirector.getConstraintMatchTotals();
for (ConstraintMatchTotal constraintMatchTotal : constraintMatchTotals) {
    String constraintName = constraintMatchTotal.getConstraintName();
    // The score impact of that constraint
    HardSoftScore totalScore = (HardSoftScore) constraintMatchTotal.getScore();

    for (ConstraintMatch constraintMatch : constraintMatchTotal.getConstraintMatchSet()) {
        List<Object> justificationList = constraintMatch.getJustificationList();
        HardSoftScore score = (HardSoftScore) constraintMatch.getScore();
        ...
    }
}

Each ConstraintMatchTotal represents one constraint (so one score rule) and has a part of the overall score. The sum of all the ConstraintMatchTotal.getScore() equals the overall score.

5.6.3. Indictment Heat Map: Visualize the Hot Planning Entities

To show a heat map in the UI that highlights the planning entities and problem facts have an impact on the Score, get the Indictment map from the ScoreDirector:

Map<Object, Indictment> indictmentMap = guiScoreDirector.getIndictmentMap();
for (CloudProcess process : cloudBalance.getProcessList()) {
    Indictment indictment = indictmentMap.get(process);
    if (indictment == null) {
        continue;
    }
    // The score impact of that planning entity
    HardSoftScore totalScore = (HardSoftScore) indictment.getScore();

    for (ConstraintMatch constraintMatch : indictment.getConstraintMatchSet()) {
        String constraintName = constraintMatch.getConstraintName();
        HardSoftScore score = (HardSoftScore) constraintMatch.getScore();
        ...
    }
}

Each Indictment is the sum of all constraints where that justification object is involved with. The sum of all the Indictment.getScoreTotal() differs from the overall score, because multiple Indictments can share the same ConstraintMatch.

5.7. Testing score constraints with JUnit

It’s recommended to write a unit test for each score constraint individually to check that it behaves correctly.

Add a test scoped dependency to the optaplanner-test jar to take advantage of the JUnit integration and use the ScoreVerifier classes to test score rules in DRL (or a constraint match aware incremental score calculator). For example, suppose we want to test these score rules:

global HardSoftScoreHolder scoreHolder;

rule "requiredCpuPowerTotal"
    when
        ...
    then
        scoreHolder.addHardConstraintMatch(...);
end

...

rule "computerCost"
    when
        ...
    then
        scoreHolder.addSoftConstraintMatch(...);
end

For each score rule, we have a separate @Test that only tests the effect of that score rule on the score:

public class CloudBalancingScoreConstraintTest {

    private HardSoftScoreVerifier<CloudBalance> scoreVerifier = new HardSoftScoreVerifier<>(
            SolverFactory.createFromXmlResource(
                    "org/optaplanner/examples/cloudbalancing/solver/cloudBalancingSolverConfig.xml"));

    @Test
    public void requiredCpuPowerTotal() {
        CloudComputer c1 = new CloudComputer(1L, 1000, 1, 1, 1);
        CloudComputer c2 = new CloudComputer(2L, 200, 1, 1, 1);
        CloudProcess p1 = new CloudProcess(1L, 700, 0, 0);
        CloudProcess p2 = new CloudProcess(2L, 70, 0, 0);
        CloudBalance solution = new CloudBalance(0L,
                Arrays.asList(c1, c2),
                Arrays.asList(p1, p2));
        // Uninitialized
        scoreVerifier.assertHardWeight("requiredCpuPowerTotal", 0, solution);
        p1.setComputer(c1);
        p2.setComputer(c1);
        // Usage 700 + 70 is within capacity 1000 of c1
        scoreVerifier.assertHardWeight("requiredCpuPowerTotal", 0, solution);
        p1.setComputer(c2);
        p2.setComputer(c2);
        // Usage 700 + 70 is above capacity 200 of c2
        scoreVerifier.assertHardWeight("requiredCpuPowerTotal", -570, solution);
    }

    ...

    @Test
    public void computerCost() {
        CloudComputer c1 = new CloudComputer(1L, 1, 1, 1, 200);
        CloudComputer c2 = new CloudComputer(2L, 1, 1, 1, 30);
        CloudProcess p1 = new CloudProcess(1L, 0, 0, 0);
        CloudProcess p2 = new CloudProcess(2L, 0, 0, 0);
        CloudBalance solution = new CloudBalance(0L,
                Arrays.asList(c1, c2),
                Arrays.asList(p1, p2));
        // Uninitialized
        scoreVerifier.assertSoftWeight("computerCost", 0, solution);
        p1.setComputer(c1);
        p2.setComputer(c1);
        // Pay 200 for c1
        scoreVerifier.assertSoftWeight("computerCost", -200, solution);
        p2.setComputer(c2);
        // Pay 200 + 30 for c1 and c2
        scoreVerifier.assertSoftWeight("computerCost", -230, solution);
    }

}

There is a ScoreVerifier implementation for each Score implementation. In the assertHardWeight() and assertSoftWeight() methods, the weight of the other score rules is ignored (even those of the same score level).

A ScoreVerifier does not work well to isolate score corruption, use an assertionScoreDirectorFactory instead.

6. Constraint Streams Score Calculation

Constraint streams are an Functional Programming form of incremental score calculation in plain Java 8+ that is fast, scalable and debuggable.

6.1. Introduction

Using Java 8’s Streams API, we could implement an easy score calculator that uses a functional approach:

List<Talk> talkList = schedule.getTalkList();
talkList.stream()
        .filter(talk -> talk.hasAnyUnavailableSpeaker())
        .forEach(talk -> penalize(talk.getDurationInMinutes()));

However, that scales poorly because it doesn’t do an incremental calculation. When the planning variable of a single Talk changes, to recalculate the score, the normal Streams API has to execute the entire stream from scratch. So it doesn’t do deltas. Nor does it support justifications.

The ConstraintStreams API does do deltas and support justifications.

Constraints stream will be implemented soon.

7. Drools Score Calculation

7.1. Overview

Implement your score calculation using the Drools rule engine. Every score constraint is written as one or more score rules.

  • Advantages:

    • Incremental score calculation for free

      • Because most DRL syntax uses forward chaining, it does incremental calculation without any extra code

    • Score constraints are isolated as separate rules

      • Easy to add or edit existing score rules

    • Flexibility to augment your score constraints by

      • Defining them in decision tables

        • Excel (XLS) spreadsheet

        • KIE Workbench WebUI

      • Translate them into natural language with DSL

      • Store and release in the KIE Workbench repository

    • Performance optimizations in future versions for free

      • In every release, the Drools rule engine tends to become faster

  • Disadvantages:

    • DRL learning curve

    • Usage of DRL

      • Polyglot fear can prohibit the use of a new language such as DRL in some organizations

7.2. Drools Score Rules Configuration

There are several ways to define where your score rules live.

7.2.1. A scoreDrl Resource on the Classpath

This is the easy way. The score rules live in a DRL file which is provided as a classpath resource. Just add the score rules DRL file in the solver configuration as a <scoreDrl> element:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <scoreDrl>org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nQueensScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

In a typical project (following the Maven directory structure), that DRL file would be located at $PROJECT_DIR/src/main/resources/org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nQueensScoreRules.drl (even for a war project).

The <scoreDrl> element expects a classpath resource, as defined by ClassLoader.getResource(String), it does not accept a File, nor an URL, nor a webapp resource. See below to use a File instead.

Add multiple <scoreDrl> elements if the score rules are split across multiple DRL files.

Optionally, you can also set drools configuration properties:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <scoreDrl>org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nQueensScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>
    <kieBaseConfigurationProperties>
      <drools.equalityBehavior>...</drools.equalityBehavior>
    </kieBaseConfigurationProperties>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

To enable property reactive by default, without a @propertyReactive on the domain classes, add <drools.propertySpecific>ALWAYS</drools.propertySpecific> in there. Otherwise Planner automatically changes the Drools default to ALLOWED so property reactive is not active by default.

7.2.2. A scoreDrlFile

To use File on the local file system, instead of a classpath resource, add the score rules DRL file in the solver configuration as a <scoreDrlFile> element:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <scoreDrlFile>/home/ge0ffrey/tmp/nQueensScoreRules.drl</scoreDrlFile>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

For portability reasons, a classpath resource is recommended over a File. An application build on one computer, but used on another computer, might not find the file on the same location. Worse, if they use a different Operating System, it is hard to choose a portable file path.

Add multiple <scoreDrlFile> elements if the score rules are split across multiple DRL files.

7.2.3. A ksessionName in a Kjar from a Maven repository

This way allows you to use score rules defined by the Workbench or build a kjar and deploy it to the Execution Server. Both the score rules and the solver configuration are resources in a kjar. Clients can obtain that kjar either from the local classpath, from a local Maven repository or even from a remote Maven repository.

The score rules still live in a DRL file, but the KieContainer finds that DRL file through the META-INF/kmodule.xml file:

<kmodule xmlns="http://www.drools.org/xsd/kmodule">
  <configuration>
    <!-- Don't enable propertyReactive unless there is a @PropertyReactive annotation on the domain classes -->
    <property key="drools.propertySpecific" value="ALLOWED"/>
  </configuration>
  <kbase name="nQueensKbase" packages="org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.solver">
    <ksession name="nQueensKsession"/>
  </kbase>
</kmodule>

The kmodule above will pick up all the DRL files in the package org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.solver. A kbase can even extend another kbase.

Starting from version 7.0, Drools enables property reactive by default for all classes. This means if you have a non-simple getter and forget to apply @Modifies correctly, corruption occurs. To avoid this, simply set drools.propertySpecific to ALLOWED as shown above.

Add the ksession name in the solver configuration as a <ksessionName> element:

  <scoreDirectorFactory>
    <ksessionName>nQueensKsession</ksessionName>
  </scoreDirectorFactory>

In this approach, it’s required to use a SolverFactory.createFromKieContainerXmlResource(…​) method to build the SolverFactory. If no <ksessionName> element is specified, the default ksession of the kmodule.xml is used.

7.3. Implementing a Score Rule

Here is an example of a score constraint implemented as a score rule in a DRL file:

rule "multipleQueensHorizontal"
    when
        Queen($id : id, row != null, $i : rowIndex)
        Queen(id > $id, rowIndex == $i)
    then
        scoreHolder.addConstraintMatch(kcontext, -1);
end

This score rule will fire once for every two queens with the same rowIndex. The (id > $id) condition is needed to assure that for two queens A and B, it can only fire for (A, B) and not for (B, A), (A, A) or (B, B). Let us take a closer look at this score rule on this solution of four queens:

unsolvedNQueens04

In this solution the multipleQueensHorizontal score rule will fire for six queen couples: (A, B), (A, C), (A, D), (B, C), (B, D) and (C, D). Because none of the queens are on the same vertical or diagonal line, this solution will have a score of -6. An optimal solution of four queens has a score of 0.

Notice that every score rule uses at least one planning entity class (directly or indirectly through a logically inserted fact).

It is a waste of time to write a score rule that only relates to problem facts, as the consequence will never change during planning, no matter what the possible solution.

A ScoreHolder instance is asserted into the KieSession as a global called scoreHolder. The score rules need to (directly or indirectly) update that instance to influence the score of a solution state.

The kcontext variable is a magic variable in Drools Expert. The scoreHolder's method uses it to do incremental score calculation correctly and to create a ConstraintMatch instance.

7.4. Weighing Score Rules

If you’ve configured a constraint configuration, the score level and score weight of each constraint are beautifully decoupled from the constraint implementation, so they can be changed by the business users more easily.

In that case, use the reward() and penalize() methods of the ScoreHolder:

package org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.solver;
...
global SimpleScoreHolder scoreHolder;

rule "multipleQueensHorizontal"
    when
        Queen($id : id, row != null, $i : rowIndex)
        Queen(id > $id, rowIndex == $i)
    then
        scoreHolder.penalize(kcontext);
end

// multipleQueensVertical is obsolete because it is always 0

rule "multipleQueensAscendingDiagonal"
    when
        Queen($id : id, row != null, $i : ascendingDiagonalIndex)
        Queen(id > $id, ascendingDiagonalIndex == $i)
    then
        scoreHolder.penalize(kcontext);
end

rule "multipleQueensDescendingDiagonal"
    when
        Queen($id : id, row != null, $i : descendingDiagonalIndex)
        Queen(id > $id, descendingDiagonalIndex == $i)
    then
        scoreHolder.penalize(kcontext);
end

They automatically impact the score for each constraint match by the score weight defined in the constraint configuration.

The drl file must define a package (otherwise Drools defaults to defaultpkg) and it must match with the constraint configuration's constraintPackage.

To learn more about the Drools rule language (DRL), consult the Drools documentation.

The score weight of some constraints depends on the constraint match. In these cases, provide a match weight to the reward() or penalize() methods. The score impact is the constraint weight multiplied with the match weight.

For example in conference scheduling, the impact of a content conflict, depends on the number of shared content tags between 2 overlapping talks:

rule "Content conflict"
    when
        $talk1 : Talk(...)
        $talk2 : Talk(...)
    then
        scoreHolder.penalize(kcontext,
                $talk2.overlappingContentCount($talk1));
end

Presume its constraint weight is set to 100soft. So when 2 overlapping talks share only 1 content tag, the score is impacted by -100soft. But when 2 overlapping talks share 3 content tags, the match weight is 3, so the score is impacted by -300soft.

If there is no constraint configuration, you’ll need to hard-code the weight in the constraint implementations:

global HardSoftScoreHolder scoreHolder;

// RoomCapacity: For each lecture, the number of students that attend the course must be less or equal
// than the number of seats of all the rooms that host its lectures.
rule "roomCapacity"
    when
        $room : Room($capacity : capacity)
        $lecture : Lecture(room == $room, studentSize > $capacity, $studentSize : studentSize)
    then
        // Each student above the capacity counts as one point of penalty.
        scoreHolder.addSoftConstraintMatch(kcontext, ($capacity - $studentSize));
end

// CurriculumCompactness: Lectures belonging to a curriculum should be adjacent
// to each other (i.e., in consecutive periods).
// For a given curriculum we account for a violation every time there is one lecture not adjacent
// to any other lecture within the same day.
rule "curriculumCompactness"
    when
        ...
    then
        // Each isolated lecture in a curriculum counts as two points of penalty.
        scoreHolder.addSoftConstraintMatch(kcontext, -2);
end

Notice how addSoftConstraintMatch() specifies that it’s a soft constraint, and needs a negative number to penalize each match. Otherwise it would reward such matches. The parameter ($capacity - $studentSize) always results into a negative number because studentSize > $capacity.

8. Shadow Variable

8.1. Introduction

A shadow variable is a planning variable whose correct value can be deduced from the state of the genuine planning variables. Even though such a variable violates the principle of normalization by definition, in some use cases it can be very practical to use a shadow variable, especially to express the constraints more naturally. For example in vehicle routing with time windows: the arrival time at a customer for a vehicle can be calculated based on the previously visited customers of that vehicle (and the known travel times between two locations).

planningVariableListener

When the customers for a vehicle change, the arrival time for each customer is automatically adjusted. For more information, see the vehicle routing domain model.

From a score calculation perspective, a shadow variable is like any other planning variable. From an optimization perspective, Planner effectively only optimizes the genuine variables (and mostly ignores the shadow variables): it just assures that when a genuine variable changes, any dependent shadow variables are changed accordingly.

Any class that has at least one shadow variable, is a planning entity class (even if it has no genuine planning variables). That class must be defined in the solver configuration (unless classes are automatically scanned) and have a @PlanningEntity annotation.

A genuine planning entity class has at least one genuine planning variable, but can have shadow variables too. A shadow planning entity class has no genuine planning variables and at least one shadow planning variable.

There are several built-in shadow variables:

8.2. Bi-directional Variable (Inverse Relation Shadow Variable)

Two variables are bi-directional if their instances always point to each other (unless one side points to null and the other side does not exist). So if A references B, then B references A.

bidirectionalVariable

For a non-chained planning variable, the bi-directional relationship must be a many to one relationship. To map a bi-directional relationship between two planning variables, annotate the master side (which is the genuine side) as a normal planning variable:

@PlanningEntity
public class CloudProcess {

    @PlanningVariable(...)
    public CloudComputer getComputer() {
        return computer;
    }
    public void setComputer(CloudComputer computer) {...}

}

And then annotate the other side (which is the shadow side) with a @InverseRelationShadowVariable annotation on a Collection (usually a Set or List) property:

@PlanningEntity
public class CloudComputer {

    @InverseRelationShadowVariable(sourceVariableName = "computer")
    public List<CloudProcess> getProcessList() {
        return processList;
    }

}

Register this class as a planning entity, otherwise Planner won’t detect it and the shadow variable won’t update. The sourceVariableName property is the name of the genuine planning variable on the return type of the getter (so the name of the genuine planning variable on the other side).

The shadow property, which is Collection (usually List, Set or SortedSet), can never be null. If no genuine variable references that shadow entity, then it is an empty collection. Furthermore it must be a mutable Collection because once Planner starts initializing or changing genuine planning variables, it will add and remove elements to the Collections of those shadow variables accordingly.

For a chained planning variable, the bi-directional relationship is always a one to one relationship. In that case, the genuine side looks like this:

@PlanningEntity
public class Customer ... {

    @PlanningVariable(graphType = PlanningVariableGraphType.CHAINED, ...)
    public Standstill getPreviousStandstill() {
        return previousStandstill;
    }
    public void setPreviousStandstill(Standstill previousStandstill) {...}

}

And the shadow side looks like this:

@PlanningEntity
public class Standstill {

    @InverseRelationShadowVariable(sourceVariableName = "previousStandstill")
    public Customer getNextCustomer() {
         return nextCustomer;
    }
    public void setNextCustomer(Customer nextCustomer) {...}

}

Register this class as a planning entity, otherwise Planner won’t detect it and the shadow variable won’t update.

The input planning problem of a Solver must not violate bi-directional relationships. If A points to B, then B must point to A. Planner will not violate that principle during planning, but the input must not violate it either.

8.3. Anchor Shadow Variable

An anchor shadow variable is the anchor of a chained variable.

Annotate the anchor property as a @AnchorShadowVariable annotation:

@PlanningEntity
public class Customer {

    @AnchorShadowVariable(sourceVariableName = "previousStandstill")
    public Vehicle getVehicle() {...}
    public void setVehicle(Vehicle vehicle) {...}

}

This class should already be registered as a planning entity. The sourceVariableName property is the name of the chained variable on the same entity class.

8.4. Custom VariableListener

To update a shadow variable, Planner uses a VariableListener. To define a custom shadow variable, write a custom VariableListener: implement the interface and annotate it on the shadow variable that needs to change.

    @PlanningVariable(...)
    public Standstill getPreviousStandstill() {
        return previousStandstill;
    }

    @CustomShadowVariable(variableListenerClass = VehicleUpdatingVariableListener.class,
            sources = {@PlanningVariableReference(variableName = "previousStandstill")})
    public Vehicle getVehicle() {
        return vehicle;
    }

Register this class as a planning entity if it hasn’t already. The variableName is the (genuine or shadow) variable that triggers changes to this shadow variable.

If the source variable’s class is different than the shadow variable’s class, also specify the entityClass in the @PlanningVariableReference annotation and make sure the shadow variable’s class is registered as a planning entity, otherwise Planner won’t detect it and the shadow variable won’t update.

For example, the VehicleUpdatingVariableListener assures that every Customer in a chain has the same Vehicle, namely the chain’s anchor.

public class VehicleUpdatingVariableListener implements VariableListener<Customer> {

    public void afterEntityAdded(ScoreDirector scoreDirector, Customer customer) {
        updateVehicle(scoreDirector, customer);
    }

    public void afterVariableChanged(ScoreDirector scoreDirector, Customer customer) {
        updateVehicle(scoreDirector, customer);
    }

    ...

    protected void updateVehicle(ScoreDirector scoreDirector, Customer sourceCustomer) {
        Standstill previousStandstill = sourceCustomer.getPreviousStandstill();
        Vehicle vehicle = previousStandstill == null ? null : previousStandstill.getVehicle();
        Customer shadowCustomer = sourceCustomer;
        while (shadowCustomer != null && shadowCustomer.getVehicle() != vehicle) {
            scoreDirector.beforeVariableChanged(shadowCustomer, "vehicle");
            shadowCustomer.setVehicle(vehicle);
            scoreDirector.afterVariableChanged(shadowCustomer, "vehicle");
            shadowCustomer = shadowCustomer.getNextCustomer();
        }
    }

}

A VariableListener can only change shadow variables. It must never change a genuine planning variable or a problem fact.

Any change of a shadow variable must be told to the ScoreDirector.

If one VariableListener changes two shadow variables (because having two separate VariableListeners would be inefficient), then annotate only the first shadow variable with the variableListenerClass and let the other shadow variable(s) reference the first shadow variable:

    @PlanningVariable(...)
    public Standstill getPreviousStandstill() {
        return previousStandstill;
    }

    @CustomShadowVariable(variableListenerClass = TransportTimeAndCapacityUpdatingVariableListener.class,
            sources = {@PlanningVariableReference(variableName = "previousStandstill")})
    public Integer getTransportTime() {
        return transportTime;
    }

    @CustomShadowVariable(variableListenerRef = @PlanningVariableReference(variableName = "transportTime"))
    public Integer getCapacity() {
        return capacity;
    }

8.5. VariableListener triggering order

All shadow variables are triggered by a VariableListener, regardless if it’s a built-in or a custom shadow variable. The genuine and shadow variables form a graph, that determines the order in which the afterEntityAdded(), afterVariableChanged() and afterEntityRemoved() methods are called:

shadowVariableOrder

In the example above, D could have also been ordered after E (or F) because there is no direct or indirect dependency between D and E (or F).

Planner guarantees that:

  • The first VariableListener's after*() methods trigger after the last genuine variable has changed. Therefore the genuine variables (A and B in the example above) are guaranteed to be in a consistent state across all its instances (with values A1, A2 and B1 in the example above) because the entire Move has been applied.

  • The second VariableListener's after*() methods trigger after the last first shadow variable has changed. Therefore the first shadow variable (C in the example above) are guaranteed to be in consistent state across all its instances (with values C1 and C2 in the example above). And of course the genuine variables too.

  • And so forth.

Planner does not guarantee the order in which the after*() methods are called for the sameVariableListener with different parameters (such as A1 and A2 in the example above), although they are likely to be in the order in which they were affected.

By default, Planner does not guarantee that the events are unique. For example, if a shadow variable on an entity is changed twice in the same move (for example by two different genuine variables), then that will cause the same event twice on the VariableListeners that are listening to that original shadow variable. To avoid dealing with that complexity, overwrite the method requiresUniqueEntityEvents() to receive unique events at the cost of a small performance penalty:

public class StartTimeUpdatingVariableListener implements VariableListener<Task> {

    @Override
    public boolean requiresUniqueEntityEvents() {
        return true;
    }

    ...
}

9. Optimization Algorithms

9.1. Search Space Size in the Real World

The number of possible solutions for a planning problem can be mind blowing. For example:

  • Four queens has 256 possible solutions (4^4) and two optimal solutions.

  • Five queens has 3125 possible solutions (5^5) and one optimal solution.

  • Eight queens has 16777216 possible solutions (8^8) and 92 optimal solutions.

  • 64 queens has more than 10^115 possible solutions (64^64).

  • Most real-life planning problems have an incredible number of possible solutions and only one or a few optimal solutions.

For comparison: the minimal number of atoms in the known universe (10^80). As a planning problem gets bigger, the search space tends to blow up really fast. Adding only one extra planning entity or planning value can heavily multiply the running time of some algorithms.

cloudBalanceSearchSpaceSize

Calculating the number of possible solutions depends on the design of the domain model:

searchSpaceSizeCalculation

This search space size calculation includes infeasible solutions (if they can be represented by the model), because:

  • The optimal solution might be infeasible.

  • There are many types of hard constraints that cannot be incorporated in the formula practically. For example, in Cloud Balancing, try incorporating the CPU capacity constraint in the formula.

Even in cases where adding some of the hard constraints in the formula is practical (for example, Course Scheduling), the resulting search space is still huge.

An algorithm that checks every possible solution (even with pruning, such as in Branch And Bound) can easily run for billions of years on a single real-life planning problem. The aim is to find the best solution in the available timeframe. Planning competitions (such as the International Timetabling Competition) show that Local Search variations (Tabu Search, Simulated Annealing, Late Acceptance, …​) usually perform best for real-world problems given real-world time limitations.

9.2. Does Planner Find the Optimal Solution?

The business wants the optimal solution, but they also have other requirements:

  • Scale out: Large production data sets must not crash and have also good results.

  • Optimize the right problem: The constraints must match the actual business needs.

  • Available time: The solution must be found in time, before it becomes useless to execute.

  • Reliability: Every data set must have at least a decent result (better than a human planner).

Given these requirements, and despite the promises of some salesmen, it is usually impossible for anyone or anything to find the optimal solution. Therefore, Planner focuses on finding the best solution in available time. In "realistic, independent competitions", it often comes out as the best reusable software.

The nature of NP-complete problems make scaling a prime concern.

The quality of a result from a small data set is no indication of the quality of a result from a large data set.

Scaling issues cannot be mitigated by hardware purchases later on. Start testing with a production sized data set as soon as possible. Do not assess quality on small data sets (unless production encounters only such data sets). Instead, solve a production sized data set and compare the results of longer executions, different algorithms and - if available - the human planner.

9.3. Architecture Overview

Planner is the first framework to combine optimization algorithms (metaheuristics, …​) with score calculation by a rule engine (such as Drools Expert). This combination is very efficient, because:

  • A rule engine, such as Drools Expert, is great for calculating the score of a solution of a planning problem. It makes it easy and scalable to add additional soft or hard constraints such as, "a teacher should not teach more then seven hours a day". It does delta-based score calculation without any extra code. However it tends to be not suitable to actually find new solutions.

  • An optimization algorithm is great at finding new improving solutions for a planning problem, without necessarily brute-forcing every possibility. However, it needs to know the score of a solution and offers no support in calculating that score efficiently.

architectureOverview

9.4. Optimization Algorithms Overview

Planner supports three families of optimization algorithms: Exhaustive Search, Construction Heuristics and Metaheuristics. In practice, Metaheuristics (in combination with Construction Heuristics to initialize) are the recommended choice:

scalabilityOfOptimizationAlgorithms

Each of these algorithm families have multiple optimization algorithms:

Table 4. Optimization Algorithms Overview
Algorithm Scalable? Optimal? Easy to use? Tweakable? Requires CH?

Exhaustive Search (ES)

  Brute Force

0/5

5/5

5/5

0/5

No

  Branch And Bound

0/5

5/5

4/5

2/5

No

Construction heuristics (CH)

  First Fit

5/5

1/5

5/5

1/5

No

  First Fit Decreasing

5/5

2/5

4/5

2/5

No

  Weakest Fit

5/5

2/5

4/5

2/5

No

  Weakest Fit Decreasing

5/5

2/5

4/5

2/5

No

  Strongest Fit

5/5

2/5

4/5

2/5

No

  Strongest Fit Decreasing

5/5

2/5

4/5

2/5

No

  Cheapest Insertion

3/5

2/5

5/5

2/5

No

  Regret Insertion

3/5

2/5

5/5

2/5

No

Metaheuristics (MH)

  Local Search (LS)

    Hill Climbing

5/5

2/5

4/5

3/5

Yes

    Tabu Search

5/5

4/5

3/5

5/5

Yes

    Simulated Annealing

5/5

4/5

2/5

5/5

Yes

    Late Acceptance

5/5

4/5

3/5

5/5

Yes

    Step Counting Hill Climbing

5/5

4/5

3/5

5/5

Yes

    Variable Neighborhood Descent

3/5

3/5

2/5

5/5

Yes

  Evolutionary Algorithms (EA)

    Evolutionary Strategies

3/5

3/5

2/5

5/5

Yes

    Genetic Algorithms

3/5

3/5

2/5

5/5

Yes

To learn more about metaheuristics, see Essentials of Metaheuristics or Clever Algorithms.

9.5. Which Optimization Algorithms Should I Use?

The best optimization algorithms configuration to use depends heavily on your use case. However, this basic procedure provides a good starting configuration that will produce better than average results.

  1. Start with a quick configuration that involves little or no configuration and optimization code: See First Fit.

  2. Next, implement planning entity difficulty comparison and turn it into First Fit Decreasing.

  3. Next, add Late Acceptance behind it:

    1. First Fit Decreasing.

    2. Late Acceptance.

At this point, the return on invested time lowers and the result is likely to be sufficient.

However, this can be improved at a lower return on invested time. Use the Benchmarker and try a couple of different Tabu Search, Simulated Annealing and Late Acceptance configurations, for example:

  1. First Fit Decreasing: Tabu Search.

Use the Benchmarker to improve the values for the size parameters.

Other experiments can also be run. For example, the following multiple algorithms can be combined together:

  1. First Fit Decreasing

  2. Late Acceptance (relatively long time)

  3. Tabu Search (relatively short time)

9.6. Power tweaking or default parameter values

Many optimization algorithms have parameters that affect results and scalability. Planner applies configuration by exception, so all optimization algorithms have default parameter values. This is very similar to the Garbage Collection parameters in a JVM: most users have no need to tweak them, but power users often do.

The default parameter values are sufficient for many cases (and especially for prototypes), but if development time allows, it may be beneficial to power tweak them with the benchmarker for better results and scalability on a specific use case. The documentation for each optimization algorithm also declares the advanced configuration for power tweaking.

The default value of parameters will change between minor versions, to improve them for most users. The advanced configuration can be used to prevent unwanted changes, however, this is not recommended.

9.7. Solver Phase

A Solver can use multiple optimization algorithms in sequence. Each optimization algorithm is represented by one solver Phase. There is never more than one Phase solving at the same time.

Some Phase implementations can combine techniques from multiple optimization algorithms, but it is still just one Phase. For example: a Local Search Phase can do Simulated Annealing with entity Tabu.

Here is a configuration that runs three phases in sequence:

<solver>
  ...
  <constructionHeuristic>
    ... <!-- First phase: First Fit Decreasing -->
  </constructionHeuristic>
  <localSearch>
    ... <!-- Second phase: Late Acceptance -->
  </localSearch>
  <localSearch>
    ... <!-- Third phase: Tabu Search -->
  </localSearch>
</solver>

The solver phases are run in the order defined by solver configuration.

  • When the first Phase terminates, the second Phase starts, and so on.

  • When the last Phase terminates, the Solver terminates.

Usually, a Solver will first run a construction heuristic and then run one or multiple metaheuristics:

generalPhaseSequence

If no phases are configured, Planner will default to a Construction Heuristic phase followed by a Local Search phase.

Some phases (especially construction heuristics) will terminate automatically. Other phases (especially metaheuristics) will only terminate if the Phase is configured to terminate:

<solver>
  ...
  <termination><!-- Solver termination -->
    <secondsSpentLimit>90</secondsSpentLimit>
  </termination>
  <localSearch>
    <termination><!-- Phase termination -->
      <secondsSpentLimit>60</secondsSpentLimit><!-- Give the next phase a chance to run too, before the Solver terminates -->
    </termination>
    ...
  </localSearch>
  <localSearch>
    ...
  </localSearch>
</solver>

If the Solver terminates (before the last Phase terminates itself), the current phase is terminated and all subsequent phases will not run.

9.8. Scope Overview

A solver will iteratively run phases. Each phase will usually iteratively run steps. Each step, in turn, usually iteratively runs moves. These form four nested scopes:

  1. Solver

  2. Phase

  3. Step

  4. Move

scopeOverview

Configure logging to display the log messages of each scope.

9.9. Termination

Not all phases terminate automatically and may take a significant amount of time. A Solver can be terminated synchronously by up-front configuration, or asynchronously from another thread.

Metaheuristic phases in particular need to be instructed to stop solving. This can be because of a number of reasons, for example, if the time is up, or the perfect score has been reached just before its solution is used. Finding the optimal solution cannot be relied on (unless you know the optimal score), because a metaheuristic algorithm is generally unaware of the optimal solution.

This is not an issue for real-life problems, as finding the optimal solution may take more time than is available. Finding the best solution in the available time is the most important outcome.

If no termination is configured (and a metaheuristic algorithm is used), the Solver will run forever, until terminateEarly() is called from another thread. This is especially common during real-time planning.

For synchronous termination, configure a Termination on a Solver or a Phase when it needs to stop. The built-in implementations of these should be sufficient, but custom terminations are supported too. Every Termination can calculate a time gradient (needed for some optimization algorithms), which is a ratio between the time already spent solving and the estimated entire solving time of the Solver or Phase.

9.9.1. Time Spent Termination

Terminates when an amount of time has been used.

  <termination>
    <millisecondsSpentLimit>500</millisecondsSpentLimit>
  </termination>

Besides milliseconds you can also use:

  • Seconds

      <termination>
        <secondsSpentLimit>10</secondsSpentLimit>
      </termination>
  • Minutes

      <termination>
        <minutesSpentLimit>5</minutesSpentLimit>
      </termination>
  • Hours

      <termination>
        <hoursSpentLimit>1</hoursSpentLimit>
      </termination>
  • Days

      <termination>
        <daysSpentLimit>2</daysSpentLimit>
      </termination>

Multiple time types can be used together, for example to configure 150 minutes, either configure it directly:

  <termination>
    <minutesSpentLimit>150</minutesSpentLimit>
  </termination>

Or use a combination that sums up to 150 minutes:

  <termination>
    <hoursSpentLimit>2</hoursSpentLimit>
    <minutesSpentLimit>30</minutesSpentLimit>
  </termination>

This Termination will most likely sacrifice perfect reproducibility (even with environmentMode REPRODUCIBLE) because the available CPU time differs frequently between runs:

  • The available CPU time influences the number of steps that can be taken, which might be a few more or less.

  • The Termination might produce slightly different time gradient values, which will send time gradient-based algorithms (such as Simulated Annealing) on a radically different path.

9.9.2. Unimproved Time Spent Termination

Terminates when the best score has not improved in a specified amount of time.

  <localSearch>
    <termination>
      <unimprovedMillisecondsSpentLimit>500</unimprovedMillisecondsSpentLimit>
    </termination>
  </localSearch>

Besides milliseconds you can also use:

  • Seconds

      <localSearch>
        <termination>
          <unimprovedSecondsSpentLimit>10</unimprovedSecondsSpentLimit>
        </termination>
      </localSearch>
  • Minutes

      <localSearch>
        <termination>
          <unimprovedMinutesSpentLimit>5</unimprovedMinutesSpentLimit>
        </termination>
      </localSearch>
  • Hours

      <localSearch>
        <termination>
          <unimprovedHoursSpentLimit>1</unimprovedHoursSpentLimit>
        </termination>
      </localSearch>
  • Days

      <localSearch>
        <termination>
          <unimprovedDaysSpentLimit>1</unimprovedDaysSpentLimit>
        </termination>
      </localSearch>

Just like time spent termination, combinations are summed up.

This termination should not be applied to Construction Heuristics as they only update the best solution at the end. Configuring it on a specific Phase (such as <localSearch>), instead of on the Solver itself is often a better option.

This Termination will most likely sacrifice perfect reproducibility (even with environmentMode REPRODUCIBLE) as the available CPU time differs frequently between runs:

  • The available CPU time influences the number of steps that can be taken, which might be a few more or less.

  • The Termination might produce slightly different time gradient values, which will send time gradient based algorithms (such as Simulated Annealing) on a radically different path.

Optionally, configure a score difference threshold by which the best score must improve in the specified time. For example, if the score doesn’t improve by at least 100 soft points every 30 seconds or less, it terminates:

  <localSearch>
    <termination>
      <unimprovedSecondsSpentLimit>30</unimprovedSecondsSpentLimit>
      <unimprovedScoreDifferenceThreshold>0hard/100soft</unimprovedScoreDifferenceThreshold>
    </termination>
  </localSearch>

If the score improves by 1 hard point and drops 900 soft points, it’s still meets the threshold, because 1hard/-900soft is larger than the threshold 0hard/100soft.

On the other hand, a threshold of 1hard/0soft is not met by any new best solution that improves 1 hard point at the expense of 1 or more soft points, because 1hard/-100soft is smaller than the threshold 1hard/0soft.

To require a feasibility improvement every 30 seconds while avoiding the pitfall above, use a wildcard * for lower score levels that are allowed to deteriorate if a higher score level improves:

  <localSearch>
    <termination>
      <unimprovedSecondsSpentLimit>30</unimprovedSecondsSpentLimit>
      <unimprovedScoreDifferenceThreshold>1hard/*soft</unimprovedScoreDifferenceThreshold>
    </termination>
  </localSearch>

This effectively implies a threshold of 1hard/-2147483648soft.

9.9.3. BestScoreTermination

BestScoreTermination terminates when a certain score has been reached. Use this Termination where the perfect score is known, for example for four queens (which uses a SimpleScore):

  <termination>
    <bestScoreLimit>0</bestScoreLimit>
  </termination>

A planning problem with a HardSoftScore may look like this:

  <termination>
    <bestScoreLimit>0hard/-5000soft</bestScoreLimit>
  </termination>

A planning problem with a BendableScore with three hard levels and one soft level may look like this:

  <termination>
    <bestScoreLimit>[0/0/0]hard/[-5000]soft</bestScoreLimit>
  </termination>

In this instance, Termination once a feasible solution has been reached is not practical because it requires a bestScoreLimit such as 0hard/-2147483648soft. Use the next termination instead.

9.9.4. BestScoreFeasibleTermination

Terminates as soon as a feasible solution has been discovered. Requires that Score implements FeasibilityScore.

  <termination>
    <bestScoreFeasible>true</bestScoreFeasible>
  </termination>

This Termination is usually combined with other terminations.

9.9.5. StepCountTermination

Terminates when a number of steps has been reached. This is useful for hardware performance independent runs.

  <localSearch>
    <termination>
      <stepCountLimit>100</stepCountLimit>
    </termination>
  </localSearch>

This Termination can only be used for a Phase (such as <localSearch>), not for the Solver itself.

9.9.6. UnimprovedStepCountTermination

Terminates when the best score has not improved in a number of steps. This is useful for hardware performance independent runs.

  <localSearch>
    <termination>
      <unimprovedStepCountLimit>100</unimprovedStepCountLimit>
    </termination>
  </localSearch>

If the score has not improved recently, it is unlikely to improve in a reasonable timeframe. It has been observed that once a new best solution is found (even after a long time without improvement on the best solution), the next few steps tend to improve the best solution.

This Termination can only be used for a Phase (such as <localSearch>), not for the Solver itself.

9.9.7. ScoreCalculationCountTermination

ScoreCalculationCountTermination terminates when a number of score calculations have been reached. This is often the sum of the number of moves and the number of steps. This is useful for benchmarking.

  <termination>
    <scoreCalculationCountLimit>100000</scoreCalculationCountLimit>
  </termination>

Switching EnvironmentMode can heavily impact when this termination ends.

9.9.8. Combining Multiple Terminations

Terminations can be combined, for example: terminate after 100 steps or if a score of 0 has been reached:

  <termination>
    <terminationCompositionStyle>OR</terminationCompositionStyle>
    <stepCountLimit>100</stepCountLimit>
    <bestScoreLimit>0</bestScoreLimit>
  </termination>

Alternatively you can use AND, for example: terminate after reaching a feasible score of at least -100 and no improvements in 5 steps:

  <termination>
    <terminationCompositionStyle>AND</terminationCompositionStyle>
    <unimprovedStepCountLimit>5</unimprovedStepCountLimit>
    <bestScoreLimit>-100</bestScoreLimit>
  </termination>

This example ensures it does not just terminate after finding a feasible solution, but also completes any obvious improvements on that solution before terminating.

9.9.9. Asynchronous Termination from Another Thread

Asychronous termination from another thread occurs when a Solver needs to be terminated early from another thread, for example, due to a user action or a server restart. This cannot be configured by a Termination as it is impossible to predict when and if it will occur. Therefore the Solver interface has the following thread-safe methods:

public interface Solver<Solution_> {
    ...

    boolean terminateEarly();
    boolean isTerminateEarly();

}

When calling the terminateEarly() method from another thread, the Solver will terminate at its earliest convenience and the solve(Solution) method will return (in the original Solver thread).

Interrupting the Solver thread (which is the thread that called Solver.solve(Solution)) has the same affect as calling terminateEarly() except that it leaves that thread in the interrupted state. This guarantees a graceful shutdown when an ExecutorService (such as a thread pool) is shutdown because that only interrupts all active threads in the pool.

9.10. SolverEventListener

Each time a new best solution is found, a new BestSolutionChangedEvent is fired in the Solver thread.

To listen to such events, add a SolverEventListener to the Solver:

public interface Solver<Solution_> {
    ...

    void addEventListener(SolverEventListener<S> eventListener);
    void removeEventListener(SolverEventListener<S> eventListener);

}

The BestSolutionChangedEvent's newBestSolution may not be initialized or feasible. Use the isFeasible() method on BestSolutionChangedEvent's new best Score to detect such cases:

    solver.addEventListener(new SolverEventListener<CloudBalance>() {
        public void bestSolutionChanged(BestSolutionChangedEvent<CloudBalance> event) {
            // Ignore infeasible (including uninitialized) solutions
            if (event.getNewBestSolution().getScore().isFeasible()) {
                ...
            }
        }
    });

Use Score.isSolutionInitialized() instead of Score.isFeasible() to only ignore uninitialized solutions, but also accept infeasible solutions.

The bestSolutionChanged() method is called in the solver’s thread, as part of Solver.solve(). So it should return quickly to avoid slowing down the solving.

9.11. Custom Solver Phase

Run a custom optimization algorithm between phases or before the first phase to initialize the Solution, or to get a better score quickly. You will still want to reuse the score calculation. For example, to implement a custom Construction Heuristic without implementing an entire Phase.

Most of the time, a custom solver phase is not worth the development time investment. The supported Constructions Heuristics are configurable (use the Benchmarker to tweak them), Termination aware and support partially initialized solutions too.

The CustomPhaseCommand interface appears as follows:

public interface CustomPhaseCommand<Solution_> {
    ...

    void changeWorkingSolution(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector);

}

For example, extend AbstractCustomPhaseCommand and implement the changeWorkingSolution() method:

public class ToOriginalMachineSolutionInitializer extends AbstractCustomPhaseCommand<MachineReassignment> {

    public void changeWorkingSolution(ScoreDirector<MachineReassignment> scoreDirector) {
        MachineReassignment machineReassignment = scoreDirector.getWorkingSolution();
        for (MrProcessAssignment processAssignment : machineReassignment.getProcessAssignmentList()) {
            scoreDirector.beforeVariableChanged(processAssignment, "machine");
            processAssignment.setMachine(processAssignment.getOriginalMachine());
            scoreDirector.afterVariableChanged(processAssignment, "machine");
            scoreDirector.triggerVariableListeners();
        }
    }

}

Any change on the planning entities in a CustomPhaseCommand must be notified to the ScoreDirector.

Do not change any of the problem facts in a CustomPhaseCommand. That will corrupt the Solver because any previous score or solution was for a different problem. To do that, read about repeated planning and do it with a ProblemFactChange instead.

Configure the CustomPhaseCommand in the solver configuration:

<solver>
  ...
  <customPhase>
    <customPhaseCommandClass>org.optaplanner.examples.machinereassignment.solver.solution.initializer.ToOriginalMachineSolutionInitializer</customPhaseCommandClass>
  </customPhase>
  ... <!-- Other phases -->
</solver>

Configure multiple customPhaseCommandClass instances to run them in sequence.

If the changes of a CustomPhaseCommand do not result in a better score, the best solution will not be changed (so effectively nothing will have changed for the next Phase or CustomPhaseCommand). To force such changes anyway, use forceUpdateBestSolution:

  <customPhase>
    <customPhaseCommandClass>...MyCustomPhase</customPhaseCommandClass>
    <forceUpdateBestSolution>true</forceUpdateBestSolution>
  </customPhase>

If the Solver or a Phase wants to terminate while a CustomPhaseCommand is still running, it will wait to terminate until the CustomPhaseCommand is complete. This may take a significant amount of time. The built-in solver phases do not have this issue.

To configure values of a CustomPhaseCommand dynamically in the solver configuration (so the Benchmarker can tweak those parameters), add the customProperties element and use custom properties:

  <customPhase>
    <customPhaseCommandClass>...MyCustomPhase</customPhaseCommandClass>
    <customProperties>
      <mySelectionSize>5</mySelectionSize>
    </customProperties>
  </customPhase>

9.12. No Change Solver Phase

In rare cases, it’s useful not to run any solver phases. But by default, configuring no phase will trigger running the default phases. To avoid those, configure a NoChangePhase:

<solver>
  ...
  <noChangePhase/>
</solver>

9.13. Multithreaded Solving

There are several ways of doing multithreaded solving:

  • Multitenancy: solve different datasets in parallel

    • The SolverManager will make it even easier to set this up, in a future version.

  • Multi bet solving: solve 1 dataset with multiple, isolated solvers and take the best result.

    • Not recommended: This is a marginal gain for a high cost of hardware resources.

    • Use the Benchmarker during development to determine the most appropriate algorithm, although that’s only on average.

    • Use multithreaded incremental solving instead.

  • Partitioned Search: Split 1 dataset in multiple parts and solve them independently.

  • Multithreaded incremental solving: solve 1 dataset with multiple threads without sacrificing incremental score calculation.

    • Donate a portion of your CPU cores to Planner to scale up the score calculation speed and get the same results in fraction of the time.

    • Configure multithreaded incremental solving.

multiThreadingStrategies

A logging level of debug or trace might cause congestion multithreaded solving and slow down the score calculation speed.

9.13.1. @PlanningId

For some functionality (such as multithreaded solving and real-time planning), Planner needs to map problem facts and planning entities to an ID. Planner uses that ID to rebase a move from one thread’s solution state to another’s.

To enable such functionality, specify the @PlanningId annotation on the identification field or getter method, for example on the database ID:

public class CloudComputer {

    @PlanningId
    private Long id;

    ...
}

Or alternatively, on another type of ID:

public class User {

    @PlanningId
    private String username;

    ...
}

An @PlanningId property must be:

  • Unique for that specific class

    • It does not need to be unique across different problem fact classes (unless in that rare case that those classes are mixed in the same value range or planning entity collection).

  • An instance of a type that implements Object.hashCode() and Object.equals().

    • It’s recommended to use the type Integer, Long, String or UUID.

  • Never null by the time Solver.solve() is called.

9.13.2. Custom Thread Factory (WildFly, Android, GAE, …​)

The threadFactoryClass allows to plug in a custom ThreadFactory for environments where arbitrary thread creation should be avoided, such as most application servers (including WildFly), Android, or Google App Engine.

Configure the ThreadFactory on the solver to create the move threads and the Partition Search threads with it:

<solver>
  <threadFactoryClass>...MyAppServerThreadFactory</threadFactoryClass>
  ...
</solver>

9.13.3. Multithreaded Incremental Solving

Enable multithreaded incremental solving by adding a @PlanningId annotation on every planning entity class and planning value class. Then configure a moveThreadCount:

<solver>
  <moveThreadCount>AUTO</moveThreadCount>
  ...
</solver>

That one extra line heavily improves the score calculation speed, presuming that your machine has enough free CPU cores.

Advanced configuration:

<solver>
  <moveThreadCount>4</moveThreadCount>
  <moveThreadBufferSize>10</moveThreadBufferSize>
  <threadFactoryClass>...MyAppServerThreadFactory</threadFactoryClass>
  ...
</solver>

A moveThreadCount of 4 saturates almost 5 CPU cores: the 4 move threads fill up 4 CPU cores completely and the solver thread uses most of another CPU core.

The following moveThreadCounts are supported:

  • NONE (default): Don’t run any move threads. Use the single threaded code.

  • AUTO: Let Planner decide how many move threads to run in parallel. On machines or containers with little or no CPUs, this falls back to the single threaded code.

  • Static number: The number of move threads to run in parallel.

    <moveThreadCount>4</moveThreadCount>

    This can be 1 to enforce running the multithreaded code with only 1 move thread (which is less efficient than NONE).

  • JavaScript formula: Formula for the number of move threads to run in parallel. It can use the variable availableProcessorCount. For example:

    <moveThreadCount>(availableProcessorCount / 2) + 1</moveThreadCount>

It is counter-effective to set a moveThreadCount that is higher than the number of available CPU cores, as that will slow down the score calculation speed. One good reason to do it anyway, is to reproduce a bug of a high-end production machine.

Multithreaded solving is still reproducible, as long as the resolved moveThreadCount is stable. A run of the same solver configuration on 2 machines with a different number of CPUs, is still reproducible, unless the moveThreadCount is set to AUTO or a function of availableProcessorCount.

The moveThreadBufferSize power tweaks the number of moves that are selected but won’t be foraged. Setting it too low reduces performance, but setting it too high too. Unless you’re deeply familiar with the inner workings of multithreaded solving, don’t configure this parameter.

To run in an environment that doesn’t like arbitrary thread creation, use threadFactoryClass to plug in a custom thread factory.

10. Move and Neighborhood Selection

10.1. Move and Neighborhood Introduction

10.1.1. What is a Move?

A Move is a change (or set of changes) from a solution A to a solution B. For example, the move below changes queen C from row 0 to row 2:

singleMoveNQueens04

The new solution is called a neighbor of the original solution, because it can be reached in a single Move. Although a single move can change multiple queens, the neighbors of a solution should always be a very small subset of all possible solutions. For example, on that original solution, these are all possible changeMove's:

possibleMovesNQueens04

If we ignore the four changeMove's that have no impact and are therefore not doable, we can see that number of moves is n * (n - 1) = 12. This is far less than the number of possible solutions, which is n ^ n = 256. As the problem scales out, the number of possible moves increases far less than the number of possible solutions.

Yet, in four changeMove's or less we can reach any solution. For example we can reach a very different solution in three changeMove's:

sequentialMovesNQueens04

There are many other types of moves besides changeMove's. Many move types are included out-of-the-box, but you can also implement custom moves.

A Move can affect multiple entities or even create/delete entities. But it must not change the problem facts.

All optimization algorithms use Move's to transition from one solution to a neighbor solution. Therefore, all the optimization algorithms are confronted with Move selection: the craft of creating and iterating moves efficiently and the art of finding the most promising subset of random moves to evaluate first.

10.1.2. What is a MoveSelector?

A MoveSelector's main function is to create Iterator<Move> when needed. An optimization algorithm will iterate through a subset of those moves.

Here’s an example how to configure a changeMoveSelector for the optimization algorithm Local Search:

  <localSearch>
    <changeMoveSelector/>
    ...
  </localSearch>

Out of the box, this works and all properties of the changeMoveSelector are defaulted sensibly (unless that fails fast due to ambiguity). On the other hand, the configuration can be customized significantly for specific use cases. For example: you might want to configure a filter to discard pointless moves.

10.1.3. Subselecting of Entities, Values and Other Moves

To create a Move, a MoveSelector needs to select one or more planning entities and/or planning values to move. Just like MoveSelectors, EntitySelectors and ValueSelectors need to support a similar feature set (such as scalable just-in-time selection). Therefore, they all implement a common interface Selector and they are configured similarly.

A MoveSelector is often composed out of EntitySelectors, ValueSelectors or even other MoveSelectors, which can be configured individually if desired:

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector>
          ...
        </entitySelector>
        <valueSelector>
          ...
        </valueSelector>
        ...
      </changeMoveSelector>
      <swapMoveSelector>
        ...
      </swapMoveSelector>
    </unionMoveSelector>

Together, this structure forms a Selector tree:

selectorTree

The root of this tree is a MoveSelector which is injected into the optimization algorithm implementation to be (partially) iterated in every step.

10.2. Generic MoveSelectors

10.2.1. Generic MoveSelectors Overview

Name Description `toString()` example

Change move

Change 1 entity’s variable

Process-A {Computer-1 -> Computer-2}

Swap move

Swap all variables of 2 entities

Process-A {Computer-1} <-> Process-B {Computer-2}

Pillar change move

Change a set of entities with the same value

[Process-A, Process-B, Process-C] {Computer-1 -> Computer-2}

Pillar swap move

Swap 2 sets of entities with the same values

[Process-A, Process-B, Process-C] {Computer-1} <-> [Process-E, Process-F] {Computer-2}

Tail chain swap move

Swap 2 tails chains

Visit-A5 {Visit-A4} <-tailChainSwap-> Visit-B3 {Visit-B2}

Sub chain change move

Cut a subchain and paste it into another chain

[Visit-A5..Visit-A8] {Visit-A4 -> Visit-B2}

Sub chain swap move

Swap 2 subchains

[Visit-A5..Visit-A8] {Visit-A4} <-> [Visit-B3..Visit-B9] {Visit-B2}

10.2.2. ChangeMoveSelector

For one planning variable, the ChangeMove selects one planning entity and one planning value and assigns the entity’s variable to that value.

changeMove

Simplest configuration:

    <changeMoveSelector/>

If there are multiple entity classes or multiple planning variables for one entity class, a simple configuration will automatically unfold into a union of ChangeMove selectors for every planning variable.

Advanced configuration:

    <changeMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <entitySelector>
        <entityClass>...Lecture</entityClass>
        ...
      </entitySelector>
      <valueSelector variableName="room">
        ...
        <nearbySelection>...</nearbySelection>
      </valueSelector>
    </changeMoveSelector>

A ChangeMove is the finest grained move.

Almost every moveSelector configuration injected into a metaheuristic algorithm should include a changeMoveSelector. This guarantees that every possible Solution can be reached in theory through applying a number of moves in sequence. Of course, normally it is unioned with other, more coarse grained move selectors.

This move selector only supports phase or solver caching if it doesn’t apply on a chained variable.

10.2.3. SwapMoveSelector

The SwapMove selects two different planning entities and swaps the planning values of all their planning variables.

swapMove

Although a SwapMove on a single variable is essentially just two ChangeMoves, it’s often the winning step in cases that the first of the two ChangeMoves would not win because it leaves the solution in a state with broken hard constraints. For example: swapping the room of two lectures doesn’t bring the solution in a intermediate state where both lectures are in the same room which breaks a hard constraint.

Simplest configuration:

    <swapMoveSelector/>

If there are multiple entity classes, a simple configuration will automatically unfold into a union of SwapMove selectors for every entity class.

Advanced configuration:

    <swapMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <entitySelector>
        <entityClass>...Lecture</entityClass>
        ...
      </entitySelector>
      <secondaryEntitySelector>
        <entityClass>...Lecture</entityClass>
        ...
        <nearbySelection>...</nearbySelection>
      </secondaryEntitySelector>
      <variableNameInclude>room</variableNameInclude>
      <variableNameInclude>...</variableNameInclude>
    </swapMoveSelector>

The secondaryEntitySelector is rarely needed: if it is not specified, entities from the same entitySelector are swapped.

If one or more variableNameInclude properties are specified, not all planning variables will be swapped, but only those specified. For example for course scheduling, specifying only variableNameInclude room will make it only swap room, not period.

This move selector only supports phase or solver caching if it doesn’t apply on any chained variables.

10.2.4. PillarChangeMoveSelector

A pillar is a set of planning entities which have the same planning value(s) for their planning variable(s). The PillarChangeMove selects one entity pillar (or subset of those) and changes the value of one variable (which is the same for all entities) to another value.

pillarChangeMove

In the example above, queen A and C have the same value (row 0) and are moved to row 2. Also the yellow and blue process have the same value (computer Y) and are moved to computer X.

Simplest configuration:

    <pillarChangeMoveSelector/>

Advanced configuration:

    <pillarChangeMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <pillarSelector>
        <entitySelector>
          <entityClass>...Lecture</entityClass>
          ...
        </entitySelector>
        <subPillarEnabled>true</subPillarEnabled>
        <minimumSubPillarSize>1</minimumSubPillarSize>
        <maximumSubPillarSize>1000</maximumSubPillarSize>
      </pillarSelector>
      <valueSelector variableName="room">
        ...
      </valueSelector>
    </pillarChangeMoveSelector>

A sub pillar is a subset of entities that share the same value(s) for their variable(s). For example if queen A, B, C and D are all located on row 0, they are a pillar and [A, D] is one of the many sub pillars. If subPillarEnabled (defaults to true) is false, no sub pillars are selected. If sub pillars are enabled, the pillar itself is also included and the properties minimumSubPillarSize (defaults to 1) and maximumSubPillarSize (defaults to infinity) limit the size of the selected (sub) pillar.

The number of sub pillars of a pillar is exponential to the size of the pillar. For example a pillar of size 32 has (2^32 - 1) subpillars. Therefore a pillarSelector only supports JIT random selection (which is the default).

The other properties are explained in changeMoveSelector. This move selector does not support phase or solver caching and step caching scales badly memory wise.

10.2.5. PillarSwapMoveSelector

A pillar is a set of planning entities which have the same planning value(s) for their planning variable(s). The PillarSwapMove selects two different entity pillars and swaps the values of all their variables for all their entities.

pillarSwapMove

Simplest configuration:

    <pillarSwapMoveSelector/>

Advanced configuration:

    <pillarSwapMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <pillarSelector>
        <entitySelector>
          <entityClass>...Lecture</entityClass>
          ...
        </entitySelector>
        <subPillarEnabled>true</subPillarEnabled>
        <minimumSubPillarSize>1</minimumSubPillarSize>
        <maximumSubPillarSize>1000</maximumSubPillarSize>
      </pillarSelector>
      <secondaryPillarSelector>
        <entitySelector>
          ...
        </entitySelector>
        ...
      </secondaryPillarSelector>
      <variableNameInclude>room</variableNameInclude>
      <variableNameInclude>...</variableNameInclude>
    </pillarSwapMoveSelector>

The secondaryPillarSelector is rarely needed: if it is not specified, entities from the same pillarSelector are swapped.

The other properties are explained in swapMoveSelector and pillarChangeMoveSelector. This move selector does not support phase or solver caching and step caching scales badly memory wise.

10.2.6. TailChainSwapMoveSelector or 2-opt (chained variables only)

A tailChain is a set of planning entities with a chained planning variable which form a last part of a chain. The tailChainSwapMove selects a tail chain and swaps it with the tail chain of another planning value (in a different or the same anchor chain). If the targeted planning value, doesn’t have a tail chain, it swaps with nothing (resulting in a change like move). If it occurs within the same anchor chain, a partial chain reverse occurs. In academic papers, this is often called a 2-opt move.

Simplest configuration:

    <tailChainSwapMoveSelector/>

Advanced configuration:

    <subChainChangeMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <entitySelector>
        <entityClass>...Customer</entityClass>
        ...
      </entitySelector>
      <valueSelector variableName="previousStandstill">
        ...
        <nearbySelection>...</nearbySelection>
      </valueSelector>
    </subChainChangeMoveSelector>

The entitySelector selects the start of the tail chain that is being moved. The valueSelector selects to where that tail chain is moved. If it has a tail chain itself, that is moved to the location of the original tail chain. It uses a valueSelector instead of a secondaryEntitySelector to be able to include all possible 2opt moves (such as moving to the end of a tail) and to work correctly with nearby selection (because of asymmetric distances and also swapped entity distance gives an incorrect selection probability).

Although subChainChangeMoveSelector and subChainSwapMoveSelector include almost every possible tailChainSwapMove, experiments have shown that focusing on tailChainSwapMoves increases efficiency.

This move selector does not support phase or solver caching.

10.2.7. SubChainChangeMoveSelector (chained variables only)

A subChain is a set of planning entities with a chained planning variable which form part of a chain. The subChainChangeMoveSelector selects a subChain and moves it to another place (in a different or the same anchor chain).

Simplest configuration:

    <subChainChangeMoveSelector/>

Advanced configuration:

    <subChainChangeMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <entityClass>...Customer</entityClass>
      <subChainSelector>
        <valueSelector variableName="previousStandstill">
          ...
        </valueSelector>
        <minimumSubChainSize>2</minimumSubChainSize>
        <maximumSubChainSize>40</maximumSubChainSize>
      </subChainSelector>
      <valueSelector variableName="previousStandstill">
        ...
      </valueSelector>
      <selectReversingMoveToo>true</selectReversingMoveToo>
    </subChainChangeMoveSelector>

The subChainSelector selects a number of entities, no less than minimumSubChainSize (defaults to 1) and no more than maximumSubChainSize (defaults to infinity).

If minimumSubChainSize is 1 (which is the default), this selector might select the same move as a ChangeMoveSelector, at a far lower selection probability (because each move type has the same selection chance by default (not every move instance) and there are far more SubChainChangeMove instances than ChangeMove instances). However, don’t just remove the ChangeMoveSelector, because experiments show that it’s good to focus on ChangeMoves.

Furthermore, in a SubChainSwapMoveSelector, setting minimumSubChainSize prevents swapping a subchain of size 1 with a subchain of size 2 or more.

The selectReversingMoveToo property (defaults to true) enables selecting the reverse of every subchain too.

This move selector does not support phase or solver caching and step caching scales badly memory wise.

10.2.8. SubChainSwapMoveSelector (chained variables only)

The subChainSwapMoveSelector selects two different subChains and moves them to another place in a different or the same anchor chain.

Simplest configuration:

    <subChainSwapMoveSelector/>

Advanced configuration:

    <subChainSwapMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <entityClass>...Customer</entityClass>
      <subChainSelector>
        <valueSelector variableName="previousStandstill">
          ...
        </valueSelector>
        <minimumSubChainSize>2</minimumSubChainSize>
        <maximumSubChainSize>40</maximumSubChainSize>
      </subChainSelector>
      <secondarySubChainSelector>
        <valueSelector variableName="previousStandstill">
          ...
        </valueSelector>
        <minimumSubChainSize>2</minimumSubChainSize>
        <maximumSubChainSize>40</maximumSubChainSize>
      </secondarySubChainSelector>
      <selectReversingMoveToo>true</selectReversingMoveToo>
    </subChainSwapMoveSelector>

The secondarySubChainSelector is rarely needed: if it is not specified, entities from the same subChainSelector are swapped.

The other properties are explained in subChainChangeMoveSelector. This move selector does not support phase or solver caching and step caching scales badly memory wise.

10.3. Combining Multiple MoveSelectors

10.3.1. unionMoveSelector

A unionMoveSelector selects a Move by selecting one of its MoveSelector children to supply the next Move.

Simplest configuration:

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <...MoveSelector/>
      <...MoveSelector/>
      <...MoveSelector/>
      ...
    </unionMoveSelector>

Advanced configuration:

    <unionMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <selectorProbabilityWeightFactoryClass>...ProbabilityWeightFactory</selectorProbabilityWeightFactoryClass>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <fixedProbabilityWeight>...</fixedProbabilityWeight>
        ...
      </changeMoveSelector>
      <swapMoveSelector>
        <fixedProbabilityWeight>...</fixedProbabilityWeight>
        ...
      </swapMoveSelector>
      <...MoveSelector>
        <fixedProbabilityWeight>...</fixedProbabilityWeight>
        ...
      </...MoveSelector>
      ...
    </unionMoveSelector>

The selectorProbabilityWeightFactory determines in selectionOrder RANDOM how often a MoveSelector child is selected to supply the next Move. By default, each MoveSelector child has the same chance of being selected.

selectorProbabilityInUnion

Change the fixedProbabilityWeight of such a child to select it more often. For example, the unionMoveSelector can return a SwapMove twice as often as a ChangeMove:

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <fixedProbabilityWeight>1.0</fixedProbabilityWeight>
        ...
      </changeMoveSelector>
      <swapMoveSelector>
        <fixedProbabilityWeight>2.0</fixedProbabilityWeight>
        ...
      </swapMoveSelector>
    </unionMoveSelector>

The number of possible ChangeMoves is very different from the number of possible SwapMoves and furthermore it’s problem dependent. To give each individual Move the same selection chance (as opposed to each MoveSelector), use the FairSelectorProbabilityWeightFactory:

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <selectorProbabilityWeightFactoryClass>org.optaplanner.core.impl.heuristic.selector.common.decorator.FairSelectorProbabilityWeightFactory</selectorProbabilityWeightFactoryClass>
      <changeMoveSelector/>
      <swapMoveSelector/>
    </unionMoveSelector>

10.3.2. cartesianProductMoveSelector

A cartesianProductMoveSelector selects a new CompositeMove. It builds that CompositeMove by selecting one Move per MoveSelector child and adding it to the CompositeMove.

Simplest configuration:

    <cartesianProductMoveSelector>
      <...MoveSelector/>
      <...MoveSelector/>
      <...MoveSelector/>
      ...
    </cartesianProductMoveSelector>

Advanced configuration:

    <cartesianProductMoveSelector>
      ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      <ignoreEmptyChildIterators>true</ignoreEmptyChildIterators>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        ...
      </changeMoveSelector>
      <swapMoveSelector>
        ...
      </swapMoveSelector>
      <...MoveSelector>
        ...
      </...MoveSelector>
      ...
    </cartesianProductMoveSelector>

The ignoreEmptyChildIterators property (true by default) will ignore every empty childMoveSelector to avoid returning no moves. For example: a cartesian product of changeMoveSelector A and B, for which B is empty (because all it’s entities are immovable) returns no move if ignoreEmptyChildIterators is false and the moves of A if ignoreEmptyChildIterators is true.

To enforce that two child selectors use the same entity or value efficiently, use mimic selection, not move filtering.

10.4. EntitySelector

Simplest configuration:

      <entitySelector/>

Advanced configuration:

      <entitySelector>
        ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
        <entityClass>org.optaplanner.examples.curriculumcourse.domain.Lecture</entityClass>
      </entitySelector>

The entityClass property is only required if it cannot be deduced automatically because there are multiple entity classes.

10.5. ValueSelector

Simplest configuration:

      <valueSelector/>

Advanced configuration:

      <valueSelector variableName="room">
        ... <!-- Normal selector properties -->
      </valueSelector>

The variableName property is only required if it cannot be deduced automatically because there are multiple variables (for the related entity class).

In exotic Construction Heuristic configurations, the entityClass from the EntitySelector sometimes needs to be downcasted, which can be done with the property downcastEntityClass:

      <valueSelector variableName="period">
        <downcastEntityClass>...LeadingExam</downcastEntityClass>
      </valueSelector>

If a selected entity cannot be downcasted, the ValueSelector is empty for that entity.

10.6. General Selector Features

10.6.1. CacheType: Create Moves Ahead of Time or Just In Time

A Selector's cacheType determines when a selection (such as a Move, an entity, a value, …​) is created and how long it lives.

Almost every Selector supports setting a cacheType:

    <changeMoveSelector>
      <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      ...
    </changeMoveSelector>

The following cacheTypes are supported:

  • JUST_IN_TIME (default, recommended): Not cached. Construct each selection (Move, …​) just before it’s used. This scales up well in memory footprint.

  • STEP: Cached. Create each selection (Move, …​) at the beginning of a step and cache them in a list for the remainder of the step. This scales up badly in memory footprint.

  • PHASE: Cached. Create each selection (Move, …​) at the beginning of a solver phase and cache them in a list for the remainder of the phase. Some selections cannot be phase cached because the list changes every step. This scales up badly in memory footprint, but has a slight performance gain.

  • SOLVER: Cached. Create each selection (Move, …​) at the beginning of a Solver and cache them in a list for the remainder of the Solver. Some selections cannot be solver cached because the list changes every step. This scales up badly in memory footprint, but has a slight performance gain.

A cacheType can be set on composite selectors too:

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      <changeMoveSelector/>
      <swapMoveSelector/>
      ...
    </unionMoveSelector>

Nested selectors of a cached selector cannot be configured to be cached themselves, unless it’s a higher cacheType. For example: a STEP cached unionMoveSelector can contain a PHASE cached changeMoveSelector, but it cannot contain a STEP cached changeMoveSelector.

10.6.2. SelectionOrder: Original, Sorted, Random, Shuffled or Probabilistic

A Selector's selectionOrder determines the order in which the selections (such as Moves, entities, values, …​) are iterated. An optimization algorithm will usually only iterate through a subset of its MoveSelector's selections, starting from the start, so the selectionOrder is critical to decide which Moves are actually evaluated.

Almost every Selector supports setting a selectionOrder:

    <changeMoveSelector>
      ...
      <selectionOrder>RANDOM</selectionOrder>
      ...
    </changeMoveSelector>

The following selectionOrders are supported:

  • ORIGINAL: Select the selections (Moves, entities, values, …​) in default order. Each selection will be selected only once.

    • For example: A0, A1, A2, A3, …​, B0, B1, B2, B3, …​, C0, C1, C2, C3, …​

  • SORTED: Select the selections (Moves, entities, values, …​) in sorted order. Each selection will be selected only once. Requires cacheType >= STEP. Mostly used on an entitySelector or valueSelector for construction heuristics. See sorted selection.

    • For example: A0, B0, C0, …​, A2, B2, C2, …​, A1, B1, C1, …​

  • RANDOM (default): Select the selections (Moves, entities, values, …​) in non-shuffled random order. A selection might be selected multiple times. This scales up well in performance because it does not require caching.

    • For example: C2, A3, B1, C2, A0, C0, …​

  • SHUFFLED: Select the selections (Moves, entities, values, …​) in shuffled random order. Each selection will be selected only once. Requires cacheType >= STEP. This scales up badly in performance, not just because it requires caching, but also because a random number is generated for each element, even if it’s not selected (which is the grand majority when scaling up).

    • For example: C2, A3, B1, A0, C0, …​

  • PROBABILISTIC: Select the selections (Moves, entities, values, …​) in random order, based on the selection probability of each element. A selection with a higher probability has a higher chance to be selected than elements with a lower probability. A selection might be selected multiple times. Requires cacheType >= STEP. Mostly used on an entitySelector or valueSelector. See probabilistic selection.

    • For example: B1, B1, A1, B2, B1, C2, B1, B1, …​

A selectionOrder can be set on composite selectors too.

When a Selector is cached, all of its nested Selectors will naturally default to selectionOrder ORIGINAL. Avoid overwriting the selectionOrder of those nested Selectors.

10.6.3. Recommended Combinations of CacheType and SelectionOrder

10.6.3.1. Just in Time Random Selection (default)

This combination is great for big use cases (10 000 entities or more), as it scales up well in memory footprint and performance. Other combinations are often not even viable on such sizes. It works for smaller use cases too, so it’s a good way to start out. It’s the default, so this explicit configuration of cacheType and selectionOrder is actually obsolete:

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <cacheType>JUST_IN_TIME</cacheType>
      <selectionOrder>RANDOM</selectionOrder>

      <changeMoveSelector/>
      <swapMoveSelector/>
    </unionMoveSelector>

Here’s how it works. When Iterator<Move>.next() is called, a child MoveSelector is randomly selected (1), which creates a random Move (2, 3, 4) and is then returned (5):

jitRandomSelection

Notice that it never creates a list of Moves and it generates random numbers only for Moves that are actually selected.

10.6.3.2. Cached Shuffled Selection

This combination often wins for small use cases (1000 entities or less). Beyond that size, it scales up badly in memory footprint and performance.

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      <selectionOrder>SHUFFLED</selectionOrder>

      <changeMoveSelector/>
      <swapMoveSelector/>
    </unionMoveSelector>

Here’s how it works: At the start of the phase (or step depending on the cacheType), all moves are created (1) and cached (2). When MoveSelector.iterator() is called, the moves are shuffled (3). When Iterator<Move>.next() is called, the next element in the shuffled list is returned (4):

cachedShuffledSelection

Notice that each Move will only be selected once, even though they are selected in random order.

Use cacheType PHASE if none of the (possibly nested) Selectors require STEP. Otherwise, do something like this:

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <cacheType>STEP</cacheType>
      <selectionOrder>SHUFFLED</selectionOrder>

      <changeMoveSelector>
        <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      </changeMoveSelector>
      <swapMoveSelector/>
        <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      </swapMoveSelector>
      <pillarSwapMoveSelector/><!-- Does not support cacheType PHASE -->
    </unionMoveSelector>
10.6.3.3. Cached Random Selection

This combination is often a worthy competitor for medium use cases, especially with fast stepping optimization algorithms (such as Simulated Annealing). Unlike cached shuffled selection, it doesn’t waste time shuffling the moves list at the beginning of every step.

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      <selectionOrder>RANDOM</selectionOrder>

      <changeMoveSelector/>
      <swapMoveSelector/>
    </unionMoveSelector>

10.6.4. Filtered Selection

There can be certain moves that you don’t want to select, because:

  • The move is pointless and would only waste CPU time. For example, swapping two lectures of the same course will result in the same score and the same schedule because all lectures of one course are interchangeable (same teacher, same students, same topic).

  • Doing the move would break a built-in hard constraint, so the solution would be infeasible but the score function doesn’t check built-in hard constraints for performance reasons. For example, don’t change a gym lecture to a room which is not a gym room. It’s usually better to not use move filtering for such cases, because it allows the metaheuristics to temporarily break hard constraints to escape local optima.

    Any built-in hard constraint must probably be filtered on every move type of every solver phase. For example if it filters the change move of Local Search, it must also filter the swap move that swaps the room of a gym lecture with another lecture for which the other lecture’s original room isn’t a gym room. Furthermore, it must also filter the change moves of the Construction Heuristics (which requires an advanced configuration).

If a move is unaccepted by the filter, it’s not executed and the score isn’t calculated.

filteredSelection

Filtering uses the interface SelectionFilter:

public interface SelectionFilter<Solution_, T> {

    boolean accept(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector, T selection);

}

Implement the accept method to return false on a discarded selection (see below). Filtered selection can happen on any Selector in the selector tree, including any MoveSelector, EntitySelector or ValueSelector. It works with any cacheType and selectionOrder.

Apply the filter on the lowest level possible. In most cases, you’ll need to know both the entity and the value involved so you’ll have to apply it on the move selector.

10.6.4.1. Filtered Move Selection

Unaccepted moves will not be selected and will therefore never have their doMove() method called:

public class DifferentCourseSwapMoveFilter implements SelectionFilter<SwapMove> {

    @Override
    public boolean accept(ScoreDirector scoreDirector, SwapMove move) {
        Lecture leftLecture = (Lecture) move.getLeftEntity();
        Lecture rightLecture = (Lecture) move.getRightEntity();
        return !leftLecture.getCourse().equals(rightLecture.getCourse());
    }

}

Configure the filterClass on every targeted moveSelector (potentially both in the Local Search and the Construction Heuristics if it filters ChangeMoves):

    <swapMoveSelector>
      <filterClass>org.optaplanner.examples.curriculumcourse.solver.move.DifferentCourseSwapMoveFilter</filterClass>
    </swapMoveSelector>

You can configure multiple filterClass elements on a single move selector.

10.6.4.2. Filtered Entity Selection

Unaccepted entities will not be selected and will therefore never be used to create a move.

public class LongLectureSelectionFilter implements SelectionFilter<Lecture> {

    @Override
    public boolean accept(ScoreDirector<CourseSchedule> scoreDirector, Lecture lecture) {
        return lecture.isLong();
    }

}

Configure the filterClass on every targeted entitySelector (potentially both in the Local Search and the Construction Heuristics):

    <changeMoveSelector>
      <entitySelector>
        <filterClass>org.optaplanner.examples.curriculumcourse.solver.move.LongLectureSelectionFilter</filterClass>
      </entitySelector>
    </changeMoveSelector>

If that filter should apply on all entities, configure it as a global movableEntitySelectionFilter instead.

You can configure multiple filterClass elements on a single entity selector.

10.6.4.3. Filtered Value Selection

Unaccepted values will not be selected and will therefore never be used to create a move.

public class LongPeriodSelectionFilter implements SelectionFilter<Period> {

    @Override
    public boolean accept(ScoreDirector<CourseSchedule> scoreDirector, Period period) {
        return period();
    }

}

Configure the filterClass on every targeted valueSelector (potentially both in the Local Search and the Construction Heuristics):

    <changeMoveSelector>
      <valueSelector>
        <filterClass>org.optaplanner.examples.curriculumcourse.solver.move.LongPeriodSelectionFilter</filterClass>
      </valueSelector>
    </changeMoveSelector>

You can configure multiple filterClass elements on a single value selector.

10.6.5. Sorted Selection

Sorted selection can happen on any Selector in the selector tree, including any MoveSelector, EntitySelector or ValueSelector. It does not work with cacheType JUST_IN_TIME and it only works with selectionOrder SORTED.

It’s mostly used in construction heuristics.

If the chosen construction heuristic implies sorting, for example FIRST_FIT_DECREASING implies that the EntitySelector is sorted, there is no need to explicitly configure a Selector with sorting. If you do explicitly configure the Selector, it overwrites the default settings of that construction heuristic.

10.6.5.1. Sorted Selection by SorterManner

Some Selector types implement a SorterManner out of the box:

  • EntitySelector supports:

    • DECREASING_DIFFICULTY: Sorts the planning entities according to decreasing planning entity difficulty. Requires that planning entity difficulty is annotated on the domain model.

          <entitySelector>
            <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
            <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
            <sorterManner>DECREASING_DIFFICULTY</sorterManner>
          </entitySelector>
  • ValueSelector supports:

    • INCREASING_STRENGTH: Sorts the planning values according to increasing planning value strength. Requires that planning value strength is annotated on the domain model.

          <valueSelector>
            <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
            <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
            <sorterManner>INCREASING_STRENGTH</sorterManner>
          </valueSelector>
10.6.5.2. Sorted Selection by Comparator

An easy way to sort a Selector is with a plain old Comparator:

public class CloudProcessDifficultyComparator implements Comparator<CloudProcess> {

    public int compare(CloudProcess a, CloudProcess b) {
        return new CompareToBuilder()
                .append(a.getRequiredMultiplicand(), b.getRequiredMultiplicand())
                .append(a.getId(), b.getId())
                .toComparison();
    }

}

You’ll also need to configure it (unless it’s annotated on the domain model and automatically applied by the optimization algorithm):

    <entitySelector>
      <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
      <sorterComparatorClass>...CloudProcessDifficultyComparator</sorterComparatorClass>
      <sorterOrder>DESCENDING</sorterOrder>
    </entitySelector>
10.6.5.3. Sorted Selection by SelectionSorterWeightFactory

If you need the entire Solution to sort a Selector, use a SelectionSorterWeightFactory instead:

public interface SelectionSorterWeightFactory<Solution_, T> {

    Comparable createSorterWeight(Solution_ solution, T selection);

}
public class QueenDifficultyWeightFactory implements SelectionSorterWeightFactory<NQueens, Queen> {

    public QueenDifficultyWeight createSorterWeight(NQueens nQueens, Queen queen) {
        int distanceFromMiddle = calculateDistanceFromMiddle(nQueens.getN(), queen.getColumnIndex());
        return new QueenDifficultyWeight(queen, distanceFromMiddle);
    }

    ...

    public static class QueenDifficultyWeight implements Comparable<QueenDifficultyWeight> {

        private final Queen queen;
        private final int distanceFromMiddle;

        public QueenDifficultyWeight(Queen queen, int distanceFromMiddle) {
            this.queen = queen;
            this.distanceFromMiddle = distanceFromMiddle;
        }

        public int compareTo(QueenDifficultyWeight other) {
            return new CompareToBuilder()
                    // The more difficult queens have a lower distance to the middle
                    .append(other.distanceFromMiddle, distanceFromMiddle) // Decreasing
                    // Tie breaker
                    .append(queen.getColumnIndex(), other.queen.getColumnIndex())
                    .toComparison();
        }

    }

}

You’ll also need to configure it (unless it’s annotated on the domain model and automatically applied by the optimization algorithm):

    <entitySelector>
      <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
      <sorterWeightFactoryClass>...QueenDifficultyWeightFactory</sorterWeightFactoryClass>
      <sorterOrder>DESCENDING</sorterOrder>
    </entitySelector>
10.6.5.4. Sorted Selection by SelectionSorter

Alternatively, you can also use the interface SelectionSorter directly:

public interface SelectionSorter<Solution_, T> {

    void sort(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector, List<T> selectionList);

}
    <entitySelector>
      <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
      <sorterClass>...MyEntitySorter</sorterClass>
    </entitySelector>

10.6.6. Probabilistic Selection

Probabilistic selection can happen on any Selector in the selector tree, including any MoveSelector, EntitySelector or ValueSelector. It does not work with cacheType JUST_IN_TIME and it only works with selectionOrder PROBABILISTIC.

probabilisticSelection

Each selection has a probabilityWeight, which determines the chance that selection will be selected:

public interface SelectionProbabilityWeightFactory<Solution_, T> {

    double createProbabilityWeight(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector, T selection);

}
    <entitySelector>
      <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
      <selectionOrder>PROBABILISTIC</selectionOrder>
      <probabilityWeightFactoryClass>...MyEntityProbabilityWeightFactoryClass</probabilityWeightFactoryClass>
    </entitySelector>

For example, if there are three entities: process A (probabilityWeight 2.0), process B (probabilityWeight 0.5) and process C (probabilityWeight 0.5), then process A will be selected four times more than B and C.

10.6.7. Limited Selection

Selecting all possible moves sometimes does not scale well enough, especially for construction heuristics (which don’t support acceptedCountLimit).

To limit the number of selected selection per step, apply a selectedCountLimit on the selector:

    <changeMoveSelector>
      <selectedCountLimit>100</selectedCountLimit>
    </changeMoveSelector>

To scale Local Search, setting acceptedCountLimit is usually better than using selectedCountLimit.

10.6.8. Mimic Selection (Record/Replay)

During mimic selection, one normal selector records its selection and one or multiple other special selectors replay that selection. The recording selector acts as a normal selector and supports all other configuration properties. A replaying selector mimics the recording selection and supports no other configuration properties.

The recording selector needs an id. A replaying selector must reference a recorder’s id with a mimicSelectorRef:

      <cartesianProductMoveSelector>
        <changeMoveSelector>
          <entitySelector id="entitySelector"/>
          <valueSelector variableName="period"/>
        </changeMoveSelector>
        <changeMoveSelector>
          <entitySelector mimicSelectorRef="entitySelector"/>
          <valueSelector variableName="room"/>
        </changeMoveSelector>
      </cartesianProductMoveSelector>

Mimic selection is useful to create a composite move from two moves that affect the same entity.

10.6.9. Nearby Selection

In some use cases (such as TSP and VRP, but also in non-chained variable cases), changing entities to nearby values or swapping nearby entities can heavily increase scalability and improve solution quality.

nearbySelectionMotivation

Nearby selection increases the probability of selecting an entity or value which is nearby to the first entity being moved in that move.

nearbySelectionRandomDistribution

The distance between two entities or values is domain specific. Therefore, implement the NearbyDistanceMeter interface:

public interface NearbyDistanceMeter<O, D> {

    double getNearbyDistance(O origin, D destination);

}

It returns a double which represents the distance:

public class CustomerNearbyDistanceMeter implements NearbyDistanceMeter<Customer, Standstill> {

    public double getNearbyDistance(Customer origin, Standstill destination) {
        return origin.getDistanceTo(destination);
    }

}

To configure nearby selection, add a nearbySelection element in the entitySelector or valueSelector and use mimic selection to specify which entity should be near by the selection.

    <unionMoveSelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector id="entitySelector1"/>
        <valueSelector>
          <nearbySelection>
            <originEntitySelector mimicSelectorRef="entitySelector1"/>
            <nearbyDistanceMeterClass>...CustomerNearbyDistanceMeter</nearbyDistanceMeterClass>
            <parabolicDistributionSizeMaximum>40</parabolicDistributionSizeMaximum>
          </nearbySelection>
        </valueSelector>
      </changeMoveSelector>
      <swapMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector id="entitySelector2"/>
        <secondaryEntitySelector>
          <nearbySelection>
            <originEntitySelector mimicSelectorRef="entitySelector2"/>
            <nearbyDistanceMeterClass>...CustomerNearbyDistanceMeter</nearbyDistanceMeterClass>
            <parabolicDistributionSizeMaximum>40</parabolicDistributionSizeMaximum>
          </nearbySelection>
        </secondaryEntitySelector>
      </swapMoveSelector>
      <tailChainSwapMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector id="entitySelector3"/>
        <valueSelector>
          <nearbySelection>
            <originEntitySelector mimicSelectorRef="entitySelector3"/>
            <nearbyDistanceMeterClass>...CustomerNearbyDistanceMeter</nearbyDistanceMeterClass>
            <parabolicDistributionSizeMaximum>40</parabolicDistributionSizeMaximum>
          </nearbySelection>
        </valueSelector>
      </tailChainSwapMoveSelector>
    </unionMoveSelector>

A distributionSizeMaximum parameter should not be 1 because if the nearest is already the planning value of the current entity, then the only move that is selectable is not doable.

To allow every element to be selected, regardless of the number of entities, only set the distribution type (so without a distributionSizeMaximum parameter):

  <nearbySelection>
    <nearbySelectionDistributionType>PARABOLIC_DISTRIBUTION</nearbySelectionDistributionType>
  </nearbySelection>

The following NearbySelectionDistributionTypes are supported:

  • BLOCK_DISTRIBUTION: Only the n nearest are selected, with an equal probability. For example, select the 20 nearest:

      <nearbySelection>
        <blockDistributionSizeMaximum>20</blockDistributionSizeMaximum>
      </nearbySelection>
  • LINEAR_DISTRIBUTION: Nearest elements are selected with a higher probability. The probability decreases linearly.

      <nearbySelection>
        <linearDistributionSizeMaximum>40</linearDistributionSizeMaximum>
      </nearbySelection>
  • PARABOLIC_DISTRIBUTION (recommended): Nearest elements are selected with a higher probability.

      <nearbySelection>
        <parabolicDistributionSizeMaximum>80</parabolicDistributionSizeMaximum>
      </nearbySelection>
  • BETA_DISTRIBUTION: Selection according to a beta distribution. Slows down the solver significantly.

      <nearbySelection>
        <betaDistributionAlpha>1</betaDistributionAlpha>
        <betaDistributionBeta>5</betaDistributionBeta>
      </nearbySelection>

As always, use the Benchmarker to tweak values if desired.

10.7. Custom Moves

10.7.1. Which Move Types Might be Missing in my Implementation?

To determine which move types might be missing in your implementation, run a Benchmarker for a short amount of time and configure it to write the best solutions to disk. Take a look at such a best solution: it will likely be a local optima. Try to figure out if there’s a move that could get out of that local optima faster.

If you find one, implement that coarse-grained move, mix it with the existing moves and benchmark it against the previous configurations to see if you want to keep it.

10.7.2. Custom Moves Introduction

Instead of using the generic Moves (such as ChangeMove) you can also implement your own Move. Generic and custom MoveSelectors can be combined as desired.

A custom Move can be tailored to work to the advantage of your constraints. For example in examination scheduling, changing the period of an exam A would also change the period of all the other exams that need to coincide with exam A.

A custom Move is far more work to implement and much harder to avoid bugs than a generic Move. After implementing a custom Move, turn on environmentMode FULL_ASSERT to check for score corruptions.

10.7.3. The Interface Move

All moves implement the Move interface:

public interface Move<Solution_> {

    boolean isMoveDoable(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector);

    Move<Solution_> doMove(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector);

    ...
}

To implement a custom move, it’s recommended to extend AbstractMove instead implementing Move directly. Planner calls AbstractMove.doMove(ScoreDirector), which calls doMoveOnGenuineVariables(ScoreDirector). For example in cloud balancing, this move changes one process to another computer:

public class CloudComputerChangeMove extends AbstractMove<CloudBalance> {

    private CloudProcess cloudProcess;
    private CloudComputer toCloudComputer;

    public CloudComputerChangeMove(CloudProcess cloudProcess, CloudComputer toCloudComputer) {
        this.cloudProcess = cloudProcess;
        this.toCloudComputer = toCloudComputer;
    }

    @Override
    protected void doMoveOnGenuineVariables(ScoreDirector<CloudBalance> scoreDirector) {
        scoreDirector.beforeVariableChanged(cloudProcess, "computer");
        cloudProcess.setComputer(toCloudComputer);
        scoreDirector.afterVariableChanged(cloudProcess, "computer");
    }

    // ...

}

The implementation must notify the ScoreDirector of any changes it makes to planning entity’s variables: Call the scoreDirector.beforeVariableChanged(Object, String) and scoreDirector.afterVariableChanged(Object, String) methods directly before and after modifying an entity’s planning variable.

The example move above is a fine-grained move because it changes only one planning variable. On the other hand, a coarse-grained move changes multiple entities or multiple planning variables in a single move, usually to avoid breaking hard constraints by making multiple related changes at once. For example, a swap move is really just two change moves, but it keeps those two changes together.

A Move can only change/add/remove planning entities, it must not change any of the problem facts as that will cause score corruption. Use real-time planning to change problem facts while solving.

Planner automatically filters out non doable moves by calling the isMoveDoable(ScoreDirector) method on each selected move. A non doable move is:

  • A move that changes nothing on the current solution. For example, moving process P1 on computer X to computer X is not doable, because it is already there.

  • A move that is impossible to do on the current solution. For example, moving process P1 to computer Q (when Q isn’t in the list of computers) is not doable because it would assign a planning value that’s not inside the planning variable’s value range.

In the cloud balancing example, a move which assigns a process to the computer it’s already assigned to is not doable:

    @Override
    public boolean isMoveDoable(ScoreDirector<CloudBalance> scoreDirector) {
        return !Objects.equals(cloudProcess.getComputer(), toCloudComputer);
    }

We don’t need to check if toCloudComputer is in the value range, because we only generate moves for which that is the case. A move that is currently not doable can become doable when the working Solution changes in a later step, otherwise we probably shouldn’t have created it in the first place.

Each move has an undo move: a move (normally of the same type) which does the exact opposite. In the cloud balancing example the undo move of P1 {X → Y} is the move P1 {Y → X}. The undo move of a move is created when the Move is being done on the current solution, before the genuine variables change:

    @Override
    public CloudComputerChangeMove createUndoMove(ScoreDirector<CloudBalance> scoreDirector) {
        return new CloudComputerChangeMove(cloudProcess, cloudProcess.getComputer());
    }

Notice that if P1 would have already been moved to Y, the undo move would create the move P1 {Y → Y}, instead of the move P1 {Y → X}.

A solver phase might do and undo the same Move more than once. In fact, many solver phases will iteratively do and undo a number of moves to evaluate them, before selecting one of those and doing that move again (without undoing it the last time).

Always implement the toString() method to keep Planner’s logs readable. Keep it non-verbose and make it consistent with the generic moves:

    public String toString() {
        return cloudProcess + " {" + cloudProcess.getComputer() + " -> " + toCloudComputer + "}";
    }

Optionally, implement the getSimpleMoveTypeDescription() method to support picked move statistics:

    @Override
    public String getSimpleMoveTypeDescription() {
        return "CloudComputerChangeMove(CloudProcess.computer)";
    }
10.7.3.1. Custom move: rebase()

For multithreaded incremental solving, the custom move must implement the rebase() method:

    @Override
    public CloudComputerChangeMove rebase(ScoreDirector<CloudBalance> destinationScoreDirector) {
        return new CloudComputerChangeMove(destinationScoreDirector.lookUpWorkingObject(cloudProcess),
                destinationScoreDirector.lookUpWorkingObject(toCloudComputer));
    }

Rebasing a move takes a move generated of one working solution and creates a new move that does the same change as the original move, but rewired as if was generated off of the destination working solution. This allows multithreaded solving to migrate moves from one thread to another.

The lookUpWorkingObject() method translates a planning entity instance or problem fact instance from one working solution to that of the destination’s working solution. Internally it often uses a mapping technique based on the planning ID.

To rebase lists or arrays in bulk, use rebaseList() and rebaseArray() on AbstractMove.

10.7.3.2. Custom move: getPlanningEntities() and getPlanningValues()

A custom move should also implement the getPlanningEntities() and getPlanningValues() methods. Those are used by entity tabu and value tabu respectively. They are called after the Move has already been done.

    @Override
    public Collection<? extends Object> getPlanningEntities() {
        return Collections.singletonList(cloudProcess);
    }

    @Override
    public Collection<? extends Object> getPlanningValues() {
        return Collections.singletonList(toCloudComputer);
    }

If the Move changes multiple planning entities, such as in a swap move, return all of them in getPlanningEntities() and return all their values (to which they are changing) in getPlanningValues().

    @Override
    public Collection<? extends Object> getPlanningEntities() {
        return Arrays.asList(leftCloudProcess, rightCloudProcess);
    }

    @Override
    public Collection<? extends Object> getPlanningValues() {
        return Arrays.asList(leftCloudProcess.getComputer(), rightCloudProcess.getComputer());
    }
10.7.3.3. Custom move: equals() and hashCode()

A Move must implement the equals() and hashCode() methods for move tabu. Two moves which make the same change on a solution, should be equal ideally.

    @Override
    public boolean equals(Object o) {
        if (this == o) {
            return true;
        } else if (o instanceof CloudComputerChangeMove) {
            CloudComputerChangeMove other = (CloudComputerChangeMove) o;
            return new EqualsBuilder()
                    .append(cloudProcess, other.cloudProcess)
                    .append(toCloudComputer, other.toCloudComputer)
                    .isEquals();
        } else {
            return false;
        }
    }

    @Override
    public int hashCode() {
        return new HashCodeBuilder()
                .append(cloudProcess)
                .append(toCloudComputer)
                .toHashCode();
    }

Notice that it checks if the other move is an instance of the same move type. This instanceof check is important because a move are compared to a move of another move type. For example a ChangeMove and SwapMove are compared.

10.7.4. Generating custom moves

Now, let’s generate instances of this custom Move class. There are 2 ways:

10.7.4.1. MoveListFactory: the Easy Way to Generate Custom Moves

The easiest way to generate custom moves is by implementing the interface MoveListFactory:

public interface MoveListFactory<Solution_> {

    List<Move> createMoveList(Solution_ solution);

}

For example:

public class CloudComputerChangeMoveFactory implements MoveListFactory<CloudBalance> {

    @Override
    public List<CloudComputerChangeMove> createMoveList(CloudBalance cloudBalance) {
        List<CloudComputerChangeMove> moveList = new ArrayList<>();
        List<CloudComputer> cloudComputerList = cloudBalance.getComputerList();
        for (CloudProcess cloudProcess : cloudBalance.getProcessList()) {
            for (CloudComputer cloudComputer : cloudComputerList) {
                moveList.add(new CloudComputerChangeMove(cloudProcess, cloudComputer));
            }
        }
        return moveList;
    }

}

Simple configuration (which can be nested in a unionMoveSelector just like any other MoveSelector):

    <moveListFactory>
      <moveListFactoryClass>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.optional.move.CloudComputerChangeMoveFactory</moveListFactoryClass>
    </moveListFactory>

Advanced configuration:

    <moveListFactory>
      ... <!-- Normal moveSelector properties -->
      <moveListFactoryClass>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.optional.move.CloudComputerChangeMoveFactory</moveListFactoryClass>
    </moveListFactory>

Because the MoveListFactory generates all moves at once in a List<Move>, it does not support cacheType JUST_IN_TIME. Therefore, moveListFactory uses cacheType STEP by default and it scales badly.

A custom `MoveListFactory`implementation must ensure that it does not move immovable entities.

10.7.4.2. MoveIteratorFactory: Generate Custom Moves Just in Time

Use this advanced form to generate custom moves Just In Time by implementing the MoveIteratorFactory interface:

public interface MoveIteratorFactory<Solution_> {

    long getSize(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector);

    Iterator<Move> createOriginalMoveIterator(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector);

    Iterator<Move> createRandomMoveIterator(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector, Random workingRandom);

}

The getSize() method must return an estimation of the size. It doesn’t need to be correct, but it’s better too big than too small. The createOriginalMoveIterator method is called if the selectionOrder is ORIGINAL or if it is cached. The createRandomMoveIterator method is called for selectionOrder RANDOM combined with cacheType JUST_IN_TIME.

Don’t create a collection (array, list, set or map) of Moves when creating the Iterator<Move>: the whole purpose of MoveIteratorFactory over MoveListFactory is to create a Move just in time in a custom Iterator.next().

Simple configuration (which can be nested in a unionMoveSelector just like any other MoveSelector):

    <moveIteratorFactory>
      <moveIteratorFactoryClass>...</moveIteratorFactoryClass>
    </moveIteratorFactory>

Advanced configuration:

    <moveIteratorFactory>
      ... <!-- Normal moveSelector properties -->
      <moveIteratorFactoryClass>...</moveIteratorFactoryClass>
    </moveIteratorFactory>

A custom MoveIteratorFactory implementation must ensure that it does not move immovable entities.

11. Exhaustive Search

11.1. Overview

Exhaustive Search will always find the global optimum and recognize it too. That being said, it doesn’t scale (not even beyond toy data sets) and is therefore mostly useless.

11.2. Brute Force

11.2.1. Algorithm Description

The Brute Force algorithm creates and evaluates every possible solution.

bruteForceNQueens04

Notice that it creates a search tree that explodes exponentially as the problem size increases, so it hits a scalability wall.

Brute Force is mostly unusable for a real-world problem due to time limitations, as shown in scalability of Exhaustive Search.

11.2.2. Configuration

Simplest configuration of Brute Force:

<solver>
  ...
  <exhaustiveSearch>
    <exhaustiveSearchType>BRUTE_FORCE</exhaustiveSearchType>
  </exhaustiveSearch>
</solver>

11.3. Branch And Bound

11.3.1. Algorithm Description

Branch And Bound also explores nodes in an exponential search tree, but it investigates more promising nodes first and prunes away worthless nodes.

For each node, Branch And Bound calculates the optimistic bound: the best possible score to which that node can lead to. If the optimistic bound of a node is lower or equal to the global pessimistic bound, then it prunes away that node (including the entire branch of all its subnodes).

Academic papers use the term lower bound instead of optimistic bound (and the term upper bound instead of pessimistic bound), because they minimize the score.

Planner maximizes the score (because it supports combining negative and positive constraints). Therefore, for clarity, it uses different terms, as it would be confusing to use the term lower bound for a bound which is always higher.

For example: at index 14, it sets the global pessimistic bound to -2. Because all solutions reachable from the node visited at index 11 will have a score lower or equal to -2 (the node’s optimistic bound), they can be pruned away.

depthFirstBranchAndBoundNQueens04

Notice that Branch And Bound (much like Brute Force) creates a search tree that explodes exponentially as the problem size increases. So it hits the same scalability wall, only a little bit later.

Branch And Bound is mostly unusable for a real-world problem due to time limitations, as shown in scalability of Exhaustive Search.

11.3.2. Configuration

Simplest configuration of Branch And Bound:

<solver>
  ...
  <exhaustiveSearch>
    <exhaustiveSearchType>BRANCH_AND_BOUND</exhaustiveSearchType>
  </exhaustiveSearch>
</solver>

For the pruning to work with the default ScoreBounder, the InitializingScoreTrend should be set. Especially an InitializingScoreTrend of ONLY_DOWN (or at least has ONLY_DOWN in the leading score levels) prunes a lot.

Advanced configuration:

  <exhaustiveSearch>
    <exhaustiveSearchType>BRANCH_AND_BOUND</exhaustiveSearchType>
    <nodeExplorationType>DEPTH_FIRST</nodeExplorationType>
    <entitySorterManner>DECREASING_DIFFICULTY_IF_AVAILABLE</entitySorterManner>
    <valueSorterManner>INCREASING_STRENGTH_IF_AVAILABLE</valueSorterManner>
  </exhaustiveSearch>

The nodeExplorationType options are:

  • DEPTH_FIRST (default): Explore deeper nodes first (and then a better score and then a better optimistic bound). Deeper nodes (especially leaf nodes) often improve the pessimistic bound. A better pessimistic bound allows pruning more nodes to reduce the search space.

      <exhaustiveSearch>
        <exhaustiveSearchType>BRANCH_AND_BOUND</exhaustiveSearchType>
        <nodeExplorationType>DEPTH_FIRST</nodeExplorationType>
      </exhaustiveSearch>
  • BREADTH_FIRST (not recommended): Explore nodes layer by layer (and then a better score and then a better optimistic bound). Scales terribly in memory (and usually in performance too).

      <exhaustiveSearch>
        <exhaustiveSearchType>BRANCH_AND_BOUND</exhaustiveSearchType>
        <nodeExplorationType>BREADTH_FIRST</nodeExplorationType>
      </exhaustiveSearch>
  • SCORE_FIRST: Explore nodes with a better score first (and then a better optimistic bound and then deeper nodes first). Might scale as terribly as BREADTH_FIRST in some cases.

      <exhaustiveSearch>
        <exhaustiveSearchType>BRANCH_AND_BOUND</exhaustiveSearchType>
        <nodeExplorationType>SCORE_FIRST</nodeExplorationType>
      </exhaustiveSearch>
  • OPTIMISTIC_BOUND_FIRST: Explore nodes with a better optimistic bound first (and then a better score and then deeper nodes first). Might scale as terribly as BREADTH_FIRST in some cases.

      <exhaustiveSearch>
        <exhaustiveSearchType>BRANCH_AND_BOUND</exhaustiveSearchType>
        <nodeExplorationType>OPTIMISTIC_BOUND_FIRST</nodeExplorationType>
      </exhaustiveSearch>

The entitySorterManner options are:

  • DECREASING_DIFFICULTY: Initialize the more difficult planning entities first. This usually increases pruning (and therefore improves scalability). Requires the model to support planning entity difficulty comparison.

  • DECREASING_DIFFICULTY_IF_AVAILABLE (default): If the model supports planning entity difficulty comparison, behave like DECREASING_DIFFICULTY, else like NONE.

  • NONE: Initialize the planning entities in original order.

The valueSorterManner options are:

11.4. Scalability of Exhaustive Search

Exhaustive Search variants suffer from two big scalability issues:

  • They scale terribly memory wise.

  • They scale horribly performance wise.

As shown in these time spent graphs from the Benchmarker, Brute Force and Branch And Bound both hit a performance scalability wall. For example, on N queens it hits wall at a few dozen queens:

exhaustiveSearchScalabilityNQueens

In most use cases, such as Cloud Balancing, the wall appears out of thin air:

exhaustiveSearchScalabilityCloudBalance

Exhaustive Search hits this wall on small datasets already, so in production these optimizations algorithms are mostly useless. Use Construction Heuristics with Local Search instead: those can handle thousands of queens/computers easily.

Throwing hardware at these scalability issues has no noticeable impact. Newer and more hardware are just a drop in the ocean. Moore’s law cannot win against the onslaught of a few more planning entities in the dataset.

12. Construction Heuristics

12.1. Overview

A construction heuristic builds a pretty good initial solution in a finite length of time. Its solution isn’t always feasible, but it finds it fast so metaheuristics can finish the job.

Construction heuristics terminate automatically, so there’s usually no need to configure a Termination on the construction heuristic phase specifically.

12.2. First Fit

12.2.1. Algorithm Description

The First Fit algorithm cycles through all the planning entities (in default order), initializing one planning entity at a time. It assigns the planning entity to the best available planning value, taking the already initialized planning entities into account. It terminates when all planning entities have been initialized. It never changes a planning entity after it has been assigned.

firstFitNQueens04

Notice that it starts with putting Queen A into row 0 (and never moving it later), which makes it impossible to reach the optimal solution. Suffixing this construction heuristic with metaheuristics can remedy that.

12.2.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>FIRST_FIT</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Advanced configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>FIRST_FIT</constructionHeuristicType>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics. For a very advanced configuration, see Allocate Entity From Queue.

12.3. First Fit Decreasing

12.3.1. Algorithm Description

Like First Fit, but assigns the more difficult planning entities first, because they are less likely to fit in the leftovers. So it sorts the planning entities on decreasing difficulty.

firstFitDecreasingNQueens04

Requires the model to support planning entity difficulty comparison.

One would expect that this algorithm has better results than First Fit. That’s usually the case, but not always.

12.3.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>FIRST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Advanced configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>FIRST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics. For a very advanced configuration, see Allocate Entity From Queue.

12.4. Weakest Fit

12.4.1. Algorithm Description

Like First Fit, but uses the weaker planning values first, because the strong planning values are more likely to be able to accommodate later planning entities. So it sorts the planning values on increasing strength.

Requires the model to support planning value strength comparison.

Do not presume that this algorithm has better results than First Fit. That’s often not the case.

12.4.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>WEAKEST_FIT</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Advanced configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>WEAKEST_FIT</constructionHeuristicType>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics. For a very advanced configuration, see Allocate Entity From Queue.

12.5. Weakest Fit Decreasing

12.5.1. Algorithm Description

Combines First Fit Decreasing and Weakest Fit. So it sorts the planning entities on decreasing difficulty and the planning values on increasing strength.

Do not presume that this algorithm has better results than First Fit Decreasing. That’s often not the case. However, it is usually better than Weakest Fit.

12.5.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>WEAKEST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Advanced configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>WEAKEST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics. For a very advanced configuration, see Allocate Entity From Queue.

12.6. Strongest Fit

12.6.1. Algorithm Description

Like First Fit, but uses the strong planning values first, because the strong planning values are more likely to have a lower soft cost to use. So it sorts the planning values on decreasing strength.

Requires the model to support planning value strength comparison.

Do not presume that this algorithm has better results than First Fit or Weakest Fit. That’s often not the case.

12.6.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>STRONGEST_FIT</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Advanced configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>STRONGEST_FIT</constructionHeuristicType>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics. For a very advanced configuration, see Allocate Entity From Queue.

12.7. Strongest Fit Decreasing

12.7.1. Algorithm Description

Combines First Fit Decreasing and Strongest Fit. So it sorts the planning entities on decreasing difficulty and the planning values on decreasing strength.

Do not presume that this algorithm has better results than First Fit Decreasing or Weakest Fit Decreasing. That’s often not the case. However, it is usually better than Strongest Fit.

12.7.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>STRONGEST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Advanced configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>STRONGEST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics. For a very advanced configuration, see Allocate Entity From Queue.

12.8. Allocate Entity From Queue

12.8.1. Algorithm Description

Allocate Entity From Queue is a versatile, generic form of First Fit, First Fit Decreasing, Weakest Fit, Weakest Fit Decreasing, Strongest Fit and Strongest Fit Decreasing. It works like this:

  1. Put all entities in a queue.

  2. Assign the first entity (from that queue) to the best value.

  3. Repeat until all entities are assigned.

12.8.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>ALLOCATE_ENTITY_FROM_QUEUE</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Verbose simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>ALLOCATE_ENTITY_FROM_QUEUE</constructionHeuristicType>
    <entitySorterManner>DECREASING_DIFFICULTY_IF_AVAILABLE</entitySorterManner>
    <valueSorterManner>INCREASING_STRENGTH_IF_AVAILABLE</valueSorterManner>
  </constructionHeuristic>

The entitySorterManner options are:

  • DECREASING_DIFFICULTY: Initialize the more difficult planning entities first. This usually increases pruning (and therefore improves scalability). Requires the model to support planning entity difficulty comparison.

  • DECREASING_DIFFICULTY_IF_AVAILABLE (default): If the model supports planning entity difficulty comparison, behave like DECREASING_DIFFICULTY, else like NONE.

  • NONE: Initialize the planning entities in original order.

The valueSorterManner options are:

Advanced configuration with Weakest Fit Decreasing for a single entity class with one variable:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <queuedEntityPlacer>
      <entitySelector id="placerEntitySelector">
        <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
        <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
        <sorterManner>DECREASING_DIFFICULTY</sorterManner>
      </entitySelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector mimicSelectorRef="placerEntitySelector"/>
        <valueSelector>
          <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
          <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
          <sorterManner>INCREASING_STRENGTH</sorterManner>
        </valueSelector>
      </changeMoveSelector>
    </queuedEntityPlacer>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Per step, the QueuedEntityPlacer selects one uninitialized entity from the EntitySelector and applies the winning Move (out of all the moves for that entity generated by the MoveSelector). The mimic selection ensures that the winning Move changes only the selected entity.

To customize the entity or value sorting, see sorted selection. For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics.

If there are multiple planning variables, there’s one ChangeMoveSelector per planning variable, which are either in a cartesian product or in sequential steps, similar to the less verbose configuration.

12.8.3. Multiple Entity Classes

The easiest way to deal with multiple entity classes is to run a separate Construction Heuristic for each entity class:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <queuedEntityPlacer>
      <entitySelector id="placerEntitySelector">
        <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
        <entityClass>...DogEntity</entityClass>
      </entitySelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector mimicSelectorRef="placerEntitySelector"/>
      </changeMoveSelector>
    </queuedEntityPlacer>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>
  <constructionHeuristic>
    <queuedEntityPlacer>
      <entitySelector id="placerEntitySelector">
        <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
        <entityClass>...CatEntity</entityClass>
      </entitySelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector mimicSelectorRef="placerEntitySelector"/>
      </changeMoveSelector>
    </queuedEntityPlacer>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>

12.8.4. Pick Early Type

There are several pick early types for Construction Heuristics:

  • NEVER: Evaluate all the selected moves to initialize the variable(s). This is the default if the InitializingScoreTrend is not ONLY_DOWN.

      <constructionHeuristic>
        ...
        <forager>
          <pickEarlyType>NEVER</pickEarlyType>
        </forager>
      </constructionHeuristic>
  • FIRST_NON_DETERIORATING_SCORE: Initialize the variable(s) with the first move that doesn’t deteriorate the score, ignore the remaining selected moves. This is the default if the InitializingScoreTrend is ONLY_DOWN.

      <constructionHeuristic>
        ...
        <forager>
          <pickEarlyType>FIRST_NON_DETERIORATING_SCORE</pickEarlyType>
        </forager>
      </constructionHeuristic>

    If there are only negative constraints, but the InitializingScoreTrend is strictly not ONLY_DOWN, it can sometimes make sense to apply FIRST_NON_DETERIORATING_SCORE. Use the Benchmarker to decide if the score quality loss is worth the time gain.

  • FIRST_FEASIBLE_SCORE: Initialize the variable(s) with the first move that has a feasible score.

      <constructionHeuristic>
        ...
        <forager>
          <pickEarlyType>FIRST_FEASIBLE_SCORE</pickEarlyType>
        </forager>
      </constructionHeuristic>

    If the InitializingScoreTrend is ONLY_DOWN, use FIRST_FEASIBLE_SCORE_OR_NON_DETERIORATING_HARD instead, because that’s faster without any disadvantages.

  • FIRST_FEASIBLE_SCORE_OR_NON_DETERIORATING_HARD: Initialize the variable(s) with the first move that doesn’t deteriorate the feasibility of the score any further.

      <constructionHeuristic>
        ...
        <forager>
          <pickEarlyType>FIRST_FEASIBLE_SCORE_OR_NON_DETERIORATING_HARD</pickEarlyType>
        </forager>
      </constructionHeuristic>

12.9. Allocate To Value From Queue

12.9.1. Algorithm Description

Allocate To Value From Queue works like this:

  1. Put all values in a round-robin queue.

  2. Assign the best entity to the first value (from that queue).

  3. Repeat until all entities are assigned.

12.9.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>ALLOCATE_TO_VALUE_FROM_QUEUE</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Verbose simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>ALLOCATE_TO_VALUE_FROM_QUEUE</constructionHeuristicType>
    <entitySorterManner>DECREASING_DIFFICULTY_IF_AVAILABLE</entitySorterManner>
    <valueSorterManner>INCREASING_STRENGTH_IF_AVAILABLE</valueSorterManner>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Advanced configuration for a single entity class with a single variable:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <queuedValuePlacer>
      <valueSelector id="placerValueSelector">
        <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
        <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
        <sorterManner>INCREASING_STRENGTH</sorterManner>
      </valueSelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector>
          <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
          <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
          <sorterManner>DECREASING_DIFFICULTY</sorterManner>
        </entitySelector>
        <valueSelector mimicSelectorRef="placerValueSelector"/>
      </changeMoveSelector>
    </queuedValuePlacer>
  </constructionHeuristic>

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics.

12.10. Cheapest Insertion

12.10.1. Algorithm Description

The Cheapest Insertion algorithm cycles through all the planning values for all the planning entities, initializing one planning entity at a time. It assigns a planning entity to the best available planning value (out of all the planning entities and values), taking the already initialized planning entities into account. It terminates when all planning entities have been initialized. It never changes a planning entity after it has been assigned.

cheapestInsertionNQueens04

Cheapest Insertion scales considerably worse than First Fit, etc.

12.10.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>CHEAPEST_INSERTION</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Advanced configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>CHEAPEST_INSERTION</constructionHeuristicType>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    <...MoveSelector/>
    ...
  </constructionHeuristic>

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics. For a very advanced configuration, see Allocate from pool.

12.11. Regret Insertion

12.11.1. Algorithm Description

The Regret Insertion algorithm behaves like the Cheapest Insertion algorithm. It also cycles through all the planning values for all the planning entities, initializing one planning entity at a time. But instead of picking the entity-value combination with the best score, it picks the entity which has the largest score loss between its best and second best value assignment. It then assigns that entity to its best value, to avoid regretting not having done that.

12.11.2. Configuration

This algorithm has not been implemented yet.

12.12. Allocate From Pool

12.12.1. Algorithm Description

Allocate From Pool is a versatile, generic form of Cheapest Insertion and Regret Insertion. It works like this:

  1. Put all entity-value combinations in a pool.

  2. Assign the best entity to best value.

  3. Repeat until all entities are assigned.

12.12.2. Configuration

Simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>ALLOCATE_FROM_POOL</constructionHeuristicType>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Verbose simple configuration:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>ALLOCATE_FROM_POOL</constructionHeuristicType>
    <entitySorterManner>DECREASING_DIFFICULTY_IF_AVAILABLE</entitySorterManner>
    <valueSorterManner>INCREASING_STRENGTH_IF_AVAILABLE</valueSorterManner>
  </constructionHeuristic>

The entitySorterManner and valueSorterManner options are described in Allocate Entity From Queue.

Advanced configuration with Cheapest Insertion for a single entity class with a single variable:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <pooledEntityPlacer>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <entitySelector id="placerEntitySelector">
          <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
          <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
          <sorterManner>DECREASING_DIFFICULTY</sorterManner>
        </entitySelector>
        <valueSelector>
          <cacheType>PHASE</cacheType>
          <selectionOrder>SORTED</selectionOrder>
          <sorterManner>INCREASING_STRENGTH</sorterManner>
        </valueSelector>
      </changeMoveSelector>
    </pooledEntityPlacer>
  </constructionHeuristic>

Per step, the PooledEntityPlacer applies the winning Move (out of all the moves for that entity generated by the MoveSelector).

To customize the entity or value sorting, see sorted selection. Other Selector customization (such as filtering and limiting) is supported too.

For scaling out, see scaling construction heuristics.

12.13. Scaling Construction Heuristics

If the Construction Heuristic takes a long time to solve and create an initial solution, there is too little time left for Local Search to reach a near optimal solution.

Ideally, a Construction Heuristic should take less than 20 seconds from scratch and less than 50 milliseconds in real-time planning, so there is plenty of time left for Local Search. If the Benchmarker proves that this is not the case, there’s a number of improvements that can be done:

12.13.1. InitializingScoreTrend shortcuts

If the InitializingScoreTrend is ONLY_DOWN, a Construction Heuristic algorithm (such as First Fit) is faster: for an entity, it picks the first move for which the score does not deteriorate the last step score, ignoring all subsequent moves in that step.

It can take that shortcut without reducing solution quality, because a down trend guarantees that initializing any additional planning variable can only make the score the same or worse. So if a move has the same score as before the planning variable was initialized, then no other move can have a better score.

12.13.2. Scaling Multiple Planning Variables in Construction Heuristics

There are two ways to deal with multiple planning variables, depending on how their ChangeMoves are combined:

  • Cartesian product (default): All variables of the selected entity are assigned together. This usually results in a better solution quality, but it scales poorly because it tries every combination of variables. For example:

      <constructionHeuristic>
        <constructionHeuristicType>FIRST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
        <cartesianProductMoveSelector>
          <changeMoveSelector>
            <valueSelector variableName="period"/>
          </changeMoveSelector>
          <changeMoveSelector>
            <valueSelector variableName="room"/>
          </changeMoveSelector>
        </cartesianProductMoveSelector>
      </constructionHeuristic>
  • Sequential: One variable is assigned at a time. Scales better, at the cost of solution quality. The order of the planning variables matters. For example:

      <constructionHeuristic>
        <constructionHeuristicType>FIRST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
        <changeMoveSelector>
          <valueSelector variableName="period"/>
        </changeMoveSelector>
        <changeMoveSelector>
          <valueSelector variableName="room"/>
        </changeMoveSelector>
      </constructionHeuristic>

The second way scales better, so it can be worth to switch to it. For example, in a course scheduling example with 200 rooms and 40 periods, a cartesian product selects 8 000 moves per entity (1 step per entity). On the other hand, a sequential approach only selects 240 moves per entity (2 steps per entity), ending the Construction Heuristic 3 times faster. Especially for three or more planning variables, the scaling difference is huge. For example, with three variables of 1 000 values each, a cartesian product selects 1 000 000 000 moves per entity (1 step per entity). A sequential approach only selects 3 000 moves per entity (3 steps per entity), ending the Construction Heuristic 300 000 times faster.

multiVariableConstructionHeuristics

The order of the variables is important, especially in the sequential technique. In the sequential example above, it’s better to select the period first and the room second (instead of the other way around), because there are more hard constraints that do not involve the room, such as no teacher should teach two lectures at the same time.

Let the Benchmarker guide you.

With three or more variables, it’s possible to combine the cartesian product and sequential techniques:

  <constructionHeuristic>
    <constructionHeuristicType>FIRST_FIT_DECREASING</constructionHeuristicType>
    <cartesianProductMoveSelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <valueSelector variableName="period"/>
      </changeMoveSelector>
      <changeMoveSelector>
        <valueSelector variableName="room"/>
      </changeMoveSelector>
    </cartesianProductMoveSelector>
    <changeMoveSelector>
      <valueSelector variableName="teacher"/>
    </changeMoveSelector>
  </constructionHeuristic>

12.13.3. Other Scaling Techniques in Construction Heuristics

Partitioned Search reduces the number of moves per step. On top of that, it runs the Construction Heuristic on the partitions in parallel. It is supported to only partition the Construction Heuristic phase.

Other Selector customizations can also reduce the number of moves generated by step:

13. Local Search

13.1. Overview

Local Search starts from an initial solution and evolves that single solution into a mostly better and better solution. It uses a single search path of solutions, not a search tree. At each solution in this path it evaluates a number of moves on the solution and applies the most suitable move to take the step to the next solution. It does that for a high number of iterations until it’s terminated (usually because its time has run out).

Local Search acts a lot like a human planner: it uses a single search path and moves facts around to find a good feasible solution. Therefore it’s pretty natural to implement.

Local Search needs to start from an initialized solution, therefore it’s usually required to configure a Construction Heuristic phase before it.

13.2. Local Search Concepts

13.2.1. Step by Step

A step is the winning Move. Local Search tries a number of moves on the current solution and picks the best accepted move as the step:

decideNextStepNQueens04
Figure 6. Decide the next step at step 0 (four queens example)

Because the move B0 to B3 has the highest score (-3), it is picked as the next step. If multiple moves have the same highest score, one is picked randomly, in this case B0 to B3. Note that C0 to C3 (not shown) could also have been picked because it also has the score -3.

The step is applied on the solution. From that new solution, Local Search tries every move again, to decide the next step after that. It continually does this in a loop, and we get something like this:

allStepsNQueens04
Figure 7. All steps (four queens example)

Notice that Local Search doesn’t use a search tree, but a search path. The search path is highlighted by the green arrows. At each step it tries all selected moves, but unless it’s the step, it doesn’t investigate that solution further. This is one of the reasons why Local Search is very scalable.

As shown above, Local Search solves the four queens problem by starting with the starting solution and make the following steps sequentially:

  1. B0 to B3

  2. D0 to B2

  3. A0 to B1

Turn on debug logging for the category org.optaplanner to show those steps in the log:

INFO  Solving started: time spent (0), best score (-6), environment mode (REPRODUCIBLE), random (JDK with seed 0).
DEBUG     LS step (0), time spent (20), score (-3), new best score (-3), accepted/selected move count (12/12), picked move (Queen-1 {Row-0 -> Row-3}).
DEBUG     LS step (1), time spent (31), score (-1), new best score (-1), accepted/selected move count (12/12), picked move (Queen-3 {Row-0 -> Row-2}).
DEBUG     LS step (2), time spent (40), score (0), new best score (0), accepted/selected move count (12/12), picked move (Queen-0 {Row-0 -> Row-1}).
INFO  Local Search phase (0) ended: time spent (41), best score (0), score calculation speed (5000/sec), step total (3).
INFO  Solving ended: time spent (41), best score (0), score calculation speed (5000/sec), phase total (1), environment mode (REPRODUCIBLE).

Notice that a log message includes the toString() method of the Move implementation which returns for example "Queen-1 {Row-0 → Row-3}".

A naive Local Search configuration solves the four queens problem in three steps, by evaluating only 37 possible solutions (three steps with 12 moves each + one starting solution), which is only fraction of all 256 possible solutions. It solves 16 queens in 31 steps, by evaluating only 7441 out of 18446744073709551616 possible solutions. By using a Construction Heuristics phase first, it’s even a lot more efficient.

13.2.2. Decide the Next Step

Local Search decides the next step with the aid of three configurable components:

  • A MoveSelector which selects the possible moves of the current solution. See the chapter move and neighborhood selection.

  • An Acceptor which filters out unacceptable moves.

  • A Forager which gathers accepted moves and picks the next step from them.

The solver phase configuration looks like this:

  <localSearch>
    <unionMoveSelector>
      ...
    </unionMoveSelector>
    <acceptor>
      ...
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      ...
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

In the example below, the MoveSelector generated the moves shown with the blue lines, the Acceptor accepted all of them and the Forager picked the move B0 to B3.

decideNextStepNQueens04

Turn on trace logging to show the decision making in the log:

INFO  Solver started: time spent (0), score (-6), new best score (-6), random (JDK with seed 0).
TRACE         Move index (0) not doable, ignoring move (Queen-0 {Row-0 -> Row-0}).
TRACE         Move index (1), score (-4), accepted (true), move (Queen-0 {Row-0 -> Row-1}).
TRACE         Move index (2), score (-4), accepted (true), move (Queen-0 {Row-0 -> Row-2}).
TRACE         Move index (3), score (-4), accepted (true), move (Queen-0 {Row-0 -> Row-3}).
...
TRACE         Move index (6), score (-3), accepted (true), move (Queen-1 {Row-0 -> Row-3}).
...
TRACE         Move index (9), score (-3), accepted (true), move (Queen-2 {Row-0 -> Row-3}).
...
TRACE         Move index (12), score (-4), accepted (true), move (Queen-3 {Row-0 -> Row-3}).
DEBUG     LS step (0), time spent (6), score (-3), new best score (-3), accepted/selected move count (12/12), picked move (Queen-1 {Row-0 -> Row-3}).
...

Because the last solution can degrade (for example in Tabu Search), the Solver remembers the best solution it has encountered through the entire search path. Each time the current solution is better than the last best solution, the current solution is cloned and referenced as the new best solution.

localSearchScoreOverTime

13.2.3. Acceptor

An Acceptor is used (together with a Forager) to active Tabu Search, Simulated Annealing, Late Acceptance, …​ For each move it checks whether it is accepted or not.

By changing a few lines of configuration, you can easily switch from Tabu Search to Simulated Annealing or Late Acceptance and back.

You can implement your own Acceptor, but the built-in acceptors should suffice for most needs. You can also combine multiple acceptors.

13.2.4. Forager

A Forager gathers all accepted moves and picks the move which is the next step. Normally it picks the accepted move with the highest score. If several accepted moves have the highest score, one is picked randomly to break the tie. Breaking ties randomly leads to better results.

It is possible to disable breaking ties randomly by explicitly setting breakTieRandomly to false, but that’s almost never a good idea:

  • If an earlier move is better than a later move with the same score, the score calculator should add an extra softer score level to score the first move as slightly better. Don’t rely on move selection order to enforce that.

  • Random tie breaking does not affect reproducibility.

13.2.4.1. Accepted Count Limit

When there are many possible moves, it becomes inefficient to evaluate all of them at every step. To evaluate only a random subset of all the moves, use:

  • An acceptedCountLimit integer, which specifies how many accepted moves should be evaluated during each step. By default, all accepted moves are evaluated at every step.

      <forager>
        <acceptedCountLimit>1000</acceptedCountLimit>
      </forager>

Unlike the n queens problem, real world problems require the use of acceptedCountLimit. Start from an acceptedCountLimit that takes a step in less than two seconds. Turn on INFO logging to see the step times. Use the Benchmarker to tweak the value.

With a low acceptedCountLimit (so a fast stepping algorithm), it is recommended to avoid using selectionOrder SHUFFLED because the shuffling generates a random number for every element in the selector, taking up a lot of time, but only a few elements are actually selected.

13.2.4.2. Pick Early Type

A forager can pick a move early during a step, ignoring subsequent selected moves. There are three pick early types for Local Search:

  • NEVER: A move is never picked early: all accepted moves are evaluated that the selection allows. This is the default.

        <forager>
          <pickEarlyType>NEVER</pickEarlyType>
        </forager>
  • FIRST_BEST_SCORE_IMPROVING: Pick the first accepted move that improves the best score. If none improve the best score, it behaves exactly like the pickEarlyType NEVER.

        <forager>
          <pickEarlyType>FIRST_BEST_SCORE_IMPROVING</pickEarlyType>
        </forager>
  • FIRST_LAST_STEP_SCORE_IMPROVING: Pick the first accepted move that improves the last step score. If none improve the last step score, it behaves exactly like the pickEarlyType NEVER.

        <forager>
          <pickEarlyType>FIRST_LAST_STEP_SCORE_IMPROVING</pickEarlyType>
        </forager>

13.3. Hill Climbing (Simple Local Search)

13.3.1. Algorithm Description

Hill Climbing tries all selected moves and then takes the best move, which is the move which leads to the solution with the highest score. That best move is called the step move. From that new solution, it again tries all selected moves and takes the best move and continues like that iteratively. If multiple selected moves tie for the best move, one of them is randomly chosen as the best move.

hillClimbingNQueens04

Notice that once a queen has moved, it can be moved again later. This is a good thing, because in an NP-complete problem it’s impossible to predict what will be the optimal final value for a planning variable.

13.3.2. Stuck in Local Optima

Hill Climbing always takes improving moves. This may seem like a good thing, but it’s not: Hill Climbing can easily get stuck in a local optimum. This happens when it reaches a solution for which all the moves deteriorate the score. Even if it picks one of those moves, the next step might go back to the original solution and which case chasing its own tail:

hillClimbingGetsStuckInLocalOptimaNQueens04

Improvements upon Hill Climbing (such as Tabu Search, Simulated Annealing and Late Acceptance) address the problem of being stuck in local optima. Therefore, it’s recommend to never use Hill Climbing, unless you’re absolutely sure there are no local optima in your planning problem.

13.3.3. Configuration

Simplest configuration:

  <localSearch>
    <localSearchType>HILL_CLIMBING</localSearchType>
  </localSearch>

Advanced configuration:

  <localSearch>
    ...
    <acceptor>
      <acceptorType>HILL_CLIMBING</acceptorType>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <acceptedCountLimit>1</acceptedCountLimit>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

13.4. Tabu Search

13.4.1. Algorithm Description

Tabu Search works like Hill Climbing, but it maintains a tabu list to avoid getting stuck in local optima. The tabu list holds recently used objects that are taboo to use for now. Moves that involve an object in the tabu list, are not accepted. The tabu list objects can be anything related to the move, such as the planning entity, planning value, move, solution, …​ Here’s an example with entity tabu for four queens, so the queens are put in the tabu list:

entityTabuSearch

It’s called Tabu Search, not Taboo Search. There is no spelling error.

Scientific paper: Tabu Search - Part 1 and Part 2 by Fred Glover (1989 - 1990)

13.4.2. Configuration

Simplest configuration:

  <localSearch>
    <localSearchType>TABU_SEARCH</localSearchType>
  </localSearch>

When Tabu Search takes steps it creates one or more tabu’s. For a number of steps, it does not accept a move if that move breaks tabu. That number of steps is the tabu size. Advanced configuration:

  <localSearch>
    ...
    <acceptor>
      <entityTabuSize>7</entityTabuSize>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <acceptedCountLimit>1000</acceptedCountLimit>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

A Tabu Search acceptor should be combined with a high acceptedCountLimit, such as 1000.

Planner implements several tabu types:

  • Planning entity tabu (recommended) makes the planning entities of recent steps tabu. For example, for N queens it makes the recently moved queens tabu. It’s recommended to start with this tabu type.

        <acceptor>
          <entityTabuSize>7</entityTabuSize>
        </acceptor>

    To avoid hard coding the tabu size, configure a tabu ratio, relative to the number of entities, for example 2%:

        <acceptor>
          <entityTabuRatio>0.02</entityTabuRatio>
        </acceptor>
  • Planning value tabu makes the planning values of recent steps tabu. For example, for N queens it makes the recently moved to rows tabu.

        <acceptor>
          <valueTabuSize>7</valueTabuSize>
        </acceptor>

    To avoid hard coding the tabu size, configure a tabu ratio, relative to the number of values, for example 2%:

        <acceptor>
          <valueTabuRatio>0.02</valueTabuRatio>
        </acceptor>
  • Move tabu makes recent steps tabu. It does not accept a move equal to one of those steps.

        <acceptor>
          <moveTabuSize>7</moveTabuSize>
        </acceptor>
  • Undo move tabu makes the undo move of recent steps tabu.

        <acceptor>
          <undoMoveTabuSize>7</undoMoveTabuSize>
        </acceptor>
  • Solution tabu makes recently visited solutions tabu. It does not accept a move that leads to one of those solutions. It requires that the Solution implements equals() and hashCode() properly. If you can spare the memory, don’t be cheap on the tabu size.

        <acceptor>
          <solutionTabuSize>1000</solutionTabuSize>
        </acceptor>

    For non-trivial cases, solution tabu is usually useless because the search space size makes it statistically highly unlikely to reach the same solution twice. Therefore its use is not recommended, except for small datasets.

Sometimes it’s useful to combine tabu types:

    <acceptor>
      <entityTabuSize>7</entityTabuSize>
      <valueTabuSize>3</valueTabuSize>
    </acceptor>

If the tabu size is too small, the solver can still get stuck in a local optimum. On the other hand, if the tabu size is too large, the solver can be inefficient by bouncing of the walls. Use the Benchmarker to fine tweak your configuration.

13.5. Simulated Annealing

13.5.1. Algorithm Description

Simulated Annealing evaluates only a few moves per step, so it steps quickly. In the classic implementation, the first accepted move is the winning step. A move is accepted if it doesn’t decrease the score or - in case it does decrease the score - it passes a random check. The chance that a decreasing move passes the random check decreases relative to the size of the score decrement and the time the phase has been running (which is represented as the temperature).

simulatedAnnealing

Simulated Annealing does not always pick the move with the highest score, neither does it evaluate many moves per step. At least at first. Instead, it gives non improving moves also a chance to be picked, depending on its score and the time gradient of the Termination. In the end, it gradually turns into Hill Climbing, only accepting improving moves.

13.5.2. Configuration

Start with a simulatedAnnealingStartingTemperature set to the maximum score delta a single move can cause. Use the Benchmarker to tweak the value. Advanced configuration:

  <localSearch>
    ...
    <acceptor>
      <simulatedAnnealingStartingTemperature>2hard/100soft</simulatedAnnealingStartingTemperature>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <acceptedCountLimit>1</acceptedCountLimit>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

Simulated Annealing should use a low acceptedCountLimit. The classic algorithm uses an acceptedCountLimit of 1, but often 4 performs better.

Simulated Annealing can be combined with a tabu acceptor at the same time. That gives Simulated Annealing salted with a bit of Tabu. Use a lower tabu size than in a pure Tabu Search configuration.

  <localSearch>
    ...
    <acceptor>
      <simulatedAnnealingStartingTemperature>2hard/100soft</simulatedAnnealingStartingTemperature>
      <entityTabuSize>5</entityTabuSize>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <acceptedCountLimit>1</acceptedCountLimit>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

13.6. Late Acceptance

13.6.1. Algorithm Description

Late Acceptance (also known as Late Acceptance Hill Climbing) also evaluates only a few moves per step. A move is accepted if it does not decrease the score, or if it leads to a score that is at least the late score (which is the winning score of a fixed number of steps ago).

lateAcceptance

13.6.2. Configuration

Simplest configuration:

  <localSearch>
    <localSearchType>LATE_ACCEPTANCE</localSearchType>
  </localSearch>

Late Acceptance accepts any move that has a score which is higher than the best score of a number of steps ago. That number of steps is the lateAcceptanceSize. Advanced configuration:

  <localSearch>
    ...
    <acceptor>
      <lateAcceptanceSize>400</lateAcceptanceSize>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <acceptedCountLimit>1</acceptedCountLimit>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

Late Acceptance should use a low acceptedCountLimit.

Late Acceptance can be combined with a tabu acceptor at the same time. That gives Late Acceptance salted with a bit of Tabu. Use a lower tabu size than in a pure Tabu Search configuration.

  <localSearch>
    ...
    <acceptor>
      <lateAcceptanceSize>400</lateAcceptanceSize>
      <entityTabuSize>5</entityTabuSize>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <acceptedCountLimit>1</acceptedCountLimit>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

13.7. Step Counting Hill Climbing

13.7.1. Algorithm Description

Step Counting Hill Climbing also evaluates only a few moves per step. For a number of steps, it keeps the step score as a threshold. A move is accepted if it does not decrease the score, or if it leads to a score that is at least the threshold score.

13.7.2. Configuration

Step Counting Hill Climbing accepts any move that has a score which is higher than a threshold score. Every number of steps (specified by stepCountingHillClimbingSize), the threshold score is set to the step score.

  <localSearch>
    ...
    <acceptor>
      <stepCountingHillClimbingSize>400</stepCountingHillClimbingSize>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <acceptedCountLimit>1</acceptedCountLimit>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

Step Counting Hill Climbing should use a low acceptedCountLimit.

Step Counting Hill Climbing can be combined with a tabu acceptor at the same time, similar as shown in the Late Acceptance section.

13.8. Strategic Oscillation

13.8.1. Algorithm Description

Strategic Oscillation is an add-on, which works especially well with Tabu Search. Instead of picking the accepted move with the highest score, it employs a different mechanism: If there’s an improving move, it picks it. If there’s no improving move however, it prefers moves which improve a softer score level, over moves which break a harder score level less.

13.8.2. Configuration

Configure a finalistPodiumType, for example in a Tabu Search configuration:

  <localSearch>
    ...
    <acceptor>
      <entityTabuSize>7</entityTabuSize>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <acceptedCountLimit>1000</acceptedCountLimit>
      <finalistPodiumType>STRATEGIC_OSCILLATION</finalistPodiumType>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

The following finalistPodiumTypes are supported:

  • HIGHEST_SCORE (default): Pick the accepted move with the highest score.

  • STRATEGIC_OSCILLATION: Alias for the default strategic oscillation variant.

  • STRATEGIC_OSCILLATION_BY_LEVEL: If there is an accepted improving move, pick it. If no such move exists, prefer an accepted move which improves a softer score level over one that doesn’t (even if it has a better harder score level). A move is improving if it’s better than the last completed step score.

  • STRATEGIC_OSCILLATION_BY_LEVEL_ON_BEST_SCORE: Like STRATEGIC_OSCILLATION_BY_LEVEL, but define improving as better than the best score (instead of the last completed step score).

13.9. Variable Neighborhood Descent

13.9.1. Algorithm Description

Variable Neighborhood Descent iteratively tries multiple move selectors in original order (depleting each selector entirely before trying the next one), picking the first improving move (which also resets the iterator back to the first move selector).

Despite that VND has a name that ends with descent (from the research papers), the implementation will ascend to a higher score (which is a better score).

13.9.2. Configuration

Simplest configuration:

  <localSearch>
    <localSearchType>VARIABLE_NEIGHBORHOOD_DESCENT</localSearchType>
  </localSearch>

Advanced configuration:

  <localSearch>
    <unionMoveSelector>
      <selectionOrder>ORIGINAL</selectionOrder>
      <changeMoveSelector/>
      <swapMoveSelector/>
      ...
    </unionMoveSelector>
    <acceptor>
      <acceptorType>HILL_CLIMBING</acceptorType>
    </acceptor>
    <forager>
      <pickEarlyType>FIRST_LAST_STEP_SCORE_IMPROVING</pickEarlyType>
    </forager>
  </localSearch>

Variable Neighborhood Descent doesn’t scale well, but it is useful in some use cases with a very erratic score landscape.

13.10. Using a Custom Termination, MoveSelector, EntitySelector, ValueSelector or Acceptor

Plug in a custom Termination, MoveSelector, EntitySelector, ValueSelector or Acceptor by extending the abstract class and also the related \*Config class.

Extending Config classes is not covered by the backwards compatbility gaurantee. Whenever possible, it’s better to just use custom properties instead.

For example, to use a custom Termination, extend the AbstractTermination class, extend the TerminationConfig class and configure it in the solver configuration.

<solver>
  <termination class="...MyTerminationConfig">
    <myProperty>myValue</myProperty>
  </termination>
</solver>

It’s not possible to inject a Termination, …​ instance directly (to avoid extending a Config class too) because:

  • A SolverFactory can build multiple Solver instances, which each require a distinct Termination, …​ instance.

  • A solver configuration needs to be serializable from and to XML. This makes benchmarking with PlannerBenchmark particularly easy because you can configure different Solver variants in XML.

  • A Config class is often easier and clearer to configure. For example: TerminationConfig translates minutesSpentLimit and secondsSpentLimit into timeMillisSpentLimit.

If you write a custom implementation of any of those classes, let us know why on our forum. If it’s not domain specific, you might want to consider contributing it back as a pull request on github: we’ll optimize it and take it along in future refactorings.

14. Evolutionary Algorithms

14.1. Overview

Evolutionary Algorithms work on a population of solutions and evolve that population.

14.2. Evolutionary Strategies

This algorithm has not been implemented yet.

14.3. Genetic Algorithms

This algorithm has not been implemented yet.

A good Genetic Algorithms prototype in Planner was written some time ago, but it wasn’t practical to merge and support it at the time. The results of Genetic Algorithms were consistently and seriously inferior to all the Local Search variants (except Hill Climbing) on all use cases tried. Nevertheless, a future version of Planner will add support for Genetic Algorithms, so you can easily benchmark Genetic Algorithms on your use case too.

15. Hyperheuristics

15.1. Overview

A hyperheuristic automates the decision which heuristic(s) to use on a specific data set.

A future version of Planner will have native support for hyperheuristics. Meanwhile, it’s possible to implement it yourself: Based on the size or difficulty of a data set (which is a criterion), use a different Solver configuration (or adjust the default configuration using the Solver configuration API). The Benchmarker can help to identify such criteria.

16. Partitioned Search

16.1. Algorithm Description

It is often more efficient to partition large data sets (usually above 5000 planning entities) into smaller pieces and solve them separately. Partition Search is multithreaded, so it provides a performance boost on multi-core machines due to higher CPU utilization. Additionally, even when only using one CPU, it finds an initial solution faster, because the search space sum of a partitioned Construction Heuristic is far less than its non-partitioned variant.

However, partitioning does lead to suboptimal results, even if the pieces are solved optimally, as shown below:

mapReduceIsTerribleForTsp

It effectively trades a short term gain in solution quality for long term loss. One way to compensate for this loss, is to run a non-partitioned Local Search after the Partitioned Search phase.

Not all use cases can be partitioned. Partitioning only works for use cases where the planning entities and value ranges can be split into n partitions, without any of the constraints crossing boundaries between partitions.

16.2. Configuration

Simplest configuration:

  <partitionedSearch>
    <solutionPartitionerClass>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.optional.partitioner.CloudBalancePartitioner</solutionPartitionerClass>
  </partitionedSearch>

Also add a @PlanningId annotations on every planning entity class and planning value class. There are several ways to partition a solution.

Advanced configuration:

  <partitionedSearch>
    ...
    <solutionPartitionerClass>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.optional.partitioner.CloudBalancePartitioner</solutionPartitionerClass>
    <runnablePartThreadLimit>4</runnablePartThreadLimit>

    <constructionHeuristic>...</constructionHeuristic>
    <localSearch>...</localSearch>
  </partitionedSearch>

The runnablePartThreadLimit allows limiting CPU usage to avoid hanging your machine, see below.

To run in an environment that doesn’t like arbitrary thread creation, plug in a custom thread factory.

A logging level of debug or trace causes congestion in multithreaded Partitioned Search and slows down the score calculation speed.

Just like a <solver> element, the <partitionedSearch> element can contain one or more phases. Each of those phases will be run on each partition.

A common configuration is to first run a Partitioned Search phase (which includes a Construction Heuristic and a Local Search) followed by a non-partitioned Local Search phase:

  <partitionedSearch>
    <solutionPartitionerClass>...CloudBalancePartitioner</solutionPartitionerClass>

    <constructionHeuristic/>
    <localSearch>
      <termination>
        <secondsSpentLimit>60</secondsSpentLimit>
      </termination>
    </localSearch>
  </partitionedSearch>
  <localSearch/>

16.3. Partitioning a Solution

16.3.1. Custom SolutionPartitioner

To use a custom SolutionPartitioner, configure one on the Partitioned Search phase:

  <partitionedSearch>
    <solutionPartitionerClass>org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.optional.partitioner.CloudBalancePartitioner</solutionPartitionerClass>
  </partitionedSearch>

Implement the SolutionPartitioner interface:

public interface SolutionPartitioner<Solution_> {

    List<Solution_> splitWorkingSolution(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector, Integer runnablePartThreadLimit);

}

The size() of the returned List is the partCount (the number of partitions). This can be decided dynamically, for example, based on the size of the non-partitioned solution. The partCount is unrelated to the runnablePartThreadLimit.

For example:

public class CloudBalancePartitioner implements SolutionPartitioner<CloudBalance> {

    private int partCount = 4;
    private int minimumProcessListSize = 75;

    @Override
    public List<CloudBalance> splitWorkingSolution(ScoreDirector<CloudBalance> scoreDirector, Integer runnablePartThreadLimit) {
        CloudBalance originalSolution = scoreDirector.getWorkingSolution();
        List<CloudComputer> originalComputerList = originalSolution.getComputerList();
        List<CloudProcess> originalProcessList = originalSolution.getProcessList();
        int partCount = this.partCount;
        if (originalProcessList.size() / partCount < minimumProcessListSize) {
            partCount = originalProcessList.size() / minimumProcessListSize;
        }
        List<CloudBalance> partList = new ArrayList<>(partCount);
        for (int i = 0; i < partCount; i++) {
            CloudBalance partSolution = new CloudBalance(originalSolution.getId(),
                    new ArrayList<>(originalComputerList.size() / partCount + 1),
                    new ArrayList<>(originalProcessList.size() / partCount + 1));
            partList.add(partSolution);
        }

        int partIndex = 0;
        Map<Long, Pair<Integer, CloudComputer>> idToPartIndexAndComputerMap = new HashMap<>(originalComputerList.size());
        for (CloudComputer originalComputer : originalComputerList) {
            CloudBalance part = partList.get(partIndex);
            CloudComputer computer = new CloudComputer(
                    originalComputer.getId(),
                    originalComputer.getCpuPower(), originalComputer.getMemory(),
                    originalComputer.getNetworkBandwidth(), originalComputer.getCost());
            part.getComputerList().add(computer);
            idToPartIndexAndComputerMap.put(computer.getId(), Pair.of(partIndex, computer));
            partIndex = (partIndex + 1) % partList.size();
        }

        partIndex = 0;
        for (CloudProcess originalProcess : originalProcessList) {
            CloudBalance part = partList.get(partIndex);
            CloudProcess process = new CloudProcess(
                    originalProcess.getId(),
                    originalProcess.getRequiredCpuPower(), originalProcess.getRequiredMemory(),
                    originalProcess.getRequiredNetworkBandwidth());
            part.getProcessList().add(process);
            if (originalProcess.getComputer() != null) {
                Pair<Integer, CloudComputer> partIndexAndComputer = idToPartIndexAndComputerMap.get(
                        originalProcess.getComputer().getId());
                if (partIndexAndComputer == null) {
                    throw new IllegalStateException("The initialized process (" + originalProcess
                            + ") has a computer (" + originalProcess.getComputer()
                            + ") which doesn't exist in the originalSolution (" + originalSolution + ").");
                }
                if (partIndex != partIndexAndComputer.getLeft().intValue()) {
                    throw new IllegalStateException("The initialized process (" + originalProcess
                            + ") with partIndex (" + partIndex
                            + ") has a computer (" + originalProcess.getComputer()
                            + ") which belongs to another partIndex (" + partIndexAndComputer.getLeft() + ").");
                }
                process.setComputer(partIndexAndComputer.getRight());
            }
            partIndex = (partIndex + 1) % partList.size();
        }
        return partList;
    }

}

To configure values of a SolutionPartitioner dynamically in the solver configuration (so the Benchmarker can tweak those parameters), add the solutionPartitionerCustomProperties element and use custom properties:

  <partitionedSearch>
    <solutionPartitionerClass>...CloudBalancePartitioner</solutionPartitionerClass>
    <solutionPartitionerCustomProperties>
      <myPartCount>8</myPartCount>
      <myMinimumProcessListSize>100</myMinimumProcessListSize>
    </solutionPartitionerCustomProperties>
  </partitionedSearch>

16.4. Runnable Part Thread Limit

When running a multithreaded solver, such as Partitioned Search, CPU power can quickly become a scarce resource, which can cause other processes or threads to hang or freeze. However, Planner has a system to prevent CPU starving of other processes (such as an SSH connection in production or your IDE in development) or other threads (such as the servlet threads that handle REST requests).

As explained in sizing hardware and software, each solver (including each child solver) does no IO during solve() and therefore saturates one CPU core completely. In Partitioned Search, every partition always has its own thread, called a part thread. It is impossible for two partitions to share a thread, because of asynchronous termination: the second thread would never run. Every part thread will try to consume one CPU core entirely, so if there are more partitions than CPU cores, this will probably hang the system. Thread.setPriority() is often too weak to solve this hogging problem, so another approach is used.

The runnablePartThreadLimit parameter specifies how many part threads are runnable at the same time. The other part threads will temporarily block and therefore will not consume any CPU power. This parameter basically specifies how many CPU cores are donated to Planner. All part threads share the CPU cores in a round-robin manner to consume (more or less) the same number of CPU cycles:

partitionedSearchThreading

The following runnablePartThreadLimit options are supported:

  • UNLIMITED: Allow Planner to occupy all CPU cores, do not avoid hogging. Useful if a no hogging CPU policy is configured on the OS level.

  • AUTO (default): Let Planner decide how many CPU cores to occupy. This formula is based on experience. It does not hog all CPU cores on a multi-core machine.

  • Static number: The number of CPU cores to consume. For example:

    <runnablePartThreadLimit>2</runnablePartThreadLimit>
  • JavaScript formula: Formula for the number of CPU cores to occupy. It can use the variable availableProcessorCount. For example:

    <runnablePartThreadLimit>availableProcessorCount - 2</runnablePartThreadLimit>

If the runnablePartThreadLimit is equal to or higher than the number of available processors, the host is likely to hang or freeze, unless there is an OS specific policy in place to avoid Planner from hogging all the CPU processors.

17. Benchmarking and Tweaking

17.1. Find the Best Solver Configuration

Planner supports several optimization algorithms, so you’re probably wondering which is the best one? Although some optimization algorithms generally perform better than others, it really depends on your problem domain. Most solver phases have parameters which can be tweaked. Those parameters can influence the results a lot, even though most solver phases work pretty well out-of-the-box.

Luckily, Planner includes a benchmarker, which allows you to play out different solver phases with different settings against each other in development, so you can use the best configuration for your planning problem in production.

benchmarkOverview

17.2. Benchmark Configuration

17.2.1. Add a Dependency on optaplanner-benchmark

The benchmarker is in a separate artifact called optaplanner-benchmark.

If you use Maven, add a dependency in your pom.xml file:

    <dependency>
      <groupId>org.optaplanner</groupId>
      <artifactId>optaplanner-benchmark</artifactId>
    </dependency>

This is similar for Gradle, Ivy and Buildr. The version must be exactly the same as the optaplanner-core version used (which is automatically the case if you import optaplanner-bom).

If you use ANT, you’ve probably already copied the required jars from the download zip’s binaries directory.

17.2.2. Run a Simple Benchmark

To quickly setup a benchmark, create a PlannerBenchmarkFactory from your SolverFactory, load a few datasets and benchmark them. For example, with 3 datasets:

        SolverFactory<CloudBalance> solverFactory = SolverFactory.createFromXmlResource(...);
        PlannerBenchmarkFactory benchmarkFactory = PlannerBenchmarkFactory.createFromSolverFactory(solverFactory);

        CloudBalance dataset1 = ...;
        CloudBalance dataset2 = ...;
        CloudBalance dataset3 = ...;
        PlannerBenchmark plannerBenchmark = benchmarkFactory.buildPlannerBenchmark(dataset1, dataset2, dataset3);
        plannerBenchmark.benchmarkAndShowReportInBrowser();

This generates a benchmark report in local/benchmarkReport and shows it in your browser when it’s finished. The SolverFactory’s solver configuration needs a termination to limit how long each dataset runs. To configure a different benchmark directory, pass a `File parameter to createFromSolverFactory().

The generated benchmark report already contains interesting information, but it doesn’t allow comparing solver configurations to find the best algorithm. To do that, set up a benchmark configuration:

17.2.3. Configure and Run an Advanced Benchmark

Build a PlannerBenchmark instance with a PlannerBenchmarkFactory. Configure it with a benchmark configuration XML file, provided as a classpath resource:

        PlannerBenchmarkFactory plannerBenchmarkFactory = PlannerBenchmarkFactory.createFromXmlResource(
                "org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/benchmark/nqueensBenchmarkConfig.xml");
        PlannerBenchmark plannerBenchmark = plannerBenchmarkFactory.buildPlannerBenchmark();
        plannerBenchmark.benchmark();

A benchmark configuration file looks like this:

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<plannerBenchmark>
  <benchmarkDirectory>local/data/nqueens</benchmarkDirectory>

  <inheritedSolverBenchmark>
    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <inputSolutionFile>data/cloudbalancing/unsolved/100computers-300processes.xml</inputSolutionFile>
      <inputSolutionFile>data/cloudbalancing/unsolved/200computers-600processes.xml</inputSolutionFile>
    </problemBenchmarks>
    <solver>
      ...<!-- Common solver configuration -->
    </solver>
  </inheritedSolverBenchmark>

  <solverBenchmark>
    <name>Tabu Search</name>
    <solver>
      ...<!-- Tabu Search specific solver configuration -->
    </solver>
  </solverBenchmark>
  <solverBenchmark>
    <name>Simulated Annealing</name>
    <solver>
      ...<!-- Simulated Annealing specific solver configuration -->
    </solver>
  </solverBenchmark>
  <solverBenchmark>
    <name>Late Acceptance</name>
    <solver>
      ...<!-- Late Acceptance specific solver configuration -->
    </solver>
  </solverBenchmark>
</plannerBenchmark>

This PlannerBenchmark will try three configurations (Tabu Search, Simulated Annealing and Late Acceptance) on two data sets (100computers-300processes and 200computers-600processes), so it will run six solvers.

Every <solverBenchmark> element contains a solver configuration and one or more <inputSolutionFile> elements. It will run the solver configuration on each of those unsolved solution files. The element name is optional, because it is generated if absent. The inputSolutionFile is read by a SolutionFileIO (relative to the working directory).

Use a forward slash (/) as the file separator (for example in the element <inputSolutionFile>). That will work on any platform (including Windows).

Do not use backslash (\) as the file separator: that breaks portability because it does not work on Linux and Mac.

The benchmark report will be written in the directory specified by the <benchmarkDirectory> element (relative to the working directory).

It’s recommended that the benchmarkDirectory is a directory ignored for source control and not cleaned by your build system. This way the generated files are not bloating your source control and they aren’t lost when doing a build. For example in git, it should be added to .gitignore. Usually that directory is called local.

If an Exception or Error occurs in a single benchmark, the entire Benchmarker will not fail-fast (unlike everything else in Planner). Instead, the Benchmarker will continue to run all other benchmarks, write the benchmark report and then fail (if there is at least one failing single benchmark). The failing benchmarks will be clearly marked as such in the benchmark report.

17.2.3.1. Inherited solver benchmark

To lower verbosity, the common parts of multiple <solverBenchmark> elements are extracted to the <inheritedSolverBenchmark> element. Every property can still be overwritten per <solverBenchmark> element. Note that inherited solver phases such as <constructionHeuristic> or <localSearch> are not overwritten but instead are added to the tail of the solver phases list.

17.2.4. SolutionFileIO: Input And Output Of Solution Files

17.2.4.1. SolutionFileIO Interface

The benchmarker needs to be able to read the input files to load a Solution. Also, it optionally writes the best Solution of each benchmark to an output file. It does that through the SolutionFileIO interface which has a read and write method:

public interface SolutionFileIO<Solution_> {
    ...

    Solution_ read(File inputSolutionFile);
    void write(Solution_ solution, File outputSolutionFile);

}

The SolutionFileIO interface is in the optaplanner-persistence-common jar (which is a dependency of the optaplanner-benchmark jar). There are several ways to serialize a solution:

17.2.4.2. XStreamSolutionFileIO: Serialize To And From An XML Format

To use the XStreamSolutionFileIO instance to read and write solutions, configure your Solution class as an xStreamAnnotatedClass:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      <xStreamAnnotatedClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.domain.NQueens</xStreamAnnotatedClass>
      <inputSolutionFile>data/nqueens/unsolved/32queens.xml</inputSolutionFile>
      ...
    </problemBenchmarks>

Those input files need to have been written with a XStreamSolutionFileIO instance, not just any XStream instance, because the XStreamSolutionFileIO uses a customized XStream instance.

The inputSolutionFile needs to come from a trusted source: if it contains malicious data, it can be exploited. The XStreamSolutionFileIO disables the XStream security framework, so it just works out of the box.

If you expose benchmarking in production, use XStreamSolutionFileIO.getXStream() to enable the security framework and explicitly whitelist all marshalled classes.

Add XStream annotations (such as @XStreamAlias) on your domain classes to use a less verbose XML format. Regardless, XML is still a very verbose format. Reading or writing large datasets in this format can cause an OutOfMemoryError, StackOverflowError or large performance degradation.

17.2.4.3. Custom SolutionFileIO: Serialize To And From A Custom Format

Implement your own SolutionFileIO implementation and configure it with the solutionFileIOClass element to write to a custom format (such as a txt or a binary format):

    <problemBenchmarks>
      <solutionFileIOClass>org.optaplanner.examples.machinereassignment.persistence.MachineReassignmentFileIO</solutionFileIOClass>
      <inputSolutionFile>data/machinereassignment/import/model_a1_1.txt</inputSolutionFile>
      ...
    </problemBenchmarks>

It’s recommended that output files can be read as input files, which implies that getInputFileExtension() and getOutputFileExtension() return the same value.

A SolutionFileIO implementation must be thread-safe.

17.2.4.4. Reading An Input Solution From A Database (Or Other Storage)

There are two options if your dataset is in a relational database or another type of repository:

  • Extract the datasets from the database and serialize them to a local file (for example as XML with XStreamSolutionFileIO if XML isn’t too verbose). Then use those files in <inputSolutionFile> elements.

    • The benchmarks are now more reliable because they run offline.

    • Each dataset is only loaded just in time.

  • Load all the datasets in advance and pass them to the buildPlannerBenchmark() method:

            PlannerBenchmark plannerBenchmark = benchmarkFactory.buildPlannerBenchmark(dataset1, dataset2, dataset3);

17.2.5. Warming Up The HotSpot Compiler

Without a warm up, the results of the first (or first few) benchmarks are not reliable, because they will lose CPU time on HotSpot JIT compilation (and possibly DRL compilation too).

To avoid that distortion, the benchmarker runs some of the benchmarks for 30 seconds, before running the real benchmarks. That default warm up of 30 seconds usually suffices. Change it, for example to give it 60 seconds:

<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <warmUpSecondsSpentLimit>60</warmUpSecondsSpentLimit>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

Turn off the warm up phase altogether by setting it to zero:

<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <warmUpSecondsSpentLimit>0</warmUpSecondsSpentLimit>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

The warm up time budget does not include the time it takes to load the datasets. With large datasets, this can cause the warm up to run considerably longer than specified in the configuration.

17.2.6. Benchmark Blueprint: A Predefined Configuration

To quickly configure and run a benchmark for typical solver configs, use a solverBenchmarkBluePrint instead of solverBenchmarks:

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<plannerBenchmark>
  <benchmarkDirectory>local/data/nqueens</benchmarkDirectory>

  <inheritedSolverBenchmark>
    <problemBenchmarks>
      <xStreamAnnotatedClass>org.optaplanner.examples.nqueens.domain.NQueens</xStreamAnnotatedClass>
      <inputSolutionFile>data/nqueens/unsolved/32queens.xml</inputSolutionFile>
      <inputSolutionFile>data/nqueens/unsolved/64queens.xml</inputSolutionFile>
    </problemBenchmarks>
    <solver>
      <scanAnnotatedClasses/>
      <scoreDirectorFactory>
        <scoreDrl>org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/solver/nQueensScoreRules.drl</scoreDrl>
        <initializingScoreTrend>ONLY_DOWN</initializingScoreTrend>
      </scoreDirectorFactory>
      <termination>
        <minutesSpentLimit>1</minutesSpentLimit>
      </termination>
    </solver>
  </inheritedSolverBenchmark>

  <solverBenchmarkBluePrint>
    <solverBenchmarkBluePrintType>EVERY_CONSTRUCTION_HEURISTIC_TYPE_WITH_EVERY_LOCAL_SEARCH_TYPE</solverBenchmarkBluePrintType>
  </solverBenchmarkBluePrint>
</plannerBenchmark>

The following SolverBenchmarkBluePrintTypes are supported:

  • CONSTRUCTION_HEURISTIC_WITH_AND_WITHOUT_LOCAL_SEARCH: Run the default Construction Heuristic type with and without the default Local Search type.

  • EVERY_CONSTRUCTION_HEURISTIC_TYPE: Run every Construction Heuristic type (First Fit, First Fit Decreasing, Cheapest Insertion, …​).

  • EVERY_LOCAL_SEARCH_TYPE: Run every Local Search type (Tabu Search, Late Acceptance, …​) with the default Construction Heuristic.

  • EVERY_CONSTRUCTION_HEURISTIC_TYPE_WITH_EVERY_LOCAL_SEARCH_TYPE: Run every Construction Heuristic type with every Local Search type.

17.2.7. Write The Output Solution Of Benchmark Runs

The best solution of each benchmark run can be written in the benchmarkDirectory. By default, this is disabled, because the files are rarely used and considered bloat. Also, on large datasets, writing the best solution of each single benchmark can take quite some time and memory (causing an OutOfMemoryError), especially in a verbose format like XStream XML.

To write those solutions in the benchmarkDirectory, enable writeOutputSolutionEnabled:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <writeOutputSolutionEnabled>true</writeOutputSolutionEnabled>
      ...
    </problemBenchmarks>

17.2.8. Benchmark Logging

Benchmark logging is configured like solver logging.

To separate the log messages of each single benchmark run into a separate file, use the MDC with key singleBenchmark.name in a sifting appender. For example with Logback in logback.xml:

  <appender name="fileAppender" class="ch.qos.logback.classic.sift.SiftingAppender">
    <discriminator>
      <key>singleBenchmark.name</key>
      <defaultValue>app</defaultValue>
    </discriminator>
    <sift>
      <appender name="fileAppender.${singleBenchmark.name}" class="...FileAppender">
        <file>local/log/optaplannerBenchmark-${singleBenchmark.name}.log</file>
        ...
      </appender>
    </sift>
  </appender>

17.3. Benchmark Report

17.3.1. HTML Report

After running a benchmark, an HTML report will be written in the benchmarkDirectory with the index.html filename. Open it in your browser. It has a nice overview of your benchmark including:

  • Summary statistics: graphs and tables

  • Problem statistics per inputSolutionFile: graphs and CSV

  • Each solver configuration (ranked): Handy to copy and paste

  • Benchmark information: settings, hardware, …​

Graphs are generated by the excellent JFreeChart library.

The HTML report will use your default locale to format numbers. If you share the benchmark report with people from another country, consider overwriting the locale accordingly:

<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <benchmarkReport>
    <locale>en_US</locale>
  </benchmarkReport>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

17.3.2. Ranking The Solvers

The benchmark report automatically ranks the solvers. The Solver with rank 0 is called the favorite Solver: it performs best overall, but it might not be the best on every problem. It’s recommended to use that favorite Solver in production.

However, there are different ways of ranking the solvers. Configure it like this:

<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <benchmarkReport>
    <solverRankingType>TOTAL_SCORE</solverRankingType>
  </benchmarkReport>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

The following solverRankingTypes are supported:

  • TOTAL_SCORE (default): Maximize the overall score, so minimize the overall cost if all solutions would be executed.

  • WORST_SCORE: Minimize the worst case scenario.

  • TOTAL_RANKING: Maximize the overall ranking. Use this if your datasets differ greatly in size or difficulty, producing a difference in Score magnitude.

Solvers with at least one failed single benchmark do not get a ranking. Solvers with not fully initialized solutions are ranked worse.

To use a custom ranking, implement a Comparator:

  <benchmarkReport>
    <solverRankingComparatorClass>...TotalScoreSolverRankingComparator</solverRankingComparatorClass>
  </benchmarkReport>

Or by implementing a weight factory:

  <benchmarkReport>
    <solverRankingWeightFactoryClass>...TotalRankSolverRankingWeightFactory</solverRankingWeightFactoryClass>
  </benchmarkReport>

17.4. Summary Statistics

17.4.1. Best Score Summary (Graph And Table)

Shows the best score per inputSolutionFile for each solver configuration.

Useful for visualizing the best solver configuration.

bestScoreSummary
Figure 8. Best Score Summary Statistic

17.4.2. Best Score Scalability Summary (Graph)

Shows the best score per problem scale for each solver configuration.

Useful for visualizing the scalability of each solver configuration.

The problem scale will report 0 if any @ValueRangeProvider method signature returns ValueRange (instead of CountableValueRange or Collection).

17.4.3. Best Score Distribution Summary (Graph)

Shows the best score distribution per inputSolutionFile for each solver configuration.

Useful for visualizing the reliability of each solver configuration.

bestScoreDistributionSummary
Figure 9. Best Score Distribution Summary Statistic

Enable statistical benchmarking to use this summary.

17.4.4. Winning Score Difference Summary (Graph And Table)

Shows the winning score difference per inputSolutionFile for each solver configuration. The winning score difference is the score difference with the score of the winning solver configuration for that particular inputSolutionFile.

Useful for zooming in on the results of the best score summary.

17.4.5. Worst Score Difference Percentage (ROI) Summary (Graph and Table)

Shows the return on investment (ROI) per inputSolutionFile for each solver configuration if you’d upgrade from the worst solver configuration for that particular inputSolutionFile.

Useful for visualizing the return on investment (ROI) to decision makers.

17.4.6. Score Calculation Speed Summary (Graph and Table)

Shows the score calculation speed: a count per second per problem scale for each solver configuration.

Useful for comparing different score calculators and/or score rule implementations (presuming that the solver configurations do not differ otherwise). Also useful to measure the scalability cost of an extra constraint.

17.4.7. Time Spent Summary (Graph And Table)

Shows the time spent per inputSolutionFile for each solver configuration. This is pointless if it’s benchmarking against a fixed time limit.

Useful for visualizing the performance of construction heuristics (presuming that no other solver phases are configured).

17.4.8. Time Spent Scalability Summary (Graph)

Shows the time spent per problem scale for each solver configuration. This is pointless if it’s benchmarking against a fixed time limit.

Useful for extrapolating the scalability of construction heuristics (presuming that no other solver phases are configured).

17.4.9. Best Score Per Time Spent Summary (Graph)

Shows the best score per time spent for each solver configuration. This is pointless if it’s benchmarking against a fixed time limit.

Useful for visualizing trade-off between the best score versus the time spent for construction heuristics (presuming that no other solver phases are configured).

17.5. Statistic Per Dataset (Graph And CSV)

17.5.1. Enable A Problem Statistic

The benchmarker supports outputting problem statistics as graphs and CSV (comma separated values) files to the benchmarkDirectory. To configure one or more, add a problemStatisticType line for each one:

<plannerBenchmark>
  <benchmarkDirectory>local/data/nqueens/solved</benchmarkDirectory>
  <inheritedSolverBenchmark>
    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticType>BEST_SCORE</problemStatisticType>
      <problemStatisticType>SCORE_CALCULATION_SPEED</problemStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
    ...
  </inheritedSolverBenchmark>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

These problem statistics can slow down the solvers noticeably, which affects the benchmark results. That’s why they are optional and only BEST_SCORE is enabled by default. To disable that one too, use problemStatisticEnabled:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticEnabled>false</problemStatisticEnabled>
    </problemBenchmarks>

The summary statistics do not slow down the solver and are always generated.

The following types are supported:

17.5.2. Best Score Over Time Statistic (Graph And CSV)

Shows how the best score evolves over time. It is run by default. To run it when other statistics are configured, also add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticType>BEST_SCORE</problemStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
bestScoreStatistic
Figure 10. Best Score Over Time Statistic

A time gradient based algorithm (such as Simulated Annealing) will have a different statistic if it’s run with a different time limit configuration. That’s because this Simulated Annealing implementation automatically determines its velocity based on the amount of time that can be spent. On the other hand, for the Tabu Search and Late Acceptance, what you see is what you’d get.

The best score over time statistic is very useful to detect abnormalities, such as a potential score trap which gets the solver temporarily stuck in a local optima.

letTheBestScoreStatisticGuideYou

17.5.3. Step Score Over Time Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see how the step score evolves over time, add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticType>STEP_SCORE</problemStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
stepScoreStatistic
Figure 11. Step Score Over Time Statistic

Compare the step score statistic with the best score statistic (especially on parts for which the best score flatlines). If it hits a local optima, the solver should take deteriorating steps to escape it. But it shouldn’t deteriorate too much either.

The step score statistic has been seen to slow down the solver noticeably due to GC stress, especially for fast stepping algorithms (such as Simulated Annealing and Late Acceptance).

17.5.4. Score Calculation Speed Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see how fast the scores are calculated, add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticType>SCORE_CALCULATION_SPEED</problemStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
scoreCalculationSpeedStatistic
Figure 12. Score Calculation Speed Statistic

The initial high calculation speed is typical during solution initialization: it’s far easier to calculate the score of a solution if only a handful planning entities have been initialized, than when all the planning entities are initialized.

After those few seconds of initialization, the calculation speed is relatively stable, apart from an occasional stop-the-world garbage collector disruption.

17.5.5. Best Solution Mutation Over Time Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see how much each new best solution differs from the previous best solution, by counting the number of planning variables which have a different value (not including the variables that have changed multiple times but still end up with the same value), add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticType>BEST_SOLUTION_MUTATION</problemStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
bestSolutionMutationStatistic
Figure 13. Best Solution Mutation Over Time Statistic

Use Tabu Search - an algorithm that behaves like a human - to get an estimation on how difficult it would be for a human to improve the previous best solution to that new best solution.

17.5.6. Move Count Per Step Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see how the selected and accepted move count per step evolves over time, add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticType>MOVE_COUNT_PER_STEP</problemStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
moveCountPerStepStatistic
Figure 14. Move Count Per Step Statistic

This statistic has been seen to slow down the solver noticeably due to GC stress, especially for fast stepping algorithms (such as Simulated Annealing and Late Acceptance).

17.5.7. Memory Use Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see how much memory is used, add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticType>MEMORY_USE</problemStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
memoryUseStatistic
Figure 15. Memory Use Statistic

The memory use statistic has been seen to affect the solver noticeably.

17.6. Statistic Per Single Benchmark (Graph And CSV)

17.6.1. Enable A Single Statistic

A single statistic is static for one dataset for one solver configuration. Unlike a problem statistic, it does not aggregate over solver configurations.

The benchmarker supports outputting single statistics as graphs and CSV (comma separated values) files to the benchmarkDirectory. To configure one, add a singleStatisticType line:

<plannerBenchmark>
  <benchmarkDirectory>local/data/nqueens/solved</benchmarkDirectory>
  <inheritedSolverBenchmark>
    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <problemStatisticType>...</problemStatisticType>
      <singleStatisticType>PICKED_MOVE_TYPE_BEST_SCORE_DIFF</singleStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
    ...
  </inheritedSolverBenchmark>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

Multiple singleStatisticType elements are allowed.

These statistic per single benchmark can slow down the solver noticeably, which affects the benchmark results. That’s why they are optional and not enabled by default.

The following types are supported:

17.6.2. Constraint Match Total Best Score Over Time Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see which constraints are matched in the best score (and how much) over time, add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <singleStatisticType>CONSTRAINT_MATCH_TOTAL_BEST_SCORE</singleStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
constraintMatchTotalBestScoreStatistic
Figure 16. Constraint Match Total Best Score Diff Over Time Statistic

Requires the score calculation to support constraint matches. Drools score calculation supports constraint matches automatically, but incremental Java score calculation requires more work.

The constraint match total statistics affect the solver noticeably.

17.6.3. Constraint Match Total Step Score Over Time Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see which constraints are matched in the step score (and how much) over time, add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <singleStatisticType>CONSTRAINT_MATCH_TOTAL_STEP_SCORE</singleStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
constraintMatchTotalStepScoreStatistic
Figure 17. Constraint Match Total Step Score Diff Over Time Statistic

Also requires the score calculation to support constraint matches.

The constraint match total statistics affect the solver noticeably.

17.6.4. Picked Move Type Best Score Diff Over Time Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see which move types improve the best score (and how much) over time, add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <singleStatisticType>PICKED_MOVE_TYPE_BEST_SCORE_DIFF</singleStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
pickedMoveTypeBestScoreDiffStatistic
Figure 18. Picked Move Type Best Score Diff Over Time Statistic

17.6.5. Picked Move Type Step Score Diff Over Time Statistic (Graph And CSV)

To see how much each winning step affects the step score over time, add:

    <problemBenchmarks>
      ...
      <singleStatisticType>PICKED_MOVE_TYPE_STEP_SCORE_DIFF</singleStatisticType>
    </problemBenchmarks>
pickedMoveTypeStepScoreDiffStatistic
Figure 19. Picked Move Type Step Score Diff Over Time Statistic

17.7. Advanced Benchmarking

17.7.1. Benchmarking Performance Tricks

17.7.1.1. Parallel Benchmarking On Multiple Threads

If you have multiple processors available on your computer, you can run multiple benchmarks in parallel on multiple threads to get your benchmarks results faster:

<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <parallelBenchmarkCount>AUTO</parallelBenchmarkCount>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

Running too many benchmarks in parallel will affect the results of benchmarks negatively. Leave some processors unused for garbage collection and other processes.

The following parallelBenchmarkCounts are supported:

  • 1 (default): Run all benchmarks sequentially.

  • AUTO: Let Planner decide how many benchmarks to run in parallel. This formula is based on experience. It’s recommended to prefer this over the other parallel enabling options.

  • Static number: The number of benchmarks to run in parallel.

    <parallelBenchmarkCount>2</parallelBenchmarkCount>
  • JavaScript formula: Formula for the number of benchmarks to run in parallel. It can use the variable availableProcessorCount. For example:

    <parallelBenchmarkCount>(availableProcessorCount / 2) + 1</parallelBenchmarkCount>

The parallelBenchmarkCount is always limited to the number of available processors. If it’s higher, it will be automatically decreased.

If you have a computer with slow or unreliable cooling, increasing the parallelBenchmarkCount above one (even on AUTO) may overheat your CPU.

The sensors command can help you detect if this is the case. It is available in the package lm_sensors or lm-sensors in most Linux distributions. There are several freeware tools available for Windows too.

The benchmarker uses a thread pool internally, but you can optionally plug in a custom ThreadFactory, for example when running benchmarks on an application server or a cloud platform:

<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <threadFactoryClass>...MyCustomThreadFactory</threadFactoryClass>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

In the future, we will also support multi-JVM benchmarking. This feature is independent of multithreaded solving or multi-JVM solving.

17.7.2. Statistical Benchmarking

To minimize the influence of your environment and the Random Number Generator on the benchmark results, configure the number of times each single benchmark run is repeated. The results of those runs are statistically aggregated. Each individual result is also visible in the report, as well as plotted in the best score distribution summary.

Just add a <subSingleCount> element to an <inheritedSolverBenchmark> element or in a <solverBenchmark> element:

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <inheritedSolverBenchmark>
    ...
    <solver>
      ...
    </solver>
    <subSingleCount>10</subSingleCount>
  </inheritedSolverBenchmark>
  ...
</plannerBenchmark>

The subSingleCount defaults to 1 (so no statistical benchmarking).

If subSingleCount is higher than 1, the benchmarker will automatically use a differentRandom seed for every sub single run, without losing reproducibility (for each sub single index) in EnvironmentModeREPRODUCIBLE and lower.

17.7.3. Template Based Benchmarking And Matrix Benchmarking

Matrix benchmarking is benchmarking a combination of value sets. For example: benchmark four entityTabuSize values (5, 7, 11 and 13) combined with three acceptedCountLimit values (500, 1000 and 2000), resulting in 12 solver configurations.

To reduce the verbosity of such a benchmark configuration, you can use a Freemarker template for the benchmark configuration instead:

<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <inheritedSolverBenchmark>
    ...
  </inheritedSolverBenchmark>

<#list [5, 7, 11, 13] as entityTabuSize>
<#list [500, 1000, 2000] as acceptedCountLimit>
  <solverBenchmark>
    <name>Tabu Search entityTabuSize ${entityTabuSize} acceptedCountLimit ${acceptedCountLimit}</name>
    <solver>
      <localSearch>
        <unionMoveSelector>
          <changeMoveSelector/>
          <swapMoveSelector/>
        </unionMoveSelector>
        <acceptor>
          <entityTabuSize>${entityTabuSize}</entityTabuSize>
        </acceptor>
        <forager>
          <acceptedCountLimit>${acceptedCountLimit}</acceptedCountLimit>
        </forager>
      </localSearch>
    </solver>
  </solverBenchmark>
</#list>
</#list>
</plannerBenchmark>

To configure Matrix Benchmarking for Simulated Annealing (or any other configuration that involves a Score template variable), use the replace() method in the solver benchmark name element:

<plannerBenchmark>
  ...
  <inheritedSolverBenchmark>
    ...
  </inheritedSolverBenchmark>

<#list ["1hard/10soft", "1hard/20soft", "1hard/50soft", "1hard/70soft"] as startingTemperature>
  <solverBenchmark>
    <name>Simulated Annealing startingTemperature ${startingTemperature?replace("/", "_")}</name>
    <solver>
      <localSearch>
        <acceptor>
          <simulatedAnnealingStartingTemperature>${startingTemperature}</simulatedAnnealingStartingTemperature>
        </acceptor>
      </localSearch>
    </solver>
  </solverBenchmark>
</#list>
</plannerBenchmark>

A solver benchmark name doesn’t allow some characters (such a /) because the name is also used a file name.

And build it with the class PlannerBenchmarkFactory:

        PlannerBenchmarkFactory plannerBenchmarkFactory = PlannerBenchmarkFactory.createFromFreemarkerXmlResource(
                "org/optaplanner/examples/cloudbalancing/optional/benchmark/cloudBalancingBenchmarkConfigTemplate.xml.ftl");
        PlannerBenchmark plannerBenchmark = plannerBenchmarkFactory.buildPlannerBenchmark();

17.7.4. Benchmark Report Aggregation

The BenchmarkAggregator takes one or more existing benchmarks and merges them into new benchmark report, without actually running the benchmarks again.

benchmarkAggregator

This is useful to:

  • Report on the impact of code changes: Run the same benchmark configuration before and after the code changes, then aggregate a report.

  • Report on the impact of dependency upgrades: Run the same benchmark configuration before and after upgrading the dependency, then aggregate a report.

  • Condense a too verbose report: Select only the interesting solver benchmarks from the existing report. This especially useful on template reports to make the graphs readable.

  • Partially rerun a benchmark: Rerun part of an existing report (for example only the failed or invalid solvers), then recreate the original intended report with the new values.

To use it, provide a PlannerBenchmarkFactory to the BenchmarkAggregatorFrame to display the GUI:

    public static void main(String[] args) {
        PlannerBenchmarkFactory plannerBenchmarkFactory = PlannerBenchmarkFactory.createFromXmlResource(
                "org/optaplanner/examples/nqueens/benchmark/nqueensBenchmarkConfig.xml");
        BenchmarkAggregatorFrame.createAndDisplay(plannerBenchmarkFactory);
    }

Despite that it uses a benchmark configuration as input, it ignores all elements of that configuration, except for the elements <benchmarkDirectory> and <benchmarkReport>.

In the GUI, select the interesting benchmarks and click the button to generate the report.

All the input reports which are being merged should have been generated with the same Planner version (excluding hotfix differences) as the BenchmarkAggregator. Using reports from different Planner major or minor versions are not guaranteed to succeed and deliver correct information, because the benchmark report data structure often changes.

18. Repeated Planning

18.1. Introduction to Repeated Planning

The problem facts used to create a solution may change before or during the execution of that solution. Delaying planning in order to lower the risk of problem facts changing is not ideal, as an incomplete plan is preferable to no plan.

The following examples demonstrate situations where planning solutions need to be altered due to unpredictable changes:

  • Unforeseen fact changes

    • An employee assigned to a shift calls in sick.

    • An airplane scheduled to take off has a technical delay.

    • One of the machines or vehicles break down.

      Unforeseen fact changes benefit from using backup planning.

  • Cannot assign all entities immediately

    Leave some unassigned. For example:

    • There are 10 shifts at the same time to assign but only nine employees to handle shifts.

      For this type of planning, use overconstrained planning.

  • Unknown long term future facts

    For example:

    • Hospital admissions for the next two weeks are reliable, but those for week three and four are less reliable, and for week five and beyond are not worth planning yet.

      This problem benefits from continuous planning.

  • Constantly changing problem facts

More CPU time results in a better planning solution.

Planner allows you to start planning earlier, despite unforeseen changes, as the optimization algorithms support planning a solution that has already been partially planned. This is known as repeated planning.

18.2. Backup Planning

Backup planning adds extra score constraints to create space in the planning for when things go wrong. That creates a backup plan within the plan itself.

An example of backup planning is as follows:

  1. Create an extra score constraint. For example:

    • Assign an employee as the spare employee (one for every 10 shifts at the same time).

    • Keep one hospital bed open in each department.

  2. Change the planning problem when an unforeseen event occurs.

    For example, if an employee calls in sick:

    • Delete the sick employee and leave their shifts unassigned.

    • Restart the planning, starting from that solution, which now has a different score.

The construction heuristics fills in the newly created gaps (probably with the spare employee) and the metaheuristics will improve it even further.

18.3. Overconstrained Planning

When there is no feasible solution to assign all planning entities, it is preferable to assign as many entities as possible without breaking hard constraints. This is called overconstrained planning.

By default, Planner assigns all planning entities, overloads the planning values, and therefore breaks hard constraints. There are two ways to avoid this:

  • Use nullable planning variables, so that some entities are unassigned.

  • Add virtual values to catch the unassigned entities.

18.3.1. Overconstrained Planning with Nullable Variables

If we handle overconstrained planning with nullable variables, the overload entities will be left unassigned:

overconstrainedPlanning

To implement this:

  1. Add an additional score level (usually a medium level between the hard and soft level) by switching Score type.

  2. Make the planning variable nullable.

  3. Add a score constraint on the new level (usually a medium constraint) to penalize the number of unassigned entities (or a weighted sum of them).

18.3.2. Overconstrained Planning with Virtual Values

In overconstrained planning it is often useful to know which resources are lacking. In overconstrained planning with virtual values, the solution indicates which resources to buy.

To implement this:

  1. Add an additional score level (usually a medium level between the hard and soft level) by switching Score type.

  2. Add a number of virtual values. It can be difficult to determine a good formula to calculate that number:

    • Do not add too many, as that will decrease solver efficiency.

    • Importantly, do not add too few as that will lead to an infeasible solution.

  3. Add a score constraint on the new level (usually a medium constraint) to penalize the number of virtual assigned entities (or a weighted sum of them).

  4. Optionally, change all soft constraints to ignore virtual assigned entities.

18.4. Continuous Planning (Windowed Planning)

Continuous planning is the technique of planning one or more upcoming planning periods at the same time and repeating that process monthly, weekly, daily, hourly, or even more frequently. However, as time is infinite, planning all future time periods is impossible.

continuousPlanningEmployeeRostering

In the employee rostering example above, we re-plan every four days. Each time, we actually plan a window of 12 days, but we only publish the first four days, which is stable enough to share with the employees, so they can plan their social life accordingly.

continuousPlanningPatientAdmissionSchedule

In the hospital bed planning example above, notice the difference between the original planning of November 1st and the new planning of November 5th: some problem facts (F, H, I, J, K) changed in the meantime, which results in unrelated planning entities (G) changing too.

The planning window can be split up in several stages:

  • History

    Immutable past time periods. It contains only immovable entities.

    • Recent historic entities can also affect score constraints that apply to movable entities. For example, in nurse rostering, a nurse that has worked the last three historic weekends in a row should not be assigned to three more weekends in a row, because she requires a one free weekend per month.

    • Do not load all historic entities in memory: even though immovable entities do not affect solving performance, they can cause out of memory problems when the data grows to years. Only load those that might still affect the current constraints with a good safety margin.

  • Published

    Upcoming time periods that have been published. They contain only Immovable and/or semi-immovable planning entities.

    • The published schedule has been shared with the business. For example, in nurse rostering, the nurses will use this schedule to plan their personal lives, so they require a publish notice of for example 3 weeks in advance. Normal planning will not change that part of schedule.

      Changing that schedule later is disruptive, but were exceptions force us to do them anyway (for example someone calls in sick), do change this part of the planning while minimizing disruption with non-disruptive replanning.

  • Draft

    Upcoming time periods after the published time periods that can change freely. They contain movable planning entities, except for any that are immovable for other reasons (such as being pinned by a user).

    • The first part of the draft, called the final draft, will be published, so these planning entities can change one last time. The publishing frequency, for example once per week, determines the number of time periods that change from draft to published.

    • The latter time periods of the draft are likely change again in later planning efforts, especially if some of the problem facts change by then (for example nurse Ann doesn’t want to work on one of those days).

      Despite that these latter planning entities might still change a lot, we can’t leave them out for later, because we would risk painting ourselves in a corner. For example, in employee rostering we could have all our rare skilled employees working the last 5 days of the week that gets published, which won’t reduce the score of that week, but will make it impossible for us to deliver a feasible schedule the next week. So the draft length needs to be longer than the part that will be published first.

    • That draft part is usually not shared with the business yet, because it is too volatile and it would only raise false expectations. However, it is stored in the database and used as a starting point for the next solver.

  • Unplanned (out of scope)

    Planning entities that are not in the current planning window.

continuousPublishingWithRotation

18.4.1. Immovable Planning Entities

An immovable planning entity doesn’t change during solving. This is commonly used by users to pin down one or more specific assignments and force Planner to schedule around those fixed assignments.

18.4.1.1. Pin Down Planning Entities with @PlanningPin

To make some planning entities immovable, add an @PlanningPin annotation on a boolean getter or field of the planning entity class. That boolean is true if the entity is immovable (pinned down to its current planning values) and false otherwise.

  1. Add the @PlanningPin annotation on a boolean:

    @PlanningEntity
    public class Lecture {
    
        private boolean pinned;
        ...
    
        @PlanningPin
        public boolean isPinned() {
            return pinned;
        }
    
        ...
    }

In the example above, if pinned is true, the lecture will not be assigned to another period or room (even if the current period and rooms fields are null).

18.4.1.2. Configure a Movable EntitySelectionFilter

Alternatively, to make some planning entities immovable, add an entity SelectionFilter that returns true if an entity is movable, and false if it is immovable. This is more flexible and more verbose than the @PlanningPin approach.

For example on the nurse rostering example:

  1. Add the SelectionFilter:

    public class MovableShiftAssignmentSelectionFilter implements SelectionFilter<NurseRoster, ShiftAssignment> {
    
        @Override
        public boolean accept(ScoreDirector<NurseRoster> scoreDirector, ShiftAssignment shiftAssignment) {
            NurseRoster nurseRoster = scoreDirector.getWorkingSolution();
            ShiftDate shiftDate = shiftAssignment.getShift().getShiftDate();
            return nurseRoster.getNurseRosterInfo().isInPlanningWindow(shiftDate);
        }
    
    }
  2. Configure the SelectionFilter:

    @PlanningEntity(movableEntitySelectionFilter = MovableShiftAssignmentSelectionFilter.class)
    public class ShiftAssignment {
        ...
    }

18.4.2. Nonvolatile Replanning to Minimize Disruption (Semi-movable Planning Entities)

Replanning an existing plan can be very disruptive. If the plan affects humans (such as employees, drivers, …​), very disruptive changes are often undesirable. In such cases, nonvolatile replanning helps by restricting planning freedom: the gain of changing a plan must be higher than the disruption it causes. This is usually implemented by taxing all planning entities that change.

nonDisruptiveReplanning

In the machine reassignment example, the entity has both the planning variable machine and its original value originalMachine:

@PlanningEntity(...)
public class ProcessAssignment {

    private MrProcess process;
    private Machine originalMachine;
    private Machine machine;

    public Machine getOriginalMachine() {...}

    @PlanningVariable(...)
    public Machine getMachine() {...}

    public boolean isMoved() {
        return originalMachine != null && originalMachine != machine;
    }

    ...
}

During planning, the planning variable machine changes. By comparing it with the originalMachine, a change in plan can be penalized:

rule "processMoved"
    when
        ProcessAssignment(moved == true)
    then
        scoreHolder.addSoftConstraintMatch(kcontext, -1000);
end

The soft penalty of -1000 means that a better solution is only accepted if it improves the soft score for at least 1000 points per variable changed (or if it improves the hard score).

18.5. Real-time Planning

To do real-time planning, combine the following planning techniques:

  • Backup planning - adding extra score constraints to allow for unforeseen changes.

  • Continuous planning - planning for one or more future planning periods.

  • Short planning windows.

    This lowers the burden of real-time planning.

As time passes, the problem itself changes. Consider the vehicle routing use case:

realTimePlanningVehicleRouting

In the example above, three customers are added at different times (07:56, 08:02 and 08:45), after the original customer set finished solving at 07:55, and in some cases, after the vehicles already left.

Planner can handle such scenarios with ProblemFactChange (in combination with immovable planning entities).

18.5.1. ProblemFactChange

While the Solver is solving, one of the problem facts may be changed by an outside event. For example, an airplane is delayed and needs the runway at a later time.

Do not change the problem fact instances used by the Solver while it is solving (from another thread or even in the same thread), as that will corrupt it.

Add a ProblemFactChange to the Solver, which it executes in the solver thread as soon as possible. For example:

public interface Solver<Solution_> {

    ...

    boolean addProblemFactChange(ProblemFactChange<Solution_> problemFactChange);

    boolean isEveryProblemFactChangeProcessed();

    ...

}
public interface ProblemFactChange<Solution_> {

    void doChange(ScoreDirector<Solution_> scoreDirector);

}

The ScoreDirector must be updated with any change on the problem facts of planning entities in a ProblemFactChange.

To write a ProblemFactChange correctly, it is important to understand the behavior of a planning clone.

A planning clone of a solution must fulfill these requirements:

  • The clone must represent the same planning problem. Usually it reuses the same instances of the problem facts and problem fact collections as the original.

  • The clone must use different, cloned instances of the entities and entity collections. Changes to an original Solution entity’s variables must not affect its clone.

18.5.1.1. Cloud Balancing ProblemFactChange Example

Consider the following example of a ProblemFactChange implementation in the cloud balancing use case:

    public void deleteComputer(final CloudComputer computer) {
        solver.addProblemFactChange(scoreDirector -> {
            CloudBalance cloudBalance = scoreDirector.getWorkingSolution();
            CloudComputer workingComputer = scoreDirector.lookUpWorkingObject(computer);
            // First remove the problem fact from all planning entities that use it
            for (CloudProcess process : cloudBalance.getProcessList()) {
                if (process.getComputer() == workingComputer) {
                    scoreDirector.beforeVariableChanged(process, "computer");
                    process.setComputer(null);
                    scoreDirector.afterVariableChanged(process, "computer");
                }
            }
            // A SolutionCloner does not clone problem fact lists (such as computerList)
            // Shallow clone the computerList so only workingSolution is affected, not bestSolution or guiSolution
            ArrayList<CloudComputer> computerList = new ArrayList<>(cloudBalance.getComputerList());
            cloudBalance.setComputerList(computerList);
            // Remove the problem fact itself
            scoreDirector.beforeProblemFactRemoved(workingComputer);
            computerList.remove(workingComputer);
            scoreDirector.afterProblemFactRemoved(workingComputer);
            scoreDirector.triggerVariableListeners();
        });
    }
  1. Any change in a ProblemFactChange must be done on the Solution instance of scoreDirector.getWorkingSolution().

  2. The workingSolution is a planning clone of the BestSolutionChangedEvent's bestSolution.

    • The workingSolution in the Solver is never the same instance as the Solution in the rest of your application: it is a planning clone.

    • A planning clone also clones the planning entities and planning entity collections.

      So any change on the planning entities must happen on the instances held by scoreDirector.getWorkingSolution().

  3. Use the method ScoreDirector.lookUpWorkingObject() to translate and retrieve the working solution’s instance of an object. This requires annotating a property of that class as the @PlanningId.

  4. A planning clone does not clone the problem facts, nor the problem fact collections. Therefore the workingSolution and the bestSolution share the same problem fact instances and the same problem fact list instances.

    Any problem fact or problem fact list changed by a ProblemFactChange must be problem cloned first (which can imply rerouting references in other problem facts and planning entities). Otherwise, if the workingSolution and bestSolution are used in different threads (for example a solver thread and a GUI event thread), a race condition can occur.

18.5.1.2. Cloning Solutions to Avoid Race Conditions in Real-time Planning

Many types of changes can leave a planning entity uninitialized, resulting in a partially initialized solution. This is acceptable, provided the first solver phase can handle it.

All construction heuristics solver phases can handle a partially initialized solution, so it is recommended to configure such a solver phase as the first phase.

realTimePlanningConcurrencySequenceDiagram

The process occurs as follows:

  1. The Solver stops.

  2. Runs the ProblemFactChange.

  3. restarts.

    This is a warm start because its initial solution is the adjusted best solution of the previous run.

  4. Each solver phase runs again.

    This implies the construction heuristic runs again, but because little or no planning variables are uninitialized (unless you have a nullable planning variable), it finishes much quicker than in a cold start.

  5. Each configured Termination resets (both in solver and phase configuration), but a previous call to terminateEarly() is not undone.

    Termination is not usually configured (except in daemon mode); instead, Solver.terminateEarly() is called when the results are needed. Alternatively, configure a Termination and use the daemon mode in combination with BestSolutionChangedEvent as described in the following section.

18.5.2. Daemon: solve() Does Not Return

In real-time planning, it is often useful to have a solver thread wait when it runs out of work, and immediately resume solving a problem once new problem fact changes are added. Putting the Solver in daemon mode has the following effects:

  • If the Solver's Termination terminates, it does not return from solve(), but blocks its thread instead (which frees up CPU power).

    • Except for terminateEarly(), which does make it return from solve(), freeing up system resources and allowing an application to shutdown gracefully.

    • If a Solver starts with an empty planning entity collection, it waits in the blocked state immediately.

  • If a ProblemFactChange is added, it goes into the running state, applies the ProblemFactChange and runs the Solver again.

To use the Solver in daemon mode:

  1. Enable daemon mode on the Solver:

    <solver>
      <daemon>true</daemon>
      ...
    </solver>

    Do not forget to call Solver.terminateEarly() when your application needs to shutdown to avoid killing the solver thread unnaturally.

  2. Subscribe to the BestSolutionChangedEvent to process new best solutions found by the solver thread.

    A BestSolutionChangedEvent does not guarantee that every ProblemFactChange has been processed already, nor that the solution is initialized and feasible.

  3. To ignore BestSolutionChangedEvents with such invalid solutions, do the following:

        public void bestSolutionChanged(BestSolutionChangedEvent<CloudBalance> event) {
            if (event.isEveryProblemFactChangeProcessed()
                    // Ignore infeasible (including uninitialized) solutions
                    && event.getNewBestSolution().getScore().isFeasible()) {
                ...
            }
        }
  4. Use Score.isSolutionInitialized() instead of Score.isFeasible() to only ignore uninitialized solutions, but do accept infeasible solutions too.

19. Integration

19.1. Overview

Planner’s input and output data (the planning problem and the best solution) are plain old JavaBeans (POJO’s), so integration with other Java technologies is straightforward. For example:

  • To read a planning problem from the database (and store the best solution in it), annotate the domain POJO’s with JPA annotations.

  • To read a planning problem from an XML file (and store the best solution in it), annotate the domain POJO’s with XStream or JAXB annotations.

  • To expose the Solver as a REST Service that reads the planning problem and responds with the best solution, annotate the domain POJO’s with XStream, JAXB or Jackson annotations and hook the Solver in Camel or RESTEasy.

integrationOverview

19.2. Persistent Storage

19.2.1. Database: JPA and Hibernate

Enrich domain POJO’s (solution, entities and problem facts) with JPA annotations to store them in a database by calling EntityManager.persist().

Do not confuse JPA’s @Entity annotation with Planner’s @PlanningEntity annotation. They can appear both on the same class:

@PlanningEntity // OptaPlanner annotation
@Entity // JPA annotation
public class Talk {...}

Add a dependency to the optaplanner-persistence-jpa jar to take advantage of these extra integration features:

19.2.1.1. JPA and Hibernate: Persisting a Score

When a Score is persisted into a relational database, JPA and Hibernate will default to Java serializing it to a BLOB column. This has several disadvantages:

  • The Java serialization format of Score classes is currently not backwards compatible. Upgrading to a newer Planner version can break reading an existing database.

  • The score is not easily readable for a query executed in the database console. This is annoying during development.

  • The score cannot be used in a SQL or JPA-QL query to efficiently filter the results: for example to query all infeasible schedules.

To avoid these issues, configure it to instead use INTEGER (or other) columns, by using the appropriate *ScoreHibernateType for your Score type, for example for a HardSoftScore:

@PlanningSolution
@Entity
@TypeDef(defaultForType = HardSoftScore.class, typeClass = HardSoftScoreHibernateType.class)
public class CloudBalance {

    @PlanningScore
    @Columns(columns = {@Column(name = "initScore"), @Column(name = "hardScore"), @Column(name = "softScore")})
    protected HardSoftScore score;

    ...
}

Configure the same number of @Column annotations as the number of score levels in the score plus one (for the initScore), otherwise Hibernate will fail fast because a property mapping has the wrong number of columns.

In this case, the DDL will look like this:

CREATE TABLE CloudBalance(
    ...
    initScore INTEGER,
    hardScore INTEGER,
    softScore INTEGER
);

When using a BigDecimal based Score, specify the precision and scale of the columns to avoid silent rounding:

@PlanningSolution
@Entity
@TypeDef(defaultForType = HardSoftBigDecimalScore.class, typeClass = HardSoftBigDecimalScoreHibernateType.class)
public class CloudBalance{

    @PlanningScore
    @Columns(columns = {
            @Column(name = "initScore")
            @Column(name = "hardScore", precision = 10, scale = 5),
            @Column(name = "softScore", precision = 10, scale = 5)})
    protected HardSoftBigDecimalScore score;

    ...
}

In this case, the DDL will look like this:

CREATE TABLE CloudBalance(
    ...
    initScore INTEGER,
    hardScore DECIMAL(10, 5),
    softScore DECIMAL(10, 5)
);

When using any type of bendable Score, specify the hard and soft level sizes as parameters:

@PlanningSolution
@Entity
@TypeDef(defaultForType = BendableScore.class, typeClass = BendableScoreHibernateType.class, parameters = {
        @Parameter(name = "hardLevelsSize", value = "3"),
        @Parameter(name = "softLevelsSize", value = "2")})
public class Schedule {

    @PlanningScore
    @Columns(columns = {
            @Column(name = "initScore")
            @Column(name = "hard0Score"),
            @Column(name = "hard1Score"),
            @Column(name = "hard2Score"),
            @Column(name = "soft0Score"),
            @Column(name = "soft1Score")})
    protected BendableScore score;

    ...
}

All this support is Hibernate specific because currently JPA 2.1’s converters do not support converting to multiple columns.

19.2.1.2. JPA and Hibernate: Planning Cloning

In JPA and Hibernate, there is usually a @ManyToOne relationship from most problem fact classes to the planning solution class. Therefore, the problem fact classes reference the planning solution class, which implies that when the solution is planning cloned, they need to be cloned too. Use an @DeepPlanningClone on each such problem fact class to enforce that:

@PlanningSolution // OptaPlanner annotation
@Entity // JPA annotation
public class Conference {

    @OneToMany(mappedBy="conference")
    private List<Room> roomList;

    ...
}
@DeepPlanningClone // OptaPlanner annotation: Force the default planning cloner to planning clone this class too
@Entity // JPA annotation
public class Room {

    @ManyToOne
    private Conference conference; // Because of this reference, this problem fact needs to be planning cloned too

}

Neglecting to do this can lead to persisting duplicate solutions, JPA exceptions or other side effects.

19.2.2. XML or JSON: XStream

Enrich domain POJO’s (solution, entities and problem facts) with XStream annotations to serialize them to/from XML or JSON.

Add a dependency to the optaplanner-persistence-xstream jar to take advantage of these extra integration features:

19.2.2.1. XStream: Marshalling a Score

When a Score is marshalled to XML or JSON by the default XStream configuration, it’s verbose and ugly. To fix that, configure the appropriate ScoreXStreamConverter:

@PlanningSolution
@XStreamAlias("CloudBalance")
public class CloudBalance {

    @PlanningScore
    @XStreamConverter(HardSoftScoreXStreamConverter.class)
    private HardSoftScore score;

    ...
}

For example, this will generate pretty XML:

<CloudBalance>
   ...
   <score>0hard/-200soft</score>
</CloudBalance>

The same applies for a bendable score:

@PlanningSolution
@XStreamAlias("Schedule")
public class Schedule {

    @PlanningScore
    @XStreamConverter(BendableScoreXStreamConverter.class)
    private BendableScore score;

    ...
}

For example, this will generate:

<Schedule>
   ...
   <score>[0/0]hard/[-100/-20/-3]soft</score>
</Schedule>

When reading a bendable score from an XML element, the implied hardLevelsSize and softLevelsSize must always be in sync with those in the solver.

19.2.3. XML or JSON: JAXB

Enrich domain POJO’s (solution, entities and problem facts) with JAXB annotations to serialize them to/from XML or JSON.

Add a dependency to the optaplanner-persistence-jaxb jar to take advantage of these extra integration features:

19.2.3.1. JAXB: Marshalling a Score

When a Score is marshalled to XML or JSON by the default JAXB configuration, it’s corrupted. To fix that, configure the appropriate ScoreJaxbXmlAdapter:

@PlanningSolution
@XmlRootElement @XmlAccessorType(XmlAccessType.FIELD)
public class CloudBalance {

    @PlanningScore
    @XmlJavaTypeAdapter(HardSoftScoreJaxbXmlAdapter.class)
    private HardSoftScore score;

    ...
}

For example, this will generate pretty XML:

<cloudBalance>
   ...
   <score>0hard/-200soft</score>
</cloudBalance>

The same applies for a bendable score:

@PlanningSolution
@XmlRootElement @XmlAccessorType(XmlAccessType.FIELD)
public class Schedule {

    @PlanningScore
    @XmlJavaTypeAdapter(BendableScoreJaxbXmlAdapter.class)
    private BendableScore score;

    ...
}

For example, with a hardLevelsSize of 2 and a softLevelsSize of 3, that will generate:

<schedule>
   ...
   <score>[0/0]hard/[-100/-20/-3]soft</score>
</schedule>

The hardLevelsSize and softLevelsSize implied, when reading a bendable score from an XML element, must always be in sync with those in the solver.

19.2.4. JSON: Jackson

Enrich domain POJO’s (solution, entities and problem facts) with Jackson annotations to serialize them to/from JSON.

Add a dependency to the optaplanner-persistence-jackson jar and register OptaPlannerJacksonModule:

ObjectMapper objectMapper = new ObjectMapper();
objectMapper.registerModule(OptaPlannerJacksonModule.createModule());
19.2.4.1. Jackson: Marshalling a Score

When a Score is marshalled to/from JSON by the default Jackson configuration, it fails. The OptaPlannerJacksonModule fixes that, by using HardSoftScoreJacksonJsonSerializer, HardSoftScoreJacksonJsonDeserializer`, etc.

@PlanningSolution
public class CloudBalance {

    @PlanningScore
    private HardSoftScore score;

    ...
}

For example, this will generate this JSON:

{
   "score":"0hard/-200soft"
   ...
}

When reading a BendableScore, the hardLevelsSize and softLevelsSize implied in the JSON element, must always be in sync with those defined in the @PlanningScore annotation in the solution class. For example:

{
   "score":"[0/0]hard/[-100/-20/-3]soft"
   ...
}

This JSON implies the hardLevelsSize is 2 and thet softLevelsSize is 3, which must be in sync with the @PlanningScore annotation:

@PlanningSolution
public class Schedule {

    @PlanningScore(bendableHardLevelsSize = 2, bendableSoftLevelsSize = 3)
    private BendableScore score;

    ...
}

When a field is the Score supertype (instead of a specific type such as HardSoftScore), it uses PolymorphicScoreJacksonJsonSerializer and PolymorphicScoreJacksonJsonDeserializer to record the score type in JSON too, otherwise it would be impossible to deserialize it:

@PlanningSolution
public class CloudBalance {

    @PlanningScore
    private Score score;

    ...
}

For example, this will generate this JSON:

{
   "score":{"HardSoftScore":"0hard/-200soft"}
   ...
}

19.3. SOA and ESB

19.3.1. Camel and Karaf

Camel is an enterprise integration framework which includes support for Planner (starting from Camel 2.13). It can expose a use case as a REST service, a SOAP service, a JMS service, …​

19.4. Other Environments

19.4.1. JBoss Modules, WildFly and JBoss EAP

Because of JBoss Modules' ClassLoader magic, provide the ClassLoader of your classes during the SolverFactory creation, so it can find the classpath resources (such as the solver config, score DRL’s and domain classes) in your jars.

It’s also recommended to plug in WildFly’s thread factory, especially with multithreaded solving.

19.4.1.1. Logging on WildFly and JBoss EAP

To get decent logging of the solver(s), create a file src/main/resources/jboss-log4j.xml (so it ends up in the war as WEB-INF/classes/jboss-log4j.xml) with this content:

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<log4j:configuration xmlns:log4j="http://jakarta.apache.org/log4j/" debug="false">

  <appender name="consoleAppender" class="org.apache.log4j.ConsoleAppender">
    <layout class="org.apache.log4j.PatternLayout">
      <param name="ConversionPattern" value="%d{HH:mm:ss.SSS} %-5p [%t] %m%n"/>
    </layout>
  </appender>

  <logger name="org.optaplanner">
    <level value="debug"/>
  </logger>

  <root>
    <level value="warn" />
    <appender-ref ref="consoleAppender"/>
  </root>

</log4j:configuration>
19.4.1.2. Skinny war on WildFly and JBoss EAP

To deploy an Planner web application on WildFly, simply include the optaplanner dependency jars in the war file’s WEB-INF/lib directory (just like any other dependency) as shown in the optaplanner-webexamples-*.war. However, in this approach the war file can easily grow to several MB in size, which is fine for a one-time deployment, but too heavyweight for frequent redeployments (especially over a slow network connection).

The remedy is to use deliver the optaplanner jars in a JBoss module to WildFly and create a skinny war. Let’s create an module called org.optaplanner:

  1. Navigate to the directory ${WILDFLY_HOME}/modules/system/layers/base/. This directory contains the JBoss modules of WildFly. Create directory structure org/optaplanner/main for our new module.

    1. Copy optaplanner-core-${version}.jar and all its direct and transitive dependency jars into that new directory. Use "mvn dependency:tree" on each optaplanner artifact to discover all dependencies.

    2. Create the file module.xml in that new directory. Give it this content:

      <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
      <module xmlns="urn:jboss:module:1.3" name="org.optaplanner">
        <resources>
          ...
          <resource-root path="kie-api-${version}.jar"/>
          ...
          <resource-root path="optaplanner-core-${version}.jar"/>
          ...
          <resource-root path="."/>
        </resources>
        <dependencies>
          <module name="javaee.api"/>
        </dependencies>
      </module>
  2. Navigate to the deployed war file.

    1. Remove optaplanner-core-${version}.jar and all its direct and transitive dependency jars from the WEB-INF/lib directory in the war file.

    2. Create the file jboss-deployment-structure.xml in the WEB-INF/lib directory. Give it this content:

      <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?>
      <jboss-deployment-structure>
         <deployment>
            <dependencies>
               <module name="org.optaplanner" export="true"/>
            </dependencies>
         </deployment>
      </jboss-deployment-structure>

19.4.2. Spring Boot

Normally Planner just works on Spring Boot, simply add the optaplanner-core dependency. If it has trouble finding classpath resources (such as the solver config, score DRL’s and domain classes), provide the ClassLoader of your classes during the SolverFactory creation.

19.4.3. Java Platform Module System (Jigsaw)

When using Planner from code on the modulepath (Java 9 and higher), open your packages that contain your domain objects, DRL files and solver configuration in your module-info.java file:

module org.optaplanner.cloudbalancing {
    requires org.optaplanner.core;
    ...

    opens org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.domain; // Domain classes
    opens org.optaplanner.examples.cloudbalancing.solver; // DRL file and solver configuration
    ...
}

Otherwise Planner can’t reach those classes or files, even if they are exported.

19.4.4. OSGi

The optaplanner-core jar includes OSGi metadata in its MANIFEST.MF file to function properly in an OSGi environment too. Furthermore, the maven artifact kie-karaf-features contains a features.xml file that supports the OSGi-feature optaplanner-engine.

Because of the OSGi’s ClassLoader magic, provide the ClassLoader of your classes during the SolverFactory creation, so it can find the classpath resources (such as the solver config, score DRL’s and domain classes) in your jars.

Planner does not require OSGi. It works perfectly fine in a normal Java environment too.

19.4.5. Android

Android is not a complete JVM (because some JDK libraries are missing), but Planner works on Android with easy Java or incremental Java score calculation. The Drools rule engine does not work on Android yet, so Drools score calculation doesn’t work on Android and its dependencies need to be excluded.

Workaround to use Planner on Android:

  1. Add a dependency to the build.gradle file in your Android project to exclude org.drools and xmlpull dependencies:

    dependencies {
        ...
        compile('org.optaplanner:optaplanner-core:...') {
            exclude group: 'xmlpull'
            exclude group: 'org.drools'
        }
        ...
    }

19.5. Integration with Human Planners (Politics)

A good Planner implementation beats any good human planner for non-trivial datasets. Many human planners fail to accept this, often because they feel threatened by an automated system.

But despite that, both can benefit if the human planner becomes the supervisor of Planner:

  • The human planner defines, validates and tweaks the score function.

    • The human planner tweaks the constraint weights of the constraint configuration in a UI, as the business priorities change over time.

    • When the business changes, the score function often needs to change too. The human planner can notify the developers to add, change or remove score constraints.

  • The human planner is always in control of Planner.

    • As shown in the course scheduling example, the human planner can pin down one or more planning variables to a specific planning value. Because they are immovable, Planner does not change them: it optimizes the planning around the enforcements made by the human. If the human planner pins down all planning variables, he/she sidelines Planner completely.

    • In a prototype implementation, the human planner occasionally uses pinning to intervene, but as the implementation matures, this should become obsolete. The feature should be kept available as a reassurance for the humans, and in the event that the business changes dramatically before the score constraints are adjusted accordingly.

For this reason, it is recommended the human planner is actively involved in your project.

keepTheUserInControl

19.6. Sizing Hardware and Software

Before sizing a Planner service, first understand the typical behaviour of a Solver.solve() call:

sizingHardware

Understand these guidelines to decide the hardware for a Planner service:

  • RAM memory: Provision plenty, but no need to provide more.

    • The problem dataset, loaded before Planner is called, often consumes the most memory. It depends on the problem scale.

      • For example, in the Machine Reassignment example some datasets use over 1GB in memory. But in most examples, they use just a few MB.

      • If this is a problem, review the domain class structure: remove classes or fields that Planner doesn’t need during solving.

      • Planner usually has up to three solution instances: the internal working solution, the best solution and the old best solution (when it’s being replaced). However, these are all a planning clone of each other, so many problem fact instances are shared between those solution instances.

    • During solving, the memory is very volatile, because solving creates many short-lived objects. The Garbage Collector deletes these in bulk and therefore needs some heap space as a buffer.

    • The maximum size of the JVM heap space can be in three states:

      • Insufficient: An OutOfMemoryException is thrown (often because the Garbage Collector is using more than 98% of the CPU time).

      • Narrow: The heap buffer for those short-lived instances is too small, therefore the Garbage Collector needs to run more than it would like to, which causes a performance loss.

        • Profiling shows that in the heap chart, the used heap space frequently touches the max heap space during solving. It also shows that the Garbage Collector has a significant CPU usage impact.

        • Adding more heap space increases the score calculation speed.

      • Plenty: There is enough heap space. The Garbage Collector is active, but its CPU usage is low.

        • Adding more heap space does not increase performance.

        • Usually, this is around 300 to 500MB above the dataset size, regardless of the problem scale (except with nearby selection and caching move selector, neither are used by default).

  • CPU power: More is better.

    • Improving CPU speed directly increases the score calculation speed.

      • If the CPU power is twice as fast, it takes half the time to find the same result. However, this does not guarantee that it finds a better result in the same time, nor that it finds a similar result for a problem twice as a big in the same time.

      • Increasing CPU power usually does not resolve scaling issues, because planning problems scale exponentially. Power tweaking the solver configuration has far better results for scaling issues than throwing hardware at it.

    • During the solve() method, the CPU power will max out until it returns (except in daemon mode or if your SolverEventListener writes the best solution to disk or the network).

  • Number of CPU cores: one CPU core per active Solver, plus at least one one for the operating system.

    • So in a multitenant application, which has one Solver per tenant, this means one CPU core per tenant, unless the number of solver threads is limited, as that limits the number of tenants being solved in parallel.

    • With Partitioned Search, presume one CPU core per partition (per active tenant), unless the number of partition threads is limited.

      • To reduce the number of used cores, it can be better to reduce the partition threads (so solve some partitions sequentially) than to reduce the number of partitions.

    • In use cases with many tenants (such as scheduling Software as a Service) or many partitions, it might not be affordable to provision that many CPUs.

      • Reduce the number of active Solvers at a time. For example: give each tenant only one minute of machine time and use a ExecutorService with a fixed thread pool to queue requests.

      • Distribute the Solver runs across the day (or night). This is especially an opportunity in SaaS that’s used across the globe, due to timezones: UK and India can use the same CPU core when scheduling at night.

    • The SolverManager will take care of the orchestration, especially in those underfunded environments in which solvers (and partitions) are forced to share CPU cores or wait in line.

  • I/O (network, disk, …​): Not used during solving.

    • Planner is not a web server: a solver thread does not block (unlike a servlet thread), each one fully drains a CPU.

      • A web server can handle 24 active servlets threads with eight cores without performance loss, because most servlets threads are blocking on I/O.

      • However, 24 active solver threads with eight cores will cause each solver’s score calculation speed to be three times slower, causing a big performance loss.

    • Note that calling any I/O during solving, for example a remote service in your score calculation, causes a huge performance loss because it’s called thousands of times per second, so it should complete in microseconds. So no good implementation does that.

Keep these guidelines in mind when selecting and configuring the software. See our blog archive for the details of our experiments, which use our diverse set of examples. Your mileage may vary.

  • Operating System

    • No experimentally proven advice yet (but prefer Linux anyway).

  • JDK

    • Version: Java 7 can be between 10% and 25% faster than Java 6. But Java 8 however is usually not significantly faster than Java 7.

    • Garbage Collector: ParallelGC (the default in Java 8) can be potentially between 5% and 35% faster than G1GC (the default in Java 9). Unlike web servers, Planner needs a GC focused on throughput, not latency. Use -XX:+UseParallelGC to turn on ParallelGC.

  • Logging can have a severe impact on performance.

    • Debug logging org.drools can reduce performance by a factor of 7.

    • Debug logging org.optaplanner can be between 0% and 15% slower than info logging. Trace logging can be between 5% and 70% slower than info logging.

    • Synchronous logging to a file has an additional significant impact for debug and trace logging (but not for info logging).

  • Avoid a cloud environment in which you share your CPU core(s) with other virtual machines or containers. Performance (and therefore solution quality) can be unreliable when the available CPU power varies greatly.

Keep in mind that the perfect hardware/software environment will probably not solve scaling issues (even Moore’s law is too slow). There is no need to follow these guidelines to the letter.

20. Design Patterns

20.1. Design Patterns Introduction

These design patterns list and solve common design challenges.

20.2. Domain Modeling Guide

A good model can greatly improve the success of your planning implementation. These guidelines help to design a good model:

  1. Draw a class diagram of your domain model. Normalize it get rid of duplicate data.

    • Write down some sample instances for each class.

      • For example in employee rostering, the samples for the Employee class are Ann, Bert and Carl.

  2. Determine which relationships (or fields) change during planning. Color them orange. Often there is only one such relationship (or field). One side of these relationships will become a planning variable later on.

    • For example in employee rostering, the Shift to Employee relationship changes during planning, so it is orange. Other relationships, such as from Employee to Skill, are immutable during planning because Planner can’t decide to give an employee an extra skill.

  3. If there are multiple relationships (or fields): check for shadow variables. A shadow variable does change during planning, but its value can be calculated based on one or more genuine planning variables, without dispute. Color those shadow relationships (or fields) purple.

    • Only one side of a bi-directional relationship can be a genuine planning variable, the other side will become an inverse relation shadow variable later on. Keep those relationships in orange.

  4. Check for chained planning variables. In a chained variable design, the focus lies on deciding the order of a set planning entity instances, instead of assigning them to a date/time (although there can be an assigned date/time as a shadow variable). A typical use case is vehicle routing.

  5. If there is an orange many to many relationship, replace that many to many relationship with a one to many and a many to one relationship to a new intermediate class.

    • Planner currently doesn’t support a @PlanningVariable on a collection. Although a future version will support it for flexibility reasons, it probably has an inherit performance and complexity cost, so it might be better to avoid it anyway.

    • For example in employee rostering the ShiftAssignment class is the many to many relationship between the Shift and Employee. It’s effectively every spot that needs to be filled with an employee.

      employeeShiftRosteringModelingGuideA
  6. In a many to one relationship, usually the many side is the planning entity class with the planning variable. Annotate it with a @PlanningEntity annotation.

    • For example in employee rostering, the ShiftAssignment class has an @PlanningEntity annotation.

    • If it’s a bi-directional relationship, both sides are a planning entity class, but usually the many side has the planning variable and the one side the shadow variable.

  7. The planning entity class should have at least one problem property. So a planning entity class cannot consist out of only planning variables (or even an id and only planning variables). Remove a surplus @PlanningVariable so it becomes a problem property. This heavily decreases the search space size and heavily increases solving efficiency.

    • For example in employee rostering, the ShiftAssignment class should not annotate both the shift and employee relationship with @PlanningVariable.

    • When all planning variables are null (which occurs when the planning solution is still uninitialized), a planning entity instance should still be describable to the business people.

      • So a surrogate ID does not suffice as the required minimum of one problem property.

    • This way, there is no need to add a hard constraint to assure that two planning entities are different: they are already different due to their problem properties.

    • In some cases, multiple planning entity instances have the same set of problem properties. In such cases, it can be useful to create an extra problem property to distinguish them.

      • For example in employee rostering, the ShiftAssignment class has besides the problem property Shift also the problem property indexInShift (which is an int).

  8. Choose the model in which the number of planning entities is fixed during planning.

    • For example in employee rostering, it’s impossible to know in advance how many shifts each employee will have before Planner solves it (and it can even differ per best solution found). On the other hand, the number of employees per shift is known in advance, so it’s better to make the Shift relationship a problem property and the Employee relationship a planning variable.

      employeeShiftRosteringModelingGuideB

For inspiration, take a look at how the examples modeled their domain:

entityVariableAndValueExamples

Vehicle routing is special, because it uses a chained planning variable.

20.3. Assigning Time to Planning Entities

Dealing with time and dates in planning problems may be problematic because it is dependent on the needs of your use case.

There are several representations of timestamps, dates, durations and periods in Java. Choose the right representation type for your use case:

  • java.util.Date (deprecated): a slow, error-prone way to represent timestamps. Do not use.

  • java.time.LocalDateTime, LocalDate, DayOfWeek, Duration, Period, …​: an accurate way to represent and calculate with timestamps, dates, …​

    • Supports timezones and DST (Daylight Saving Time).

    • Requires Java 8 or higher.

  • int or long: Caches a timestamp as a simplified number of coarse-grained time units (such as minutes) from the start of the global planning time window or the epoch.

    • For example: a LocalDateTime of 1-JAN 08:00:00 becomes an int of 400 minutes. Similarly 1-JAN 09:00:00 becomes 460 minutes.

    • It often represents an extra field in a class, alongside the LocalDateTime field from which it was calculated. The LocalDateTime is used for user visualization, but the int is used in the score constraints.

    • It is faster in calculations, which is especially useful in the TimeGrain pattern.

    • Do not use if timezones or DST affect the score constraints.

There are also several designs for assigning a planning entity to a starting time (or date):

  • The starting time is fixed beforehand. It is not a planning variable (in such solver).

    • For example, in the hospital bed planning example, the arrival day of each patient is fixed beforehand.

    • This is common in multi stage planning, when the starting time has been decided already in an earlier planning stage.

  • The starting time is not fixed, it is a planning variable (genuine or shadow).

    • If all planning entities have the same duration, use the Timeslot pattern.

      • For example in course scheduling, all lectures take one hour. Therefore, each timeslot is one hour.

    • If the duration differs and time is rounded to a specifc time granularity (for example 5 minutes) use the TimeGrain pattern.

      • For example in meeting scheduling, all meetings start at 15 minute intervals. All meetings take 15, 30, 45, 60, 90 or 120 minutes.

    • If the duration differs and one task starts immediately after the previous task (assigned to the same executor) finishes, use the Chained Through Time pattern.

      • For example in time windowed vehicle routing, each vehicle departs immediately to the next customer when the delivery for the previous customer finishes.

Choose the right pattern depending on the use case:

assigningTimeToPlanningEntities

20.3.1. Timeslot Pattern: Assign to a Fixed-Length Timeslot

If all planning entities have the same duration (or can be inflated to the same duration), the Timeslot pattern is useful. The planning entities are assigned to a timeslot rather than time. For example in course timetabling, all lectures take one hour.

The timeslots can start at any time. For example, the timeslots start at 8:00, 9:00, 10:15 (after a 15-minute break), 11:15, …​ They can even overlap, but that is unusual.

It is also usable if all planning entities can be inflated to the same duration. For example in exam timetabling, some exams take 90 minutes and others 120 minutes, but all timeslots are 120 minutes. When an exam of 90 minutes is assigned to a timeslot, for the remaining 30 minutes, its seats are occupied too and cannot be used by another exam.

Usually there is a second planning variable, for example the room. In course timetabling, two lectures are in conflict if they share the same room at the same timeslot. However, in exam timetabling, that is allowed, if there is enough seating capacity in the room (although mixed exam durations in the same room do inflict a soft score penalty).

20.3.2. TimeGrain Pattern: Assign to a Starting TimeGrain

Assigning humans to start a meeting at four seconds after 9 o’clock is pointless because most human activities have a time granularity of five minutes or 15 minutes. Therefore it is not necessary to allow a planning entity to be assigned subsecond, second or even one minute accuracy. The five minute or 15 minutes accuracy suffices. The TimeGrain pattern models such time accuracy by partitioning time as time grains. For example in meeting scheduling, all meetings start/end in hour, half hour, or 15-minute intervals before or after each hour, therefore the optimal settings for time grains is 15 minutes.

Each planning entity is assigned to a start time grain. The end time grain is calculated by adding the duration in grains to the starting time grain. Overlap of two entities is determined by comparing their start and end time grains.

This pattern also works well with a coarser time granularity (such as days, half days, hours, …​). With a finer time granularity (such as seconds, milliseconds, …​) and a long time window, the value range (and therefore the search space) can become too high, which reduces efficiency and scalability. However, such solution is not impossible, as shown in cheap time scheduling.

20.3.3. Chained Through Time Pattern: Assign in a Chain that Determines Starting Time

If a person or a machine continuously works on one task at a time in sequence, which means starting a task when the previous is finished (or with a deterministic delay), the Chained Through Time pattern is useful. For example, in the vehicle routing with time windows example, a vehicle drives from customer to customer (thus it handles one customer at a time).

In this pattern, the planning entities are chained. The anchor determines the starting time of its first planning entity. The second entity’s starting time is calculated based on the starting time and duration of the first entity. For example, in task assignment, Beth (the anchor) starts working at 8:00, thus her first task starts at 8:00. It lasts 52 mins, therefore her second task starts at 8:52. The starting time of an entity is usually a shadow variable.

An anchor has only one chain. Although it is possible to split up the anchor into two separate anchors, for example split up Beth into Beth’s left hand and Beth’s right hand (because she can do two tasks at the same time), this model makes pooling resources difficult. Consequently, using this model in the exam scheduling example to allow two or more exams to use the same room at the same time is problematic.

Between planning entities, there are three ways to create gaps:

  • No gaps: This is common when the anchor is a machine. For example, a build server always starts the next job when the previous finishes, without a break.

  • Only deterministic gaps: This is common for humans. For example, any task that crosses the 10:00 barrier gets an extra 15 minutes duration so the human can take a break.

    • A deterministic gap can be subjected to complex business logic. For example in vehicle routing, a cross-continent truck driver needs to rest 15 minutes after two hours of driving (which may also occur during loading or unloading time at a customer location) and also needs to rest 10 hours after 14 hours of work.

  • Planning variable gaps: This is uncommon, because an extra planning variable (which impacts the search space) reduces efficiency and scalability.

20.4. Multi-stage planning

For practical or organizational reasons (such as Conway’s law), complex planning problems are often broken down in multiple stages. A typical example is train scheduling, where one department decides where and when a train will arrive or depart, and another departments assigns the operators to the actual train cars/locomotives.

Each stage has its own solver configuration (and therefore its own SolverFactory). Do not confuse it with multi-phase solving which uses a one-solver configuration.

Similarly to Partitioned Search, multi-stage planning leads to suboptimal results. Nevertheless, it may be beneficial in order to simplify the maintenance, ownership, and help to start a project.

21. Development

21.1. Methodology Overview

The diagram below explains the overall structure of the OptaPlanner source code:

methodologyOverview

In the diagram above, it’s important to understand the clear separation between the configuration and runtime classes.

The development philosophy includes:

  • Reuse: The examples are reused as integration tests, stress tests and demo’s. The documentation images are reused as slides.

  • Consistent terminology: Each example has a class App (executable class) and Panel (swing UI).

  • Consistent structure: Each example has the same packages: domain, persistence, app, solver and swingui.

  • Real world usefulness: Every feature is used in an example. Most examples are real world use cases with real world constraints, often with real world data.

  • Automated testing: There are unit tests, integration tests, performance regressions tests and stress tests. The test coverage is high.

  • Fail fast with an understandable error message: Invalid states are checked as early as possible.

21.2. Development guidelines

  1. Fail fast. There are several levels of fail fast, from better to worse:

    1. Fail Fast at compile time. For example: Don’t accept an Object as parameter if it needs to be a String or an Integer.

    2. Fail Fast at startup time. For example: if the configuration parameter needs to be a positive int and it’s negative, fail fast

    3. Fail Fast at runtime. For example: if the request needs to contain a double between 0.0 and 1.0 and it’s bigger than 1.0, fail fast.

    4. Fail Fast at runtime in assertion mode if the detection performance cost is high. For example: If, after every low level iteration, the variable A needs to be equal to the square root of B, check it if and only if an assert flag is set to true (usually controlled by the EnvironmentMode).

  2. Exception messages

    1. The Exception message must include the name and state of each relevant variable. For example:

      if (fooSize < 0) {
          throw new IllegalArgumentException("The fooSize (" + fooSize + ") of bar (" + this + ") must be positive.");
      }

      Notice that the output clearly explains what’s wrong:

      Exception in thread "main" java.lang.IllegalArgumentException: The fooSize (-5) of bar (myBar) must be positive.
          at ...
    2. Whenever possible, the Exception message must include context.

    3. Whenever the fix is not obvious, the Exception message should include advice. Advice normally starts with the word maybe on a new line:

      Exception in thread "main" java.lang.IllegalStateException: The valueRangeDescriptor (fooRange) is nullable, but not countable (false).
      Maybe the member (getFooRange) should return CountableValueRange.
          at ...

      The word maybe is to indicate that the advice is not guaranteed to be right in all cases.

  3. Generics. The Solution class is often passed as a generic type parameter to subsystems. The PlanningEntity class(es) are rarely passed as a generic type parameter.